Adding upstream version 0.6.0.

Signed-off-by: Andrew Lee (李健秋) <ajqlee@debian.org>
ubuntu/cosmic
Andrew Lee (李健秋) 9 years ago
parent 450afc560c
commit 33ac93602c

@ -0,0 +1,15 @@
Originally forked from Konsole by <e_k@users.sourceforge.net>
Revived by Petr Vanek <petr@yarpen.cz>
Contributors:
Adam Treat <atreat@rim.com>
Chris Mueller <ruunsmail@googlemail.com>
Christian Surlykke <christian@surlykke.dk>
Daniel O'Neill <doneill@cammy.riverroadcable.com>
Francisco Ballina <zballinita@gmail.com>
Georg Rudoy <0xd34df00d@gmail.com>
Jerome Leclanche <jerome@leclan.ch>
Petr Vanek <petr@yarpen.cz>
@kulti <kultihell@gmail.com>

@ -0,0 +1,239 @@
cmake_minimum_required( VERSION 2.8 )
project(qtermwidget)
option(BUILD_DESIGNER_PLUGIN "Build Qt4 designer plugin" ON)
option(USE_QT5 "Build using Qt5. Default OFF." OFF)
option(BUILD_TEST "Build test application. Default OFF." OFF)
set(CMAKE_MODULE_PATH ${CMAKE_MODULE_PATH} "${CMAKE_SOURCE_DIR}/cmake")
# just change version for releases
set(QTERMWIDGET_VERSION_MAJOR "0")
set(QTERMWIDGET_VERSION_MINOR "6")
set(QTERMWIDGET_VERSION_PATCH "0")
set(QTERMWIDGET_VERSION "${QTERMWIDGET_VERSION_MAJOR}.${QTERMWIDGET_VERSION_MINOR}.${QTERMWIDGET_VERSION_PATCH}")
include(CheckFunctionExists)
include(GNUInstallDirs)
include_directories(
"${CMAKE_SOURCE_DIR}/lib"
"${CMAKE_BINARY_DIR}/lib"
"${CMAKE_BINARY_DIR}"
)
add_definitions(-Wall)
if(USE_QT5)
set(QTERMWIDGET_LIBRARY_NAME qtermwidget5)
include(qtermwidget5_use)
else()
include(qtermwidget4_use)
set(QTERMWIDGET_LIBRARY_NAME qtermwidget4)
endif()
# main library
set(SRCS
lib/BlockArray.cpp
lib/ColorScheme.cpp
lib/Emulation.cpp
lib/Filter.cpp
lib/History.cpp
lib/HistorySearch.cpp
lib/KeyboardTranslator.cpp
lib/konsole_wcwidth.cpp
lib/kprocess.cpp
lib/kpty.cpp
lib/kptydevice.cpp
lib/kptyprocess.cpp
lib/Pty.cpp
lib/qtermwidget.cpp
lib/Screen.cpp
lib/ScreenWindow.cpp
lib/SearchBar.cpp
lib/Session.cpp
lib/ShellCommand.cpp
lib/TerminalCharacterDecoder.cpp
lib/TerminalDisplay.cpp
lib/tools.cpp
lib/Vt102Emulation.cpp
)
# Only the Headers that need to be moc'd go here
set(HDRS
lib/Emulation.h
lib/Filter.h
lib/HistorySearch.h
lib/kprocess.h
lib/kptydevice.h
lib/kptyprocess.h
lib/Pty.h
lib/qtermwidget.h
lib/ScreenWindow.h
lib/SearchBar.h
lib/Session.h
lib/TerminalDisplay.h
lib/Vt102Emulation.h
)
set(UI
lib/SearchBar.ui
)
# for distribution
set(HDRS_DISTRIB
lib/qtermwidget.h
lib/Filter.h
)
# dirs
set(KB_LAYOUT_DIR "${CMAKE_INSTALL_DATADIR}/${QTERMWIDGET_LIBRARY_NAME}/kb-layouts/")
message(STATUS "Keyboard layouts will be installed in: ${KB_LAYOUT_DIR}")
add_definitions(-DKB_LAYOUT_DIR="${CMAKE_INSTALL_PREFIX}/${KB_LAYOUT_DIR}")
set(COLORSCHEMES_DIR "${CMAKE_INSTALL_DATADIR}/${QTERMWIDGET_LIBRARY_NAME}/color-schemes/")
message(STATUS "Color schemes will be installed in: ${COLORSCHEMES_DIR}" )
add_definitions(-DCOLORSCHEMES_DIR="${CMAKE_INSTALL_PREFIX}/${COLORSCHEMES_DIR}")
set(QTERMWIDGET_INCLUDE_DIR "${CMAKE_INSTALL_PREFIX}/${CMAKE_INSTALL_INCLUDEDIR}/${QTERMWIDGET_LIBRARY_NAME}")
#| Defines
add_definitions(-DHAVE_POSIX_OPENPT -DHAVE_SYS_TIME_H)
if(APPLE)
add_definitions(-DHAVE_UTMPX -D_UTMPX_COMPAT)
endif()
CHECK_FUNCTION_EXISTS(updwtmpx HAVE_UPDWTMPX)
if(HAVE_UPDWTMPX)
add_definitions(-DHAVE_UPDWTMPX)
endif()
if(USE_QT5)
qt5_wrap_cpp(MOCS ${HDRS})
qt5_wrap_ui(UI_SRCS ${UI})
set(PKG_CONFIG_REQ "Qt5Core, Qt5Xml, Qt5Widgets")
else()
qt4_wrap_cpp(MOCS ${HDRS})
qt4_wrap_ui(UI_SRCS ${UI})
set(PKG_CONFIG_REQ "QtCore, QtXml")
endif()
add_library(${QTERMWIDGET_LIBRARY_NAME} SHARED ${SRCS} ${MOCS} ${UI_SRCS})
target_link_libraries(${QTERMWIDGET_LIBRARY_NAME} ${QTERMWIDGET_QT_LIBRARIES})
set_target_properties( ${QTERMWIDGET_LIBRARY_NAME} PROPERTIES
SOVERSION ${QTERMWIDGET_VERSION_MAJOR}
VERSION ${QTERMWIDGET_VERSION}
)
if(APPLE)
set (CMAKE_SKIP_RPATH 1)
# this is a must to load the lib correctly
set_target_properties( ${QTERMWIDGET_LIBRARY_NAME} PROPERTIES INSTALL_NAME_DIR ${CMAKE_INSTALL_PREFIX}/${CMAKE_INSTALL_LIBDIR} )
endif()
install(TARGETS ${QTERMWIDGET_LIBRARY_NAME} DESTINATION "${CMAKE_INSTALL_LIBDIR}")
install(FILES ${HDRS_DISTRIB} DESTINATION "${CMAKE_INSTALL_INCLUDEDIR}/${QTERMWIDGET_LIBRARY_NAME}")
# keyboard layouts
install(DIRECTORY lib/kb-layouts/ DESTINATION "${KB_LAYOUT_DIR}" FILES_MATCHING PATTERN "*.keytab" )
# color schemes
install(DIRECTORY lib/color-schemes/ DESTINATION "${COLORSCHEMES_DIR}" FILES_MATCHING PATTERN "*.*schem*")
include(create_pkgconfig_file)
create_pkgconfig_file(${QTERMWIDGET_LIBRARY_NAME}
"QTermWidget library for Qt ${QTERMWIDGET_VERSION_MAJOR}.x"
${PKG_CONFIG_REQ}
${QTERMWIDGET_LIBRARY_NAME}
${QTERMWIDGET_VERSION}
)
configure_file(
"${CMAKE_SOURCE_DIR}/cmake/${QTERMWIDGET_LIBRARY_NAME}-config.cmake.in"
"${CMAKE_BINARY_DIR}/${QTERMWIDGET_LIBRARY_NAME}-config.cmake"
@ONLY
)
install(FILES
"${CMAKE_BINARY_DIR}/${QTERMWIDGET_LIBRARY_NAME}-config.cmake"
"${CMAKE_SOURCE_DIR}/cmake/${QTERMWIDGET_LIBRARY_NAME}_use.cmake"
DESTINATION "${CMAKE_INSTALL_DATADIR}/cmake/${QTERMWIDGET_LIBRARY_NAME}"
)
# end of main library
# designer plugin
if (BUILD_DESIGNER_PLUGIN)
if(USE_QT5)
message(FATAL_ERROR "Building Qt designer plugin is not supported for Qt5 yet. Use -DBUILD_DESIGNER_PLUGIN=0")
endif()
message(STATUS "Building Qt designer plugin")
include_directories(designer "${QT_QTDESIGNER_INCLUDE_DIR}")
set(DESIGNER_SRC lib/designer/qtermwidgetplugin.cpp)
qt4_wrap_cpp(DESIGNER_MOC lib/designer/qtermwidgetplugin.h)
qt4_add_resources(DESIGNER_QRC lib/designer/qtermwidgetplugin.qrc)
link_directories(${CMAKE_BINARY_DIR})
add_library(qtermwidget4plugin SHARED
${DESIGNER_MOC}
${DESIGNER_QRC}
${DESIGNER_SRC}
)
add_dependencies(qtermwidget4plugin qtermwidget4)
target_link_libraries(qtermwidget4plugin
${QT_QTCORE_LIBRARY}
${QT_QTDESIGNER_LIBRARY}
${QT_QTDESIGNERCOMPONENTS_LIBRARY}
${QTERMWIDGET_LIBRARY_NAME}
)
if(APPLE)
# this is a must to load the lib correctly
set_target_properties(qtermwidget4plugin PROPERTIES
INSTALL_NAME_DIR "${CMAKE_INSTALL_PREFIX}/lib${LIB_SUFFIX}/qt4/plugins/designer"
)
endif()
install(TARGETS qtermwidget4plugin DESTINATION "${CMAKE_INSTALL_PREFIX}/lib${LIB_SUFFIX}/qt4/plugins/designer")
endif (BUILD_DESIGNER_PLUGIN)
# end of designer plugin
# test application
if(BUILD_TEST)
set(TEST_SRC src/main.cpp)
add_executable(test ${TEST_SRC})
add_dependencies(test ${QTERMWIDGET_LIBRARY_NAME})
link_directories(${CMAKE_BINARY_DIR})
target_link_libraries(test ${QTERMWIDGET_QT_LIBRARIES} ${QTERMWIDGET_LIBRARY_NAME} util)
endif (BUILD_TEST)
# end of test application
CONFIGURE_FILE(
"${CMAKE_CURRENT_SOURCE_DIR}/cmake/cmake_uninstall.cmake.in"
"${CMAKE_CURRENT_BINARY_DIR}/cmake_uninstall.cmake"
IMMEDIATE @ONLY
)
ADD_CUSTOM_TARGET(uninstall
"${CMAKE_COMMAND}" -P "${CMAKE_CURRENT_BINARY_DIR}/cmake_uninstall.cmake"
)
# make dist custom target
SET(CPACK_PACKAGE_NAME "qtermwidget")
# TODO/FIXME: versioning from player subdir... I don't know why it's separated...
SET(CPACK_PACKAGE_VERSION ${QTERMWIDGET_VERSION_MAJOR}.${QTERMWIDGET_VERSION_MINOR}.${QTERMWIDGET_VERSION_PATCH})
SET(CPACK_SOURCE_GENERATOR "TGZ;TBZ2")
SET(CPACK_SOURCE_PACKAGE_FILE_NAME "${CPACK_PACKAGE_NAME}-${CPACK_PACKAGE_VERSION}")
SET(CPACK_IGNORE_FILES "/\\\\.git/;\\\\.swp$;\\\\.#;/#;\\\\.tar.gz$;/CMakeFiles/;CMakeCache.txt;\\\\.qm$;/build/;\\\\.diff$;.DS_Store'")
SET(CPACK_SOURCE_IGNORE_FILES ${CPACK_IGNORE_FILES})
INCLUDE(CPack)
# simulate autotools' "make dist"
add_custom_target(dist COMMAND ${CMAKE_MAKE_PROGRAM} package_source)

@ -0,0 +1,339 @@
GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
Version 2, June 1991
Copyright (C) 1989, 1991 Free Software Foundation, Inc.,
51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies
of this license document, but changing it is not allowed.
Preamble
The licenses for most software are designed to take away your
freedom to share and change it. By contrast, the GNU General Public
License is intended to guarantee your freedom to share and change free
software--to make sure the software is free for all its users. This
General Public License applies to most of the Free Software
Foundation's software and to any other program whose authors commit to
using it. (Some other Free Software Foundation software is covered by
the GNU Lesser General Public License instead.) You can apply it to
your programs, too.
When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom, not
price. Our General Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you
have the freedom to distribute copies of free software (and charge for
this service if you wish), that you receive source code or can get it
if you want it, that you can change the software or use pieces of it
in new free programs; and that you know you can do these things.
To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that forbid
anyone to deny you these rights or to ask you to surrender the rights.
These restrictions translate to certain responsibilities for you if you
distribute copies of the software, or if you modify it.
For example, if you distribute copies of such a program, whether
gratis or for a fee, you must give the recipients all the rights that
you have. You must make sure that they, too, receive or can get the
source code. And you must show them these terms so they know their
rights.
We protect your rights with two steps: (1) copyright the software, and
(2) offer you this license which gives you legal permission to copy,
distribute and/or modify the software.
Also, for each author's protection and ours, we want to make certain
that everyone understands that there is no warranty for this free
software. If the software is modified by someone else and passed on, we
want its recipients to know that what they have is not the original, so
that any problems introduced by others will not reflect on the original
authors' reputations.
Finally, any free program is threatened constantly by software
patents. We wish to avoid the danger that redistributors of a free
program will individually obtain patent licenses, in effect making the
program proprietary. To prevent this, we have made it clear that any
patent must be licensed for everyone's free use or not licensed at all.
The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and
modification follow.
GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION AND MODIFICATION
0. This License applies to any program or other work which contains
a notice placed by the copyright holder saying it may be distributed
under the terms of this General Public License. The "Program", below,
refers to any such program or work, and a "work based on the Program"
means either the Program or any derivative work under copyright law:
that is to say, a work containing the Program or a portion of it,
either verbatim or with modifications and/or translated into another
language. (Hereinafter, translation is included without limitation in
the term "modification".) Each licensee is addressed as "you".
Activities other than copying, distribution and modification are not
covered by this License; they are outside its scope. The act of
running the Program is not restricted, and the output from the Program
is covered only if its contents constitute a work based on the
Program (independent of having been made by running the Program).
Whether that is true depends on what the Program does.
1. You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the Program's
source code as you receive it, in any medium, provided that you
conspicuously and appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate
copyright notice and disclaimer of warranty; keep intact all the
notices that refer to this License and to the absence of any warranty;
and give any other recipients of the Program a copy of this License
along with the Program.
You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring a copy, and
you may at your option offer warranty protection in exchange for a fee.
2. You may modify your copy or copies of the Program or any portion
of it, thus forming a work based on the Program, and copy and
distribute such modifications or work under the terms of Section 1
above, provided that you also meet all of these conditions:
a) You must cause the modified files to carry prominent notices
stating that you changed the files and the date of any change.
b) You must cause any work that you distribute or publish, that in
whole or in part contains or is derived from the Program or any
part thereof, to be licensed as a whole at no charge to all third
parties under the terms of this License.
c) If the modified program normally reads commands interactively
when run, you must cause it, when started running for such
interactive use in the most ordinary way, to print or display an
announcement including an appropriate copyright notice and a
notice that there is no warranty (or else, saying that you provide
a warranty) and that users may redistribute the program under
these conditions, and telling the user how to view a copy of this
License. (Exception: if the Program itself is interactive but
does not normally print such an announcement, your work based on
the Program is not required to print an announcement.)
These requirements apply to the modified work as a whole. If
identifiable sections of that work are not derived from the Program,
and can be reasonably considered independent and separate works in
themselves, then this License, and its terms, do not apply to those
sections when you distribute them as separate works. But when you
distribute the same sections as part of a whole which is a work based
on the Program, the distribution of the whole must be on the terms of
this License, whose permissions for other licensees extend to the
entire whole, and thus to each and every part regardless of who wrote it.
Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim rights or contest
your rights to work written entirely by you; rather, the intent is to
exercise the right to control the distribution of derivative or
collective works based on the Program.
In addition, mere aggregation of another work not based on the Program
with the Program (or with a work based on the Program) on a volume of
a storage or distribution medium does not bring the other work under
the scope of this License.
3. You may copy and distribute the Program (or a work based on it,
under Section 2) in object code or executable form under the terms of
Sections 1 and 2 above provided that you also do one of the following:
a) Accompany it with the complete corresponding machine-readable
source code, which must be distributed under the terms of Sections
1 and 2 above on a medium customarily used for software interchange; or,
b) Accompany it with a written offer, valid for at least three
years, to give any third party, for a charge no more than your
cost of physically performing source distribution, a complete
machine-readable copy of the corresponding source code, to be
distributed under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above on a medium
customarily used for software interchange; or,
c) Accompany it with the information you received as to the offer
to distribute corresponding source code. (This alternative is
allowed only for noncommercial distribution and only if you
received the program in object code or executable form with such
an offer, in accord with Subsection b above.)
The source code for a work means the preferred form of the work for
making modifications to it. For an executable work, complete source
code means all the source code for all modules it contains, plus any
associated interface definition files, plus the scripts used to
control compilation and installation of the executable. However, as a
special exception, the source code distributed need not include
anything that is normally distributed (in either source or binary
form) with the major components (compiler, kernel, and so on) of the
operating system on which the executable runs, unless that component
itself accompanies the executable.
If distribution of executable or object code is made by offering
access to copy from a designated place, then offering equivalent
access to copy the source code from the same place counts as
distribution of the source code, even though third parties are not
compelled to copy the source along with the object code.
4. You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Program
except as expressly provided under this License. Any attempt
otherwise to copy, modify, sublicense or distribute the Program is
void, and will automatically terminate your rights under this License.
However, parties who have received copies, or rights, from you under
this License will not have their licenses terminated so long as such
parties remain in full compliance.
5. You are not required to accept this License, since you have not
signed it. However, nothing else grants you permission to modify or
distribute the Program or its derivative works. These actions are
prohibited by law if you do not accept this License. Therefore, by
modifying or distributing the Program (or any work based on the
Program), you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so, and
all its terms and conditions for copying, distributing or modifying
the Program or works based on it.
6. Each time you redistribute the Program (or any work based on the
Program), the recipient automatically receives a license from the
original licensor to copy, distribute or modify the Program subject to
these terms and conditions. You may not impose any further
restrictions on the recipients' exercise of the rights granted herein.
You are not responsible for enforcing compliance by third parties to
this License.
7. If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation of patent
infringement or for any other reason (not limited to patent issues),
conditions are imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or
otherwise) that contradict the conditions of this License, they do not
excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you cannot
distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this
License and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you
may not distribute the Program at all. For example, if a patent
license would not permit royalty-free redistribution of the Program by
all those who receive copies directly or indirectly through you, then
the only way you could satisfy both it and this License would be to
refrain entirely from distribution of the Program.
If any portion of this section is held invalid or unenforceable under
any particular circumstance, the balance of the section is intended to
apply and the section as a whole is intended to apply in other
circumstances.
It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to infringe any
patents or other property right claims or to contest validity of any
such claims; this section has the sole purpose of protecting the
integrity of the free software distribution system, which is
implemented by public license practices. Many people have made
generous contributions to the wide range of software distributed
through that system in reliance on consistent application of that
system; it is up to the author/donor to decide if he or she is willing
to distribute software through any other system and a licensee cannot
impose that choice.
This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what is believed to
be a consequence of the rest of this License.
8. If the distribution and/or use of the Program is restricted in
certain countries either by patents or by copyrighted interfaces, the
original copyright holder who places the Program under this License
may add an explicit geographical distribution limitation excluding
those countries, so that distribution is permitted only in or among
countries not thus excluded. In such case, this License incorporates
the limitation as if written in the body of this License.
9. The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions
of the General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will
be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to
address new problems or concerns.
Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the Program
specifies a version number of this License which applies to it and "any
later version", you have the option of following the terms and conditions
either of that version or of any later version published by the Free
Software Foundation. If the Program does not specify a version number of
this License, you may choose any version ever published by the Free Software
Foundation.
10. If you wish to incorporate parts of the Program into other free
programs whose distribution conditions are different, write to the author
to ask for permission. For software which is copyrighted by the Free
Software Foundation, write to the Free Software Foundation; we sometimes
make exceptions for this. Our decision will be guided by the two goals
of preserving the free status of all derivatives of our free software and
of promoting the sharing and reuse of software generally.
NO WARRANTY
11. BECAUSE THE PROGRAM IS LICENSED FREE OF CHARGE, THERE IS NO WARRANTY
FOR THE PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN
OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES
PROVIDE THE PROGRAM "AS IS" WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED
OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS
TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE
PROGRAM PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL NECESSARY SERVICING,
REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
12. IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING
WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MAY MODIFY AND/OR
REDISTRIBUTE THE PROGRAM AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES,
INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING
OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED
TO LOSS OF DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY
YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER
PROGRAMS), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
How to Apply These Terms to Your New Programs
If you develop a new program, and you want it to be of the greatest
possible use to the public, the best way to achieve this is to make it
free software which everyone can redistribute and change under these terms.
To do so, attach the following notices to the program. It is safest
to attach them to the start of each source file to most effectively
convey the exclusion of warranty; and each file should have at least
the "copyright" line and a pointer to where the full notice is found.
<one line to give the program's name and a brief idea of what it does.>
Copyright (C) <year> <name of author>
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
(at your option) any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation, Inc.,
51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA.
Also add information on how to contact you by electronic and paper mail.
If the program is interactive, make it output a short notice like this
when it starts in an interactive mode:
Gnomovision version 69, Copyright (C) year name of author
Gnomovision comes with ABSOLUTELY NO WARRANTY; for details type `show w'.
This is free software, and you are welcome to redistribute it
under certain conditions; type `show c' for details.
The hypothetical commands `show w' and `show c' should show the appropriate
parts of the General Public License. Of course, the commands you use may
be called something other than `show w' and `show c'; they could even be
mouse-clicks or menu items--whatever suits your program.
You should also get your employer (if you work as a programmer) or your
school, if any, to sign a "copyright disclaimer" for the program, if
necessary. Here is a sample; alter the names:
Yoyodyne, Inc., hereby disclaims all copyright interest in the program
`Gnomovision' (which makes passes at compilers) written by James Hacker.
<signature of Ty Coon>, 1 April 1989
Ty Coon, President of Vice
This General Public License does not permit incorporating your program into
proprietary programs. If your program is a subroutine library, you may
consider it more useful to permit linking proprietary applications with the
library. If this is what you want to do, use the GNU Lesser General
Public License instead of this License.

@ -0,0 +1,27 @@
0.6.0 (2014-10-21)
* Full Qt4 + Qt5 support
* Fixed Ctrl+Arrows in Linux emulation
* Fixed Drag & Drop support
## Old changelog
31.07.2008
Interface class from c-style conversions rewritten with pimpl support.
16.07.2008
Added optional scrollbar
06.06.2008
Some artefacts were removed, some added...
Also added support for color schemes, and 3 color schemes provided (classical - white on black, green on black, black on light yellow). Is it enough or not?
26.05.2008
Added file release as an archive with source code. But preferrable way is still getting code from CVS, cause file release can be outdated.
11.05.2008
Initial CVS import - first version comes with number 0.0.1

@ -0,0 +1,23 @@
Requirements:
Qt4 or Qt5
cmake
Supported (tested) platforms:
Linux
*BSD
Mac OS X
Build:
A shadow build (out of source) is strongly recommended
http://www.cmake.org/Wiki/CMake_FAQ#Out-of-source_build_trees
1) mkdir -p build && cd build
2a) cmake path/to/source -DUSE_QT5=true # Qt 5
2b) cmake path/to/source # Qt 4 only
3) make
4) optional: make install
Read cmake docs to fine tune the build process (CMAKE_INSTALL_PREFIX, etc...)

@ -0,0 +1,10 @@
QTermWidget is an opensource project originally based on KDE4 Konsole application,
but it took its own direction later.
The main goal of this project is to provide unicode-enabled, embeddable
Qt widget for using as a built-in console (or terminal emulation widget).
Current maintainer: Petr Vanek <petr@yarpen.cz>
License: GPLv2+

@ -0,0 +1,23 @@
IF(NOT EXISTS "@CMAKE_CURRENT_BINARY_DIR@/install_manifest.txt")
MESSAGE(FATAL_ERROR "Cannot find install manifest: \"@CMAKE_CURRENT_BINARY_DIR@/install_manifest.txt\"")
ENDIF(NOT EXISTS "@CMAKE_CURRENT_BINARY_DIR@/install_manifest.txt")
# this works on Linux, but not on mac.
#FILE(READ "@CMAKE_CURRENT_BINARY_DIR@/install_manifest.txt" files)
#STRING(REGEX REPLACE "\n" ";" files "${files}")
#FOREACH(file ${files})
# MESSAGE(STATUS "Uninstalling \"${file}\"")
# IF(NOT EXISTS "${file}")
# MESSAGE(FATAL_ERROR "File \"${file}\" does not exists.")
# ENDIF(NOT EXISTS "${file}")
# EXEC_PROGRAM("@CMAKE_COMMAND@" ARGS "-E remove \"${file}\""
# OUTPUT_VARIABLE rm_out
# RETURN_VARIABLE rm_retval)
# IF("${rm_retval}" GREATER 0)
# MESSAGE(FATAL_ERROR "Problem when removing \"${file}\"")
# ENDIF("${rm_retval}" GREATER 0)
#ENDFOREACH(file)
EXEC_PROGRAM("xargs rm < @CMAKE_BINARY_DIR@/install_manifest.txt"
OUTPUT_VARIABLE rm_out
RETURN_VARIABLE rm_ret)

@ -0,0 +1,29 @@
#
# Write a pkg-config pc file for given "name" with "decription"
# Arguments:
# name: a library name (withoud "lib" prefix and "so" suffixes
# desc: a desription string
# requires: required libraries
# include_rel_dir: include directory, relative to includedir
# version: package version
#
macro (create_pkgconfig_file name desc requires include_rel_dir version)
set(_pkgfname "${CMAKE_CURRENT_BINARY_DIR}/${name}.pc")
message(STATUS "${name}: writing pkgconfig file ${_pkgfname}")
file(WRITE "${_pkgfname}"
"prefix=${CMAKE_INSTALL_PREFIX}\n"
"libdir=\${prefix}/${CMAKE_INSTALL_LIBDIR}\n"
"includedir=\${prefix}/${CMAKE_INSTALL_INCLUDEDIR}\n"
"\n"
"Name: ${name}\n"
"Description: ${desc}\n"
"Version: ${version}\n"
"Requires: ${requires}\n"
"Libs: -L\${libdir} -l${name}\n"
"Cflags: -I\${includedir} -I\${includedir}/${include_rel_dir}\n"
"\n"
)
install(FILES ${_pkgfname} DESTINATION ${CMAKE_INSTALL_LIBDIR}/pkgconfig)
endmacro()

@ -0,0 +1,47 @@
# - Find the QTermWidget include and library dirs and define a some macros
#
# The module defines the following variables
# QTERMWIDGET_FOUND - Set to TRUE if all of the above has been found
#
# QTERMWIDGET_INCLUDE_DIR - The QTermWidget include directory
#
# QTERMWIDGET_INCLUDE_DIRS - The QTermWidget include directory
#
# QTERMWIDGET_LIBRARIES - The libraries needed to use QTermWidget
#
# QTERMWIDGET_USE_FILE - The variable QTERMWIDGET_USE_FILE is set which is the path
# to a CMake file that can be included to compile qtermwidget
# applications and libraries. It sets up the compilation
# environment for include directories and populates a
# QTERMWIDGET_LIBRARIES variable.
#
# QTERMWIDGET_QT_LIBRARIES - The Qt libraries needed by QTermWidget
#
# Typical usage:
# option(USE_QT5 "Build using Qt5. Default off" OFF)
# if (USE_QT5)
# find_package(QTERMWIDGET4)
# else()
# find_package(QTERMWIDGET5)
# endif()
#
# include(${QTERMWIDGET_USE_FILE})
# add_executable(foo main.cpp)
# target_link_libraries(foo ${QTERMWIDGET_QT_LIBRARIES} ${QTERMWIDGET_LIBRARIES})
set(QTERMWIDGET_INCLUDE_DIR @QTERMWIDGET_INCLUDE_DIR@)
set(QTERMWIDGET_LIBRARY @QTERMWIDGET_LIBRARY_NAME@)
set(QTERMWIDGET_LIBRARIES ${QTERMWIDGET_LIBRARY})
set(QTERMWIDGET_INCLUDE_DIRS "${QTERMWIDGET_INCLUDE_DIR}")
set(QTERMWIDGET_USE_FILE "${CMAKE_CURRENT_LIST_DIR}/qtermwidget4_use.cmake")
set(QTERMWIDGET_FOUND 1)
set(QTERMWIDGET_VERSION_MAJOR @QTERMWIDGET_VERSION_MAJOR@)
set(QTERMWIDGET_VERSION_MINOR @QTERMWIDGET_VERSION_MINOR@)
set(QTERMWIDGET_VERSION_PATCH @QTERMWIDGET_VERSION_PATCH@)
set(QTERMWIDGET_VERSION @QTERMWIDGET_VERSION@)
mark_as_advanced(QTERMWIDGET_LIBRARY QTERMWIDGET_INCLUDE_DIR)

@ -0,0 +1,8 @@
find_package(Qt4 REQUIRED QUIET)
include(${QT_USE_FILE})
set(QTERMWIDGET_QT_LIBRARIES ${QT_LIBRARIES})
include_directories(${QTERMWIDGET_INCLUDE_DIRS})

@ -0,0 +1,47 @@
# - Find the QTermWidget include and library dirs and define a some macros
#
# The module defines the following variables
# QTERMWIDGET_FOUND - Set to TRUE if all of the above has been found
#
# QTERMWIDGET_INCLUDE_DIR - The QTermWidget include directory
#
# QTERMWIDGET_INCLUDE_DIRS - The QTermWidget include directory
#
# QTERMWIDGET_LIBRARIES - The libraries needed to use QTermWidget
#
# QTERMWIDGET_USE_FILE - The variable QTERMWIDGET_USE_FILE is set which is the path
# to a CMake file that can be included to compile qtermwidget
# applications and libraries. It sets up the compilation
# environment for include directories and populates a
# QTERMWIDGET_LIBRARIES variable.
#
# QTERMWIDGET_QT_LIBRARIES - The Qt libraries needed by QTermWidget
#
# Typical usage:
# option(USE_QT5 "Build using Qt5. Default off" OFF)
# if (USE_QT5)
# find_package(QTERMWIDGET4)
# else()
# find_package(QTERMWIDGET5)
# endif()
#
# include(${QTERMWIDGET_USE_FILE})
# add_executable(foo main.cpp)
# target_link_libraries(foo ${QTERMWIDGET_QT_LIBRARIES} ${QTERMWIDGET_LIBRARIES})
set(QTERMWIDGET_INCLUDE_DIR @QTERMWIDGET_INCLUDE_DIR@)
set(QTERMWIDGET_LIBRARY @QTERMWIDGET_LIBRARY_NAME@)
set(QTERMWIDGET_LIBRARIES ${QTERMWIDGET_LIBRARY})
set(QTERMWIDGET_INCLUDE_DIRS "${QTERMWIDGET_INCLUDE_DIR}")
set(QTERMWIDGET_USE_FILE "${CMAKE_CURRENT_LIST_DIR}/qtermwidget5_use.cmake")
set(QTERMWIDGET_FOUND 1)
set(QTERMWIDGET_VERSION_MAJOR @QTERMWIDGET_VERSION_MAJOR@)
set(QTERMWIDGET_VERSION_MINOR @QTERMWIDGET_VERSION_MINOR@)
set(QTERMWIDGET_VERSION_PATCH @QTERMWIDGET_VERSION_PATCH@)
set(QTERMWIDGET_VERSION @QTERMWIDGET_VERSION@)
mark_as_advanced(QTERMWIDGET_LIBRARY QTERMWIDGET_INCLUDE_DIR)

@ -0,0 +1,9 @@
find_package(Qt5Widgets REQUIRED)
include_directories(${Qt5Widgets_INCLUDE_DIRS})
add_definitions(${Qt5Core_DEFINITIONS})
set(CMAKE_CXX_FLAGS "${CMAKE_CXX_FLAGS} ${Qt5Widgets_EXECUTABLE_COMPILE_FLAGS}")
set(QTERMWIDGET_QT_LIBRARIES ${Qt5Widgets_LIBRARIES})
include_directories(${QTERMWIDGET_INCLUDE_DIRS})

@ -0,0 +1,379 @@
/*
This file is part of Konsole, an X terminal.
Copyright (C) 2000 by Stephan Kulow <coolo@kde.org>
Rewritten for QT4 by e_k <e_k at users.sourceforge.net>, Copyright (C)2008
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
(at your option) any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
02110-1301 USA.
*/
#include <QtDebug>
// Own
#include "BlockArray.h"
// System
#include <assert.h>
#include <sys/mman.h>
#include <sys/param.h>
#include <unistd.h>
#include <stdio.h>
using namespace Konsole;
static int blocksize = 0;
BlockArray::BlockArray()
: size(0),
current(size_t(-1)),
index(size_t(-1)),
lastmap(0),
lastmap_index(size_t(-1)),
lastblock(0), ion(-1),
length(0)
{
// lastmap_index = index = current = size_t(-1);
if (blocksize == 0) {
blocksize = ((sizeof(Block) / getpagesize()) + 1) * getpagesize();
}
}
BlockArray::~BlockArray()
{
setHistorySize(0);
assert(!lastblock);
}
size_t BlockArray::append(Block * block)
{
if (!size) {
return size_t(-1);
}
++current;
if (current >= size) {
current = 0;
}
int rc;
rc = lseek(ion, current * blocksize, SEEK_SET);
if (rc < 0) {
perror("HistoryBuffer::add.seek");
setHistorySize(0);
return size_t(-1);
}
rc = write(ion, block, blocksize);
if (rc < 0) {
perror("HistoryBuffer::add.write");
setHistorySize(0);
return size_t(-1);
}
length++;
if (length > size) {
length = size;
}
++index;
delete block;
return current;
}
size_t BlockArray::newBlock()
{
if (!size) {
return size_t(-1);
}
append(lastblock);
lastblock = new Block();
return index + 1;
}
Block * BlockArray::lastBlock() const
{
return lastblock;
}
bool BlockArray::has(size_t i) const
{
if (i == index + 1) {
return true;
}
if (i > index) {
return false;
}
if (index - i >= length) {
return false;
}
return true;
}
const Block * BlockArray::at(size_t i)
{
if (i == index + 1) {
return lastblock;
}
if (i == lastmap_index) {
return lastmap;
}
if (i > index) {
qDebug() << "BlockArray::at() i > index\n";
return 0;
}
// if (index - i >= length) {
// kDebug(1211) << "BlockArray::at() index - i >= length\n";
// return 0;
// }
size_t j = i; // (current - (index - i) + (index/size+1)*size) % size ;
assert(j < size);
unmap();
Block * block = (Block *)mmap(0, blocksize, PROT_READ, MAP_PRIVATE, ion, j * blocksize);
if (block == (Block *)-1) {
perror("mmap");
return 0;
}
lastmap = block;
lastmap_index = i;
return block;
}
void BlockArray::unmap()
{
if (lastmap) {
int res = munmap((char *)lastmap, blocksize);
if (res < 0) {
perror("munmap");
}
}
lastmap = 0;
lastmap_index = size_t(-1);
}
bool BlockArray::setSize(size_t newsize)
{
return setHistorySize(newsize * 1024 / blocksize);
}
bool BlockArray::setHistorySize(size_t newsize)
{
// kDebug(1211) << "setHistorySize " << size << " " << newsize;
if (size == newsize) {
return false;
}
unmap();
if (!newsize) {
delete lastblock;
lastblock = 0;
if (ion >= 0) {
close(ion);
}
ion = -1;
current = size_t(-1);
return true;
}
if (!size) {
FILE * tmp = tmpfile();
if (!tmp) {
perror("konsole: cannot open temp file.\n");
} else {
ion = dup(fileno(tmp));
if (ion<0) {
perror("konsole: cannot dup temp file.\n");
fclose(tmp);
}
}
if (ion < 0) {
return false;
}
assert(!lastblock);
lastblock = new Block();
size = newsize;
return false;
}
if (newsize > size) {
increaseBuffer();
size = newsize;
return false;
} else {
decreaseBuffer(newsize);
ftruncate(ion, length*blocksize);
size = newsize;
return true;
}
}
void moveBlock(FILE * fion, int cursor, int newpos, char * buffer2)
{
int res = fseek(fion, cursor * blocksize, SEEK_SET);
if (res) {
perror("fseek");
}
res = fread(buffer2, blocksize, 1, fion);
if (res != 1) {
perror("fread");
}
res = fseek(fion, newpos * blocksize, SEEK_SET);
if (res) {
perror("fseek");
}
res = fwrite(buffer2, blocksize, 1, fion);
if (res != 1) {
perror("fwrite");
}
// printf("moving block %d to %d\n", cursor, newpos);
}
void BlockArray::decreaseBuffer(size_t newsize)
{
if (index < newsize) { // still fits in whole
return;
}
int offset = (current - (newsize - 1) + size) % size;
if (!offset) {
return;
}
// The Block constructor could do somthing in future...
char * buffer1 = new char[blocksize];
FILE * fion = fdopen(dup(ion), "w+b");
if (!fion) {
delete [] buffer1;
perror("fdopen/dup");
return;
}
int firstblock;
if (current <= newsize) {
firstblock = current + 1;
} else {
firstblock = 0;
}
size_t oldpos;
for (size_t i = 0, cursor=firstblock; i < newsize; i++) {
oldpos = (size + cursor + offset) % size;
moveBlock(fion, oldpos, cursor, buffer1);
if (oldpos < newsize) {
cursor = oldpos;
} else {
cursor++;
}
}
current = newsize - 1;
length = newsize;
delete [] buffer1;
fclose(fion);
}
void BlockArray::increaseBuffer()
{
if (index < size) { // not even wrapped once
return;
}
int offset = (current + size + 1) % size;
if (!offset) { // no moving needed
return;
}
// The Block constructor could do somthing in future...
char * buffer1 = new char[blocksize];
char * buffer2 = new char[blocksize];
int runs = 1;
int bpr = size; // blocks per run
if (size % offset == 0) {
bpr = size / offset;
runs = offset;
}
FILE * fion = fdopen(dup(ion), "w+b");
if (!fion) {
perror("fdopen/dup");
delete [] buffer1;
delete [] buffer2;
return;
}
int res;
for (int i = 0; i < runs; i++) {
// free one block in chain
int firstblock = (offset + i) % size;
res = fseek(fion, firstblock * blocksize, SEEK_SET);
if (res) {
perror("fseek");
}
res = fread(buffer1, blocksize, 1, fion);
if (res != 1) {
perror("fread");
}
int newpos = 0;
for (int j = 1, cursor=firstblock; j < bpr; j++) {
cursor = (cursor + offset) % size;
newpos = (cursor - offset + size) % size;
moveBlock(fion, cursor, newpos, buffer2);
}
res = fseek(fion, i * blocksize, SEEK_SET);
if (res) {
perror("fseek");
}
res = fwrite(buffer1, blocksize, 1, fion);
if (res != 1) {
perror("fwrite");
}
}
current = size - 1;
length = size;
delete [] buffer1;
delete [] buffer2;
fclose(fion);
}

@ -0,0 +1,130 @@
/*
This file is part of Konsole, an X terminal.
Copyright (C) 2000 by Stephan Kulow <coolo@kde.org>
Rewritten for QT4 by e_k <e_k at users.sourceforge.net>, Copyright (C)2008
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
(at your option) any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
02110-1301 USA.
*/
#ifndef BLOCKARRAY_H
#define BLOCKARRAY_H
#include <unistd.h>
//#error Do not use in KDE 2.1
#define BlockSize (1 << 12)
#define ENTRIES ((BlockSize - sizeof(size_t) ) / sizeof(unsigned char))
namespace Konsole {
struct Block {
Block() {
size = 0;
}
unsigned char data[ENTRIES];
size_t size;
};
// ///////////////////////////////////////////////////////
class BlockArray {
public:
/**
* Creates a history file for holding
* maximal size blocks. If more blocks
* are requested, then it drops earlier
* added ones.
*/
BlockArray();
/// destructor
~BlockArray();
/**
* adds the Block at the end of history.
* This may drop other blocks.
*
* The ownership on the block is transfered.
* An unique index number is returned for accessing
* it later (if not yet dropped then)
*
* Note, that the block may be dropped completely
* if history is turned off.
*/
size_t append(Block * block);
/**
* gets the block at the index. Function may return
* 0 if the block isn't available any more.
*
* The returned block is strictly readonly as only
* maped in memory - and will be invalid on the next
* operation on this class.
*/
const Block * at(size_t index);
/**
* reorders blocks as needed. If newsize is null,
* the history is emptied completely. The indices
* returned on append won't change their semantic,
* but they may not be valid after this call.
*/
bool setHistorySize(size_t newsize);
size_t newBlock();
Block * lastBlock() const;
/**
* Convenient function to set the size in KBytes
* instead of blocks
*/
bool setSize(size_t newsize);
size_t len() const {
return length;
}
bool has(size_t index) const;
size_t getCurrent() const {
return current;
}
private:
void unmap();
void increaseBuffer();
void decreaseBuffer(size_t newsize);
size_t size;
// current always shows to the last inserted block
size_t current;
size_t index;
Block * lastmap;
size_t lastmap_index;
Block * lastblock;
int ion;
size_t length;
};
}
#endif

@ -0,0 +1,224 @@
/*
This file is part of Konsole, KDE's terminal.
Copyright 2007-2008 by Robert Knight <robertknight@gmail.com>
Copyright 1997,1998 by Lars Doelle <lars.doelle@on-line.de>
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
(at your option) any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
02110-1301 USA.
*/
#ifndef CHARACTER_H
#define CHARACTER_H
// Qt
#include <QHash>
// Local
#include "CharacterColor.h"
namespace Konsole
{
typedef unsigned char LineProperty;
static const int LINE_DEFAULT = 0;
static const int LINE_WRAPPED = (1 << 0);
static const int LINE_DOUBLEWIDTH = (1 << 1);
static const int LINE_DOUBLEHEIGHT = (1 << 2);
#define DEFAULT_RENDITION 0
#define RE_BOLD (1 << 0)
#define RE_BLINK (1 << 1)
#define RE_UNDERLINE (1 << 2)
#define RE_REVERSE (1 << 3) // Screen only
#define RE_INTENSIVE (1 << 3) // Widget only
#define RE_CURSOR (1 << 4)
#define RE_EXTENDED_CHAR (1 << 5)
/**
* A single character in the terminal which consists of a unicode character
* value, foreground and background colors and a set of rendition attributes
* which specify how it should be drawn.
*/
class Character
{
public:
/**
* Constructs a new character.
*
* @param _c The unicode character value of this character.
* @param _f The foreground color used to draw the character.
* @param _b The color used to draw the character's background.
* @param _r A set of rendition flags which specify how this character is to be drawn.
*/
inline Character(quint16 _c = ' ',
CharacterColor _f = CharacterColor(COLOR_SPACE_DEFAULT,DEFAULT_FORE_COLOR),
CharacterColor _b = CharacterColor(COLOR_SPACE_DEFAULT,DEFAULT_BACK_COLOR),
quint8 _r = DEFAULT_RENDITION)
: character(_c), rendition(_r), foregroundColor(_f), backgroundColor(_b) {}
union
{
/** The unicode character value for this character. */
quint16 character;
/**
* Experimental addition which allows a single Character instance to contain more than
* one unicode character.
*
* charSequence is a hash code which can be used to look up the unicode
* character sequence in the ExtendedCharTable used to create the sequence.
*/
quint16 charSequence;
};
/** A combination of RENDITION flags which specify options for drawing the character. */
quint8 rendition;
/** The foreground color used to draw this character. */
CharacterColor foregroundColor;
/** The color used to draw this character's background. */
CharacterColor backgroundColor;
/**
* Returns true if this character has a transparent background when
* it is drawn with the specified @p palette.
*/
bool isTransparent(const ColorEntry* palette) const;
/**
* Returns true if this character should always be drawn in bold when
* it is drawn with the specified @p palette, independent of whether
* or not the character has the RE_BOLD rendition flag.
*/
ColorEntry::FontWeight fontWeight(const ColorEntry* base) const;
/**
* returns true if the format (color, rendition flag) of the compared characters is equal
*/
bool equalsFormat(const Character &other) const;
/**
* Compares two characters and returns true if they have the same unicode character value,
* rendition and colors.
*/
friend bool operator == (const Character& a, const Character& b);
/**
* Compares two characters and returns true if they have different unicode character values,
* renditions or colors.
*/
friend bool operator != (const Character& a, const Character& b);
};
inline bool operator == (const Character& a, const Character& b)
{
return a.character == b.character &&
a.rendition == b.rendition &&
a.foregroundColor == b.foregroundColor &&
a.backgroundColor == b.backgroundColor;
}
inline bool operator != (const Character& a, const Character& b)
{
return a.character != b.character ||
a.rendition != b.rendition ||
a.foregroundColor != b.foregroundColor ||
a.backgroundColor != b.backgroundColor;
}
inline bool Character::isTransparent(const ColorEntry* base) const
{
return ((backgroundColor._colorSpace == COLOR_SPACE_DEFAULT) &&
base[backgroundColor._u+0+(backgroundColor._v?BASE_COLORS:0)].transparent)
|| ((backgroundColor._colorSpace == COLOR_SPACE_SYSTEM) &&
base[backgroundColor._u+2+(backgroundColor._v?BASE_COLORS:0)].transparent);
}
inline bool Character::equalsFormat(const Character& other) const
{
return
backgroundColor==other.backgroundColor &&
foregroundColor==other.foregroundColor &&
rendition==other.rendition;
}
inline ColorEntry::FontWeight Character::fontWeight(const ColorEntry* base) const
{
if (backgroundColor._colorSpace == COLOR_SPACE_DEFAULT)
return base[backgroundColor._u+0+(backgroundColor._v?BASE_COLORS:0)].fontWeight;
else if (backgroundColor._colorSpace == COLOR_SPACE_SYSTEM)
return base[backgroundColor._u+2+(backgroundColor._v?BASE_COLORS:0)].fontWeight;
else
return ColorEntry::UseCurrentFormat;
}
extern unsigned short vt100_graphics[32];
/**
* A table which stores sequences of unicode characters, referenced
* by hash keys. The hash key itself is the same size as a unicode
* character ( ushort ) so that it can occupy the same space in
* a structure.
*/
class ExtendedCharTable
{
public:
/** Constructs a new character table. */
ExtendedCharTable();
~ExtendedCharTable();
/**
* Adds a sequences of unicode characters to the table and returns
* a hash code which can be used later to look up the sequence
* using lookupExtendedChar()
*
* If the same sequence already exists in the table, the hash
* of the existing sequence will be returned.
*
* @param unicodePoints An array of unicode character points
* @param length Length of @p unicodePoints
*/
ushort createExtendedChar(ushort* unicodePoints , ushort length);
/**
* Looks up and returns a pointer to a sequence of unicode characters
* which was added to the table using createExtendedChar().
*
* @param hash The hash key returned by createExtendedChar()
* @param length This variable is set to the length of the
* character sequence.
*
* @return A unicode character sequence of size @p length.
*/
ushort* lookupExtendedChar(ushort hash , ushort& length) const;
/** The global ExtendedCharTable instance. */
static ExtendedCharTable instance;
private:
// calculates the hash key of a sequence of unicode points of size 'length'
ushort extendedCharHash(ushort* unicodePoints , ushort length) const;
// tests whether the entry in the table specified by 'hash' matches the
// character sequence 'unicodePoints' of size 'length'
bool extendedCharMatch(ushort hash , ushort* unicodePoints , ushort length) const;
// internal, maps hash keys to character sequence buffers. The first ushort
// in each value is the length of the buffer, followed by the ushorts in the buffer
// themselves.
QHash<ushort,ushort*> extendedCharTable;
};
}
Q_DECLARE_TYPEINFO(Konsole::Character, Q_MOVABLE_TYPE);
#endif // CHARACTER_H

@ -0,0 +1,299 @@
/*
This file is part of Konsole, KDE's terminal.
Copyright 2007-2008 by Robert Knight <robertknight@gmail.com>
Copyright 1997,1998 by Lars Doelle <lars.doelle@on-line.de>
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
(at your option) any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
02110-1301 USA.
*/
#ifndef CHARACTERCOLOR_H
#define CHARACTERCOLOR_H
// Qt
#include <QColor>
//#include <kdemacros.h>
#define KDE_NO_EXPORT
namespace Konsole
{
/**
* An entry in a terminal display's color palette.
*
* A color palette is an array of 16 ColorEntry instances which map
* system color indexes (from 0 to 15) into actual colors.
*
* Each entry can be set as bold, in which case any text
* drawn using the color should be drawn in bold.
*
* Each entry can also be transparent, in which case the terminal
* display should avoid drawing the background for any characters
* using the entry as a background.
*/
class ColorEntry
{
public:
/** Specifies the weight to use when drawing text with this color. */
enum FontWeight
{
/** Always draw text in this color with a bold weight. */
Bold,
/** Always draw text in this color with a normal weight. */
Normal,
/**
* Use the current font weight set by the terminal application.
* This is the default behavior.
*/
UseCurrentFormat
};
/**
* Constructs a new color palette entry.
*
* @param c The color value for this entry.
* @param tr Specifies that the color should be transparent when used as a background color.
* @param weight Specifies the font weight to use when drawing text with this color.
*/
ColorEntry(QColor c, bool tr, FontWeight weight = UseCurrentFormat)
: color(c), transparent(tr), fontWeight(weight) {}
/**
* Constructs a new color palette entry with an undefined color, and
* with the transparent and bold flags set to false.
*/
ColorEntry() : transparent(false), fontWeight(UseCurrentFormat) {}
/**
* Sets the color, transparency and boldness of this color to those of @p rhs.
*/
void operator=(const ColorEntry& rhs)
{
color = rhs.color;
transparent = rhs.transparent;
fontWeight = rhs.fontWeight;
}
/** The color value of this entry for display. */
QColor color;
/**
* If true character backgrounds using this color should be transparent.
* This is not applicable when the color is used to render text.
*/
bool transparent;
/**
* Specifies the font weight to use when drawing text with this color.
* This is not applicable when the color is used to draw a character's background.
*/
FontWeight fontWeight;
};
// Attributed Character Representations ///////////////////////////////
// Colors
#define BASE_COLORS (2+8)
#define INTENSITIES 2
#define TABLE_COLORS (INTENSITIES*BASE_COLORS)
#define DEFAULT_FORE_COLOR 0
#define DEFAULT_BACK_COLOR 1
//a standard set of colors using black text on a white background.
//defined in TerminalDisplay.cpp
extern const ColorEntry base_color_table[TABLE_COLORS] KDE_NO_EXPORT;
/* CharacterColor is a union of the various color spaces.
Assignment is as follows:
Type - Space - Values
0 - Undefined - u: 0, v:0 w:0
1 - Default - u: 0..1 v:intense w:0
2 - System - u: 0..7 v:intense w:0
3 - Index(256) - u: 16..255 v:0 w:0
4 - RGB - u: 0..255 v:0..256 w:0..256
Default colour space has two separate colours, namely
default foreground and default background colour.
*/
#define COLOR_SPACE_UNDEFINED 0
#define COLOR_SPACE_DEFAULT 1
#define COLOR_SPACE_SYSTEM 2
#define COLOR_SPACE_256 3
#define COLOR_SPACE_RGB 4
/**
* Describes the color of a single character in the terminal.
*/
class CharacterColor
{
friend class Character;
public:
/** Constructs a new CharacterColor whoose color and color space are undefined. */
CharacterColor()
: _colorSpace(COLOR_SPACE_UNDEFINED),
_u(0),
_v(0),
_w(0)
{}
/**
* Constructs a new CharacterColor using the specified @p colorSpace and with
* color value @p co
*
* The meaning of @p co depends on the @p colorSpace used.
*
* TODO : Document how @p co relates to @p colorSpace
*
* TODO : Add documentation about available color spaces.
*/
CharacterColor(quint8 colorSpace, int co)
: _colorSpace(colorSpace),
_u(0),
_v(0),
_w(0)
{
switch (colorSpace)
{
case COLOR_SPACE_DEFAULT:
_u = co & 1;
break;
case COLOR_SPACE_SYSTEM:
_u = co & 7;
_v = (co >> 3) & 1;
break;
case COLOR_SPACE_256:
_u = co & 255;
break;
case COLOR_SPACE_RGB:
_u = co >> 16;
_v = co >> 8;
_w = co;
break;
default:
_colorSpace = COLOR_SPACE_UNDEFINED;
}
}
/**
* Returns true if this character color entry is valid.
*/
bool isValid()
{
return _colorSpace != COLOR_SPACE_UNDEFINED;
}
/**
* Toggles the value of this color between a normal system color and the corresponding intensive
* system color.
*
* This is only applicable if the color is using the COLOR_SPACE_DEFAULT or COLOR_SPACE_SYSTEM
* color spaces.
*/
void toggleIntensive();
/**
* Returns the color within the specified color @p palette
*
* The @p palette is only used if this color is one of the 16 system colors, otherwise
* it is ignored.
*/
QColor color(const ColorEntry* palette) const;
/**
* Compares two colors and returns true if they represent the same color value and
* use the same color space.
*/
friend bool operator == (const CharacterColor& a, const CharacterColor& b);
/**
* Compares two colors and returns true if they represent different color values
* or use different color spaces.
*/
friend bool operator != (const CharacterColor& a, const CharacterColor& b);
private:
quint8 _colorSpace;
// bytes storing the character color
quint8 _u;
quint8 _v;
quint8 _w;
};
inline bool operator == (const CharacterColor& a, const CharacterColor& b)
{
return a._colorSpace == b._colorSpace &&
a._u == b._u &&
a._v == b._v &&
a._w == b._w;
}
inline bool operator != (const CharacterColor& a, const CharacterColor& b)
{
return !operator==(a,b);
}
inline const QColor color256(quint8 u, const ColorEntry* base)
{
// 0.. 16: system colors
if (u < 8) return base[u+2 ].color; u -= 8;
if (u < 8) return base[u+2+BASE_COLORS].color; u -= 8;
// 16..231: 6x6x6 rgb color cube
if (u < 216) return QColor(((u/36)%6) ? (40*((u/36)%6)+55) : 0,
((u/ 6)%6) ? (40*((u/ 6)%6)+55) : 0,
((u/ 1)%6) ? (40*((u/ 1)%6)+55) : 0); u -= 216;
// 232..255: gray, leaving out black and white
int gray = u*10+8; return QColor(gray,gray,gray);
}
inline QColor CharacterColor::color(const ColorEntry* base) const
{
switch (_colorSpace)
{
case COLOR_SPACE_DEFAULT: return base[_u+0+(_v?BASE_COLORS:0)].color;
case COLOR_SPACE_SYSTEM: return base[_u+2+(_v?BASE_COLORS:0)].color;
case COLOR_SPACE_256: return color256(_u,base);
case COLOR_SPACE_RGB: return QColor(_u,_v,_w);
case COLOR_SPACE_UNDEFINED: return QColor();
}
Q_ASSERT(false); // invalid color space
return QColor();
}
inline void CharacterColor::toggleIntensive()
{
if (_colorSpace == COLOR_SPACE_SYSTEM || _colorSpace == COLOR_SPACE_DEFAULT)
{
_v = !_v;
}
}
}
#endif // CHARACTERCOLOR_H

@ -0,0 +1,788 @@
/*
This source file is part of Konsole, a terminal emulator.
Copyright 2007-2008 by Robert Knight <robertknight@gmail.com>
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
(at your option) any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
02110-1301 USA.
*/
// Own
#include "ColorScheme.h"
#include "tools.h"
// Qt
#include <QBrush>
#include <QFile>
#include <QFileInfo>
#include <QtDebug>
#include <QSettings>
#include <QDir>
// KDE
//#include <KColorScheme>
//#include <KConfig>
//#include <KLocale>
//#include <KDebug>
//#include <KConfigGroup>
//#include <KStandardDirs>
using namespace Konsole;
const ColorEntry ColorScheme::defaultTable[TABLE_COLORS] =
// The following are almost IBM standard color codes, with some slight
// gamma correction for the dim colors to compensate for bright X screens.
// It contains the 8 ansiterm/xterm colors in 2 intensities.
{
ColorEntry( QColor(0x00,0x00,0x00), 0), ColorEntry(
QColor(0xFF,0xFF,0xFF), 1), // Dfore, Dback
ColorEntry( QColor(0x00,0x00,0x00), 0), ColorEntry(
QColor(0xB2,0x18,0x18), 0), // Black, Red
ColorEntry( QColor(0x18,0xB2,0x18), 0), ColorEntry(
QColor(0xB2,0x68,0x18), 0), // Green, Yellow
ColorEntry( QColor(0x18,0x18,0xB2), 0), ColorEntry(
QColor(0xB2,0x18,0xB2), 0), // Blue, Magenta
ColorEntry( QColor(0x18,0xB2,0xB2), 0), ColorEntry(
QColor(0xB2,0xB2,0xB2), 0), // Cyan, White
// intensive
ColorEntry( QColor(0x00,0x00,0x00), 0), ColorEntry(
QColor(0xFF,0xFF,0xFF), 1),
ColorEntry( QColor(0x68,0x68,0x68), 0), ColorEntry(
QColor(0xFF,0x54,0x54), 0),
ColorEntry( QColor(0x54,0xFF,0x54), 0), ColorEntry(
QColor(0xFF,0xFF,0x54), 0),
ColorEntry( QColor(0x54,0x54,0xFF), 0), ColorEntry(
QColor(0xFF,0x54,0xFF), 0),
ColorEntry( QColor(0x54,0xFF,0xFF), 0), ColorEntry(
QColor(0xFF,0xFF,0xFF), 0)
};
const char* const ColorScheme::colorNames[TABLE_COLORS] =
{
"Foreground",
"Background",
"Color0",
"Color1",
"Color2",
"Color3",
"Color4",
"Color5",
"Color6",
"Color7",
"ForegroundIntense",
"BackgroundIntense",
"Color0Intense",
"Color1Intense",
"Color2Intense",
"Color3Intense",
"Color4Intense",
"Color5Intense",
"Color6Intense",
"Color7Intense"
};
// dummy silently comment out the tr_NOOP
#define tr_NOOP
const char* const ColorScheme::translatedColorNames[TABLE_COLORS] =
{
tr_NOOP("Foreground"),
tr_NOOP("Background"),
tr_NOOP("Color 1"),
tr_NOOP("Color 2"),
tr_NOOP("Color 3"),
tr_NOOP("Color 4"),
tr_NOOP("Color 5"),
tr_NOOP("Color 6"),
tr_NOOP("Color 7"),
tr_NOOP("Color 8"),
tr_NOOP("Foreground (Intense)"),
tr_NOOP("Background (Intense)"),
tr_NOOP("Color 1 (Intense)"),
tr_NOOP("Color 2 (Intense)"),
tr_NOOP("Color 3 (Intense)"),
tr_NOOP("Color 4 (Intense)"),
tr_NOOP("Color 5 (Intense)"),
tr_NOOP("Color 6 (Intense)"),
tr_NOOP("Color 7 (Intense)"),
tr_NOOP("Color 8 (Intense)")
};
ColorScheme::ColorScheme()
{
_table = 0;
_randomTable = 0;
_opacity = 1.0;
}
ColorScheme::ColorScheme(const ColorScheme& other)
: _opacity(other._opacity)
,_table(0)
,_randomTable(0)
{
setName(other.name());
setDescription(other.description());
if ( other._table != 0 )
{
for ( int i = 0 ; i < TABLE_COLORS ; i++ )
setColorTableEntry(i,other._table[i]);
}
if ( other._randomTable != 0 )
{
for ( int i = 0 ; i < TABLE_COLORS ; i++ )
{
const RandomizationRange& range = other._randomTable[i];
setRandomizationRange(i,range.hue,range.saturation,range.value);
}
}
}
ColorScheme::~ColorScheme()
{
delete[] _table;
delete[] _randomTable;
}
void ColorScheme::setDescription(const QString& description) { _description = description; }
QString ColorScheme::description() const { return _description; }
void ColorScheme::setName(const QString& name) { _name = name; }
QString ColorScheme::name() const { return _name; }
void ColorScheme::setColorTableEntry(int index , const ColorEntry& entry)
{
Q_ASSERT( index >= 0 && index < TABLE_COLORS );
if ( !_table )
{
_table = new ColorEntry[TABLE_COLORS];
for (int i=0;i<TABLE_COLORS;i++)
_table[i] = defaultTable[i];
}
_table[index] = entry;
}
ColorEntry ColorScheme::colorEntry(int index , uint randomSeed) const
{
Q_ASSERT( index >= 0 && index < TABLE_COLORS );
if ( randomSeed != 0 )
qsrand(randomSeed);
ColorEntry entry = colorTable()[index];
if ( randomSeed != 0 &&
_randomTable != 0 &&
!_randomTable[index].isNull() )
{
const RandomizationRange& range = _randomTable[index];
int hueDifference = range.hue ? (qrand() % range.hue) - range.hue/2 : 0;
int saturationDifference = range.saturation ? (qrand() % range.saturation) - range.saturation/2 : 0;
int valueDifference = range.value ? (qrand() % range.value) - range.value/2 : 0;
QColor& color = entry.color;
int newHue = qAbs( (color.hue() + hueDifference) % MAX_HUE );
int newValue = qMin( qAbs(color.value() + valueDifference) , 255 );
int newSaturation = qMin( qAbs(color.saturation() + saturationDifference) , 255 );
color.setHsv(newHue,newSaturation,newValue);
}
return entry;
}
void ColorScheme::getColorTable(ColorEntry* table , uint randomSeed) const
{
for ( int i = 0 ; i < TABLE_COLORS ; i++ )
table[i] = colorEntry(i,randomSeed);
}
bool ColorScheme::randomizedBackgroundColor() const
{
return _randomTable == 0 ? false : !_randomTable[1].isNull();
}
void ColorScheme::setRandomizedBackgroundColor(bool randomize)
{
// the hue of the background colour is allowed to be randomly
// adjusted as much as possible.
//
// the value and saturation are left alone to maintain read-ability
if ( randomize )
{
setRandomizationRange( 1 /* background color index */ , MAX_HUE , 255 , 0 );
}
else
{
if ( _randomTable )
setRandomizationRange( 1 /* background color index */ , 0 , 0 , 0 );
}
}
void ColorScheme::setRandomizationRange( int index , quint16 hue , quint8 saturation ,
quint8 value )
{
Q_ASSERT( hue <= MAX_HUE );
Q_ASSERT( index >= 0 && index < TABLE_COLORS );
if ( _randomTable == 0 )
_randomTable = new RandomizationRange[TABLE_COLORS];
_randomTable[index].hue = hue;
_randomTable[index].value = value;
_randomTable[index].saturation = saturation;
}
const ColorEntry* ColorScheme::colorTable() const
{
if ( _table )
return _table;
else
return defaultTable;
}
QColor ColorScheme::foregroundColor() const
{
return colorTable()[0].color;
}
QColor ColorScheme::backgroundColor() const
{
return colorTable()[1].color;
}
bool ColorScheme::hasDarkBackground() const
{
// value can range from 0 - 255, with larger values indicating higher brightness.
// so 127 is in the middle, anything less is deemed 'dark'
return backgroundColor().value() < 127;
}
void ColorScheme::setOpacity(qreal opacity) { _opacity = opacity; }
qreal ColorScheme::opacity() const { return _opacity; }
void ColorScheme::read(const QString & fileName)
{
QSettings s(fileName, QSettings::IniFormat);
s.beginGroup("General");
_description = s.value("Description", QObject::tr("Un-named Color Scheme")).toString();
_opacity = s.value("Opacity",qreal(1.0)).toDouble();
s.endGroup();
for (int i=0 ; i < TABLE_COLORS ; i++)
{
readColorEntry(&s, i);
}
}
#if 0
// implemented upstream - user apps
void ColorScheme::read(KConfig& config)
{
KConfigGroup configGroup = config.group("General");
QString description = configGroup.readEntry("Description", QObject::tr("Un-named Color Scheme"));
_description = tr(description.toUtf8());
_opacity = configGroup.readEntry("Opacity",qreal(1.0));
for (int i=0 ; i < TABLE_COLORS ; i++)
{
readColorEntry(config,i);
}
}
void ColorScheme::write(KConfig& config) const
{
KConfigGroup configGroup = config.group("General");
configGroup.writeEntry("Description",_description);
configGroup.writeEntry("Opacity",_opacity);
for (int i=0 ; i < TABLE_COLORS ; i++)
{
RandomizationRange random = _randomTable != 0 ? _randomTable[i] : RandomizationRange();
writeColorEntry(config,colorNameForIndex(i),colorTable()[i],random);
}
}
#endif
QString ColorScheme::colorNameForIndex(int index)
{
Q_ASSERT( index >= 0 && index < TABLE_COLORS );
return QString(colorNames[index]);
}
QString ColorScheme::translatedColorNameForIndex(int index)
{
Q_ASSERT( index >= 0 && index < TABLE_COLORS );
return translatedColorNames[index];
}
void ColorScheme::readColorEntry(QSettings * s , int index)
{
s->beginGroup(colorNameForIndex(index));
ColorEntry entry;
QStringList rgbList = s->value("Color", QStringList()).toStringList();
if (rgbList.count() != 3)
{
Q_ASSERT(0);
}
int r, g, b;
r = rgbList[0].toInt();
g = rgbList[1].toInt();
b = rgbList[2].toInt();
entry.color = QColor(r, g, b);
entry.transparent = s->value("Transparent",false).toBool();
// Deprecated key from KDE 4.0 which set 'Bold' to true to force
// a color to be bold or false to use the current format
//
// TODO - Add a new tri-state key which allows for bold, normal or
// current format
if (s->contains("Bold"))
entry.fontWeight = s->value("Bold",false).toBool() ? ColorEntry::Bold :
ColorEntry::UseCurrentFormat;
quint16 hue = s->value("MaxRandomHue",0).toInt();
quint8 value = s->value("MaxRandomValue",0).toInt();
quint8 saturation = s->value("MaxRandomSaturation",0).toInt();
setColorTableEntry( index , entry );
if ( hue != 0 || value != 0 || saturation != 0 )
setRandomizationRange( index , hue , saturation , value );
s->endGroup();
}
#if 0
// implemented upstream - user apps
void ColorScheme::writeColorEntry(KConfig& config , const QString& colorName, const ColorEntry& entry , const RandomizationRange& random) const
{
KConfigGroup configGroup(&config,colorName);
configGroup.writeEntry("Color",entry.color);
configGroup.writeEntry("Transparency",(bool)entry.transparent);
if (entry.fontWeight != ColorEntry::UseCurrentFormat)
{
configGroup.writeEntry("Bold",entry.fontWeight == ColorEntry::Bold);
}
// record randomization if this color has randomization or
// if one of the keys already exists
if ( !random.isNull() || configGroup.hasKey("MaxRandomHue") )
{
configGroup.writeEntry("MaxRandomHue",(int)random.hue);
configGroup.writeEntry("MaxRandomValue",(int)random.value);
configGroup.writeEntry("MaxRandomSaturation",(int)random.saturation);
}
}
#endif
//
// Work In Progress - A color scheme for use on KDE setups for users
// with visual disabilities which means that they may have trouble
// reading text with the supplied color schemes.
//
// This color scheme uses only the 'safe' colors defined by the
// KColorScheme class.
//
// A complication this introduces is that each color provided by
// KColorScheme is defined as a 'background' or 'foreground' color.
// Only foreground colors are allowed to be used to render text and
// only background colors are allowed to be used for backgrounds.
//
// The ColorEntry and TerminalDisplay classes do not currently
// support this restriction.
//
// Requirements:
// - A color scheme which uses only colors from the KColorScheme class
// - Ability to restrict which colors the TerminalDisplay widget
// uses as foreground and background color
// - Make use of KGlobalSettings::allowDefaultBackgroundImages() as
// a hint to determine whether this accessible color scheme should
// be used by default.
//
//
// -- Robert Knight <robertknight@gmail.com> 21/07/2007
//
AccessibleColorScheme::AccessibleColorScheme()
: ColorScheme()
{
#if 0
// It's not finished in konsole and it breaks Qt4 compilation as well
// basic attributes
setName("accessible");
setDescription(QObject::tr("Accessible Color Scheme"));
// setup colors
const int ColorRoleCount = 8;
const KColorScheme colorScheme(QPalette::Active);
QBrush colors[ColorRoleCount] =
{
colorScheme.foreground( colorScheme.NormalText ),
colorScheme.background( colorScheme.NormalBackground ),
colorScheme.foreground( colorScheme.InactiveText ),
colorScheme.foreground( colorScheme.ActiveText ),
colorScheme.foreground( colorScheme.LinkText ),
colorScheme.foreground( colorScheme.VisitedText ),
colorScheme.foreground( colorScheme.NegativeText ),
colorScheme.foreground( colorScheme.NeutralText )
};
for ( int i = 0 ; i < TABLE_COLORS ; i++ )
{
ColorEntry entry;
entry.color = colors[ i % ColorRoleCount ].color();
setColorTableEntry( i , entry );
}
#endif
}
KDE3ColorSchemeReader::KDE3ColorSchemeReader( QIODevice* device ) :
_device(device)
{
}
ColorScheme* KDE3ColorSchemeReader::read()
{
Q_ASSERT( _device->openMode() == QIODevice::ReadOnly ||
_device->openMode() == QIODevice::ReadWrite );
ColorScheme* scheme = new ColorScheme();
QRegExp comment("#.*$");
while ( !_device->atEnd() )
{
QString line(_device->readLine());
line.remove(comment);
line = line.simplified();
if ( line.isEmpty() )
continue;
if ( line.startsWith(QLatin1String("color")) )
{
if (!readColorLine(line,scheme))
qDebug() << "Failed to read KDE 3 color scheme line" << line;
}
else if ( line.startsWith(QLatin1String("title")) )
{
if (!readTitleLine(line,scheme))
qDebug() << "Failed to read KDE 3 color scheme title line" << line;
}
else
{
qDebug() << "KDE 3 color scheme contains an unsupported feature, '" <<
line << "'";
}
}
return scheme;
}
bool KDE3ColorSchemeReader::readColorLine(const QString& line,ColorScheme* scheme)
{
QStringList list = line.split(QChar(' '));
if (list.count() != 7)
return false;
if (list.first() != "color")
return false;
int index = list[1].toInt();
int red = list[2].toInt();
int green = list[3].toInt();
int blue = list[4].toInt();
int transparent = list[5].toInt();
int bold = list[6].toInt();
const int MAX_COLOR_VALUE = 255;
if( (index < 0 || index >= TABLE_COLORS )
|| (red < 0 || red > MAX_COLOR_VALUE )
|| (blue < 0 || blue > MAX_COLOR_VALUE )
|| (green < 0 || green > MAX_COLOR_VALUE )
|| (transparent != 0 && transparent != 1 )
|| (bold != 0 && bold != 1) )
return false;
ColorEntry entry;
entry.color = QColor(red,green,blue);
entry.transparent = ( transparent != 0 );
entry.fontWeight = ( bold != 0 ) ? ColorEntry::Bold : ColorEntry::UseCurrentFormat;
scheme->setColorTableEntry(index,entry);
return true;
}
bool KDE3ColorSchemeReader::readTitleLine(const QString& line,ColorScheme* scheme)
{
if( !line.startsWith(QLatin1String("title")) )
return false;
int spacePos = line.indexOf(' ');
if( spacePos == -1 )
return false;
QString description = line.mid(spacePos+1);
scheme->setDescription(description.toUtf8());
return true;
}
ColorSchemeManager::ColorSchemeManager()
: _haveLoadedAll(false)
{
}
ColorSchemeManager::~ColorSchemeManager()
{
QHashIterator<QString,const ColorScheme*> iter(_colorSchemes);
while (iter.hasNext())
{
iter.next();
delete iter.value();
}
}
void ColorSchemeManager::loadAllColorSchemes()
{
qDebug() << "loadAllColorSchemes";
int success = 0;
int failed = 0;
QList<QString> nativeColorSchemes = listColorSchemes();
QListIterator<QString> nativeIter(nativeColorSchemes);
while ( nativeIter.hasNext() )
{
if ( loadColorScheme( nativeIter.next() ) )
success++;
else
failed++;
}
QList<QString> kde3ColorSchemes = listKDE3ColorSchemes();
QListIterator<QString> kde3Iter(kde3ColorSchemes);
while ( kde3Iter.hasNext() )
{
if ( loadKDE3ColorScheme( kde3Iter.next() ) )
success++;
else
failed++;
}
if ( failed > 0 )
qDebug() << "failed to load " << failed << " color schemes.";
_haveLoadedAll = true;
}
QList<const ColorScheme*> ColorSchemeManager::allColorSchemes()
{
if ( !_haveLoadedAll )
{
loadAllColorSchemes();
}
return _colorSchemes.values();
}
bool ColorSchemeManager::loadKDE3ColorScheme(const QString& filePath)
{
QFile file(filePath);
if (!filePath.endsWith(QLatin1String(".schema")) || !file.open(QIODevice::ReadOnly))
return false;
KDE3ColorSchemeReader reader(&file);
ColorScheme* scheme = reader.read();
scheme->setName(QFileInfo(file).baseName());
file.close();
if (scheme->name().isEmpty())
{
qDebug() << "color scheme name is not valid.";
delete scheme;
return false;
}
QFileInfo info(filePath);
if ( !_colorSchemes.contains(info.baseName()) )
_colorSchemes.insert(scheme->name(),scheme);
else
{
qDebug() << "color scheme with name" << scheme->name() << "has already been" <<
"found, ignoring.";
delete scheme;
}
return true;
}
#if 0
void ColorSchemeManager::addColorScheme(ColorScheme* scheme)
{
_colorSchemes.insert(scheme->name(),scheme);
// save changes to disk
QString path = KGlobal::dirs()->saveLocation("data","konsole/") + scheme->name() + ".colorscheme";
KConfig config(path , KConfig::NoGlobals);
scheme->write(config);
}
#endif
bool ColorSchemeManager::loadCustomColorScheme(const QString& path)
{
if (path.endsWith(QLatin1String(".colorscheme")))
return loadColorScheme(path);
else if (path.endsWith(QLatin1String(".schema")))
return loadKDE3ColorScheme(path);
else
return false;
}
bool ColorSchemeManager::loadColorScheme(const QString& filePath)
{
if ( !filePath.endsWith(QLatin1String(".colorscheme")) || !QFile::exists(filePath) )
return false;
QFileInfo info(filePath);
const QString& schemeName = info.baseName();
ColorScheme* scheme = new ColorScheme();
scheme->setName(schemeName);
scheme->read(filePath);
if (scheme->name().isEmpty())
{
qDebug() << "Color scheme in" << filePath << "does not have a valid name and was not loaded.";
delete scheme;
return false;
}
if ( !_colorSchemes.contains(schemeName) )
{
_colorSchemes.insert(schemeName,scheme);
}
else
{
qDebug() << "color scheme with name" << schemeName << "has already been" <<
"found, ignoring.";
delete scheme;
}
return true;
}
QList<QString> ColorSchemeManager::listKDE3ColorSchemes()
{
QString dname(get_color_schemes_dir());
QDir dir(dname);
QStringList filters;
filters << "*.schema";
dir.setNameFilters(filters);
QStringList list = dir.entryList(filters);
QStringList ret;
foreach(QString i, list)
ret << dname + "/" + i;
return ret;
//return KGlobal::dirs()->findAllResources("data",
// "konsole/*.schema",
// KStandardDirs::NoDuplicates);
//
}
QList<QString> ColorSchemeManager::listColorSchemes()
{
QString dname(get_color_schemes_dir());
QDir dir(dname);
QStringList filters;
filters << "*.colorscheme";
dir.setNameFilters(filters);
QStringList list = dir.entryList(filters);
QStringList ret;
foreach(QString i, list)
ret << dname + "/" + i;
return ret;
// return KGlobal::dirs()->findAllResources("data",
// "konsole/*.colorscheme",
// KStandardDirs::NoDuplicates);
}
const ColorScheme ColorSchemeManager::_defaultColorScheme;
const ColorScheme* ColorSchemeManager::defaultColorScheme() const
{
return &_defaultColorScheme;
}
bool ColorSchemeManager::deleteColorScheme(const QString& name)
{
Q_ASSERT( _colorSchemes.contains(name) );
// lookup the path and delete
QString path = findColorSchemePath(name);
if ( QFile::remove(path) )
{
_colorSchemes.remove(name);
return true;
}
else
{
qDebug() << "Failed to remove color scheme -" << path;
return false;
}
}
QString ColorSchemeManager::findColorSchemePath(const QString& name) const
{
// QString path = KStandardDirs::locate("data","konsole/"+name+".colorscheme");
QString path(get_color_schemes_dir() + "/"+ name + ".colorscheme");
if ( !path.isEmpty() )
return path;
//path = KStandardDirs::locate("data","konsole/"+name+".schema");
path = get_color_schemes_dir() + "/"+ name + ".schema";
return path;
}
const ColorScheme* ColorSchemeManager::findColorScheme(const QString& name)
{
if ( name.isEmpty() )
return defaultColorScheme();
if ( _colorSchemes.contains(name) )
return _colorSchemes[name];
else
{
// look for this color scheme
QString path = findColorSchemePath(name);
if ( !path.isEmpty() && loadColorScheme(path) )
{
return findColorScheme(name);
}
else
{
if (!path.isEmpty() && loadKDE3ColorScheme(path))
return findColorScheme(name);
}
qDebug() << "Could not find color scheme - " << name;
return 0;
}
}
ColorSchemeManager* ColorSchemeManager::theColorSchemeManager = 0;
//K_GLOBAL_STATIC( ColorSchemeManager , theColorSchemeManager )
ColorSchemeManager* ColorSchemeManager::instance()
{
if (! theColorSchemeManager)
theColorSchemeManager = new ColorSchemeManager();
return theColorSchemeManager;
}

@ -0,0 +1,359 @@
/*
This source file is part of Konsole, a terminal emulator.
Copyright 2007-2008 by Robert Knight <robertknight@gmail.com>
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
(at your option) any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
02110-1301 USA.
*/
#ifndef COLORSCHEME_H
#define COLORSCHEME_H
// Qt
#include <QHash>
#include <QList>
#include <QMetaType>
#include <QIODevice>
#include <QSet>
#include <QSettings>
// Konsole
#include "CharacterColor.h"
class QIODevice;
//class KConfig;
namespace Konsole
{
/**
* Represents a color scheme for a terminal display.
*
* The color scheme includes the palette of colors used to draw the text and character backgrounds
* in the display and the opacity level of the display background.
*/
class ColorScheme
{
public:
/**
* Constructs a new color scheme which is initialised to the default color set
* for Konsole.
*/
ColorScheme();
ColorScheme(const ColorScheme& other);
~ColorScheme();
/** Sets the descriptive name of the color scheme. */
void setDescription(const QString& description);
/** Returns the descriptive name of the color scheme. */
QString description() const;
/** Sets the name of the color scheme */
void setName(const QString& name);
/** Returns the name of the color scheme */
QString name() const;
#if 0
// Implemented upstream - in user apps
/** Reads the color scheme from the specified configuration source */
void read(KConfig& config);
/** Writes the color scheme to the specified configuration source */
void write(KConfig& config) const;
#endif
void read(const QString & filename);
/** Sets a single entry within the color palette. */
void setColorTableEntry(int index , const ColorEntry& entry);
/**
* Copies the color entries which form the palette for this color scheme
* into @p table. @p table should be an array with TABLE_COLORS entries.
*
* @param table Array into which the color entries for this color scheme
* are copied.
* @param randomSeed Color schemes may allow certain colors in their
* palette to be randomized. The seed is used to pick the random color.
*/
void getColorTable(ColorEntry* table, uint randomSeed = 0) const;
/**
* Retrieves a single color entry from the table.
*
* See getColorTable()
*/
ColorEntry colorEntry(int index , uint randomSeed = 0) const;
/**
* Convenience method. Returns the
* foreground color for this scheme,
* this is the primary color used to draw the
* text in this scheme.
*/
QColor foregroundColor() const;
/**
* Convenience method. Returns the background color for
* this scheme, this is the primary color used to
* draw the terminal background in this scheme.
*/
QColor backgroundColor() const;
/**
* Returns true if this color scheme has a dark background.
* The background color is said to be dark if it has a value of less than 127
* in the HSV color space.
*/
bool hasDarkBackground() const;
/**
* Sets the opacity level of the display background. @p opacity ranges
* between 0 (completely transparent background) and 1 (completely
* opaque background).
*
* Defaults to 1.
*
* TODO: More documentation
*/
void setOpacity(qreal opacity);
/**
* Returns the opacity level for this color scheme, see setOpacity()
* TODO: More documentation
*/
qreal opacity() const;
/**
* Enables randomization of the background color. This will cause
* the palette returned by getColorTable() and colorEntry() to
* be adjusted depending on the value of the random seed argument
* to them.
*/
void setRandomizedBackgroundColor(bool randomize);
/** Returns true if the background color is randomized. */
bool randomizedBackgroundColor() const;
static QString colorNameForIndex(int index);
static QString translatedColorNameForIndex(int index);
private:
// specifies how much a particular color can be randomized by
class RandomizationRange
{
public:
RandomizationRange() : hue(0) , saturation(0) , value(0) {}
bool isNull() const
{
return ( hue == 0 && saturation == 0 && value == 0 );
}
quint16 hue;
quint8 saturation;
quint8 value;
};
// returns the active color table. if none has been set specifically,
// this is the default color table.
const ColorEntry* colorTable() const;
#if 0
// implemented upstream - user apps
// reads a single colour entry from a KConfig source
// and sets the palette entry at 'index' to the entry read.
void readColorEntry(KConfig& config , int index);
// writes a single colour entry to a KConfig source
void writeColorEntry(KConfig& config , const QString& colorName, const ColorEntry& entry,const RandomizationRange& range) const;
#endif
void readColorEntry(QSettings *s, int index);
// sets the amount of randomization allowed for a particular color
// in the palette. creates the randomization table if
// it does not already exist
void setRandomizationRange( int index , quint16 hue , quint8 saturation , quint8 value );
QString _description;
QString _name;
qreal _opacity;
ColorEntry* _table; // pointer to custom color table or 0 if the default
// color scheme is being used
static const quint16 MAX_HUE = 340;
RandomizationRange* _randomTable; // pointer to randomization table or 0
// if no colors in the color scheme support
// randomization
static const char* const colorNames[TABLE_COLORS];
static const char* const translatedColorNames[TABLE_COLORS];
static const ColorEntry defaultTable[]; // table of default color entries
};
/**
* A color scheme which uses colors from the standard KDE color palette.
*
* This is designed primarily for the benefit of users who are using specially
* designed colors.
*
* TODO Implement and make it the default on systems with specialized KDE
* color schemes.
*/
class AccessibleColorScheme : public ColorScheme
{
public:
AccessibleColorScheme();
};
/**
* Reads a color scheme stored in the .schema format used in the KDE 3 incarnation
* of Konsole
*
* Only the basic essentials ( title and color palette entries ) are currently
* supported. Additional options such as background image and background
* blend colors are ignored.
*/
class KDE3ColorSchemeReader
{
public:
/**
* Constructs a new reader which reads from the specified device.
* The device should be open in read-only mode.
*/
KDE3ColorSchemeReader( QIODevice* device );
/**
* Reads and parses the contents of the .schema file from the input
* device and returns the ColorScheme defined within it.
*
* Returns a null pointer if an error occurs whilst parsing
* the contents of the file.
*/
ColorScheme* read();
private:
// reads a line from the file specifying a colour palette entry
// format is: color [index] [red] [green] [blue] [transparent] [bold]
bool readColorLine(const QString& line , ColorScheme* scheme);
bool readTitleLine(const QString& line , ColorScheme* scheme);
QIODevice* _device;
};
/**
* Manages the color schemes available for use by terminal displays.
* See ColorScheme
*/
class ColorSchemeManager
{
public:
/**
* Constructs a new ColorSchemeManager and loads the list
* of available color schemes.
*
* The color schemes themselves are not loaded until they are first
* requested via a call to findColorScheme()
*/
ColorSchemeManager();
/**
* Destroys the ColorSchemeManager and saves any modified color schemes to disk.
*/
~ColorSchemeManager();
/**
* Returns the default color scheme for Konsole
*/
const ColorScheme* defaultColorScheme() const;
/**
* Returns the color scheme with the given name or 0 if no
* scheme with that name exists. If @p name is empty, the
* default color scheme is returned.
*
* The first time that a color scheme with a particular name is
* requested, the configuration information is loaded from disk.
*/
const ColorScheme* findColorScheme(const QString& name);
#if 0
/**
* Adds a new color scheme to the manager. If @p scheme has the same name as
* an existing color scheme, it replaces the existing scheme.
*
* TODO - Ensure the old color scheme gets deleted
*/
void addColorScheme(ColorScheme* scheme);
#endif
/**
* Deletes a color scheme. Returns true on successful deletion or false otherwise.
*/
bool deleteColorScheme(const QString& name);
/**
* Returns a list of the all the available color schemes.
* This may be slow when first called because all of the color
* scheme resources on disk must be located, read and parsed.
*
* Subsequent calls will be inexpensive.
*/
QList<const ColorScheme*> allColorSchemes();
/** Returns the global color scheme manager instance. */
static ColorSchemeManager* instance();
/** @brief Loads a custom color scheme under given \em path.
*
* The \em path may refer to either KDE 4 .colorscheme or KDE 3
* .schema file
*
* The loaded color scheme is available under the name equal to
* the base name of the \em path via the allColorSchemes() and
* findColorScheme() methods after this call if loaded successfully.
*
* @param[in] path The path to KDE 4 .colorscheme or KDE 3 .schema.
* @return Whether the color scheme is loaded successfully.
*/
bool loadCustomColorScheme(const QString& path);
private:
// loads a color scheme from a KDE 4+ .colorscheme file
bool loadColorScheme(const QString& path);
// loads a color scheme from a KDE 3 .schema file
bool loadKDE3ColorScheme(const QString& path);
// returns a list of paths of color schemes in the KDE 4+ .colorscheme file format
QList<QString> listColorSchemes();
// returns a list of paths of color schemes in the .schema file format
// used in KDE 3
QList<QString> listKDE3ColorSchemes();
// loads all of the color schemes
void loadAllColorSchemes();
// finds the path of a color scheme
QString findColorSchemePath(const QString& name) const;
QHash<QString,const ColorScheme*> _colorSchemes;
QSet<ColorScheme*> _modifiedSchemes;
bool _haveLoadedAll;
static const ColorScheme _defaultColorScheme;
static ColorSchemeManager * theColorSchemeManager;
};
}
Q_DECLARE_METATYPE(const Konsole::ColorScheme*)
#endif //COLORSCHEME_H

@ -0,0 +1,55 @@
#ifndef _COLOR_TABLE_H
#define _COLOR_TABLE_H
#include "CharacterColor.h"
//using namespace Konsole;
#if 0
static const ColorEntry whiteonblack_color_table[TABLE_COLORS] = {
// normal
ColorEntry(QColor(0xFF,0xFF,0xFF), false ), ColorEntry( QColor(0x00,0x00,0x00), true ), // Dfore, Dback
ColorEntry(QColor(0x00,0x00,0x00), false ), ColorEntry( QColor(0xB2,0x18,0x18), false ), // Black, Red
ColorEntry(QColor(0x18,0xB2,0x18), false ), ColorEntry( QColor(0xB2,0x68,0x18), false ), // Green, Yellow
ColorEntry(QColor(0x18,0x18,0xB2), false ), ColorEntry( QColor(0xB2,0x18,0xB2), false ), // Blue, Magenta
ColorEntry(QColor(0x18,0xB2,0xB2), false ), ColorEntry( QColor(0xB2,0xB2,0xB2), false ), // Cyan, White
// intensiv
ColorEntry(QColor(0x00,0x00,0x00), false ), ColorEntry( QColor(0xFF,0xFF,0xFF), true ),
ColorEntry(QColor(0x68,0x68,0x68), false ), ColorEntry( QColor(0xFF,0x54,0x54), false ),
ColorEntry(QColor(0x54,0xFF,0x54), false ), ColorEntry( QColor(0xFF,0xFF,0x54), false ),
ColorEntry(QColor(0x54,0x54,0xFF), false ), ColorEntry( QColor(0xFF,0x54,0xFF), false ),
ColorEntry(QColor(0x54,0xFF,0xFF), false ), ColorEntry( QColor(0xFF,0xFF,0xFF), false )
};
static const ColorEntry greenonblack_color_table[TABLE_COLORS] = {
ColorEntry(QColor( 24, 240, 24), false), ColorEntry(QColor( 0, 0, 0), true),
ColorEntry(QColor( 0, 0, 0), false), ColorEntry(QColor( 178, 24, 24), false),
ColorEntry(QColor( 24, 178, 24), false), ColorEntry(QColor( 178, 104, 24), false),
ColorEntry(QColor( 24, 24, 178), false), ColorEntry(QColor( 178, 24, 178), false),
ColorEntry(QColor( 24, 178, 178), false), ColorEntry(QColor( 178, 178, 178), false),
// intensive colors
ColorEntry(QColor( 24, 240, 24), false ), ColorEntry(QColor( 0, 0, 0), true ),
ColorEntry(QColor( 104, 104, 104), false ), ColorEntry(QColor( 255, 84, 84), false ),
ColorEntry(QColor( 84, 255, 84), false ), ColorEntry(QColor( 255, 255, 84), false ),
ColorEntry(QColor( 84, 84, 255), false ), ColorEntry(QColor( 255, 84, 255), false ),
ColorEntry(QColor( 84, 255, 255), false ), ColorEntry(QColor( 255, 255, 255), false )
};
static const ColorEntry blackonlightyellow_color_table[TABLE_COLORS] = {
ColorEntry(QColor( 0, 0, 0), false), ColorEntry(QColor( 255, 255, 221), true),
ColorEntry(QColor( 0, 0, 0), false), ColorEntry(QColor( 178, 24, 24), false),
ColorEntry(QColor( 24, 178, 24), false), ColorEntry(QColor( 178, 104, 24), false),
ColorEntry(QColor( 24, 24, 178), false), ColorEntry(QColor( 178, 24, 178), false),
ColorEntry(QColor( 24, 178, 178), false), ColorEntry(QColor( 178, 178, 178), false),
ColorEntry(QColor( 0, 0, 0), false), ColorEntry(QColor( 255, 255, 221), true),
ColorEntry(QColor(104, 104, 104), false), ColorEntry(QColor( 255, 84, 84), false),
ColorEntry(QColor( 84, 255, 84), false), ColorEntry(QColor( 255, 255, 84), false),
ColorEntry(QColor( 84, 84, 255), false), ColorEntry(QColor( 255, 84, 255), false),
ColorEntry(QColor( 84, 255, 255), false), ColorEntry(QColor( 255, 255, 255), false)
};
#endif
#endif

@ -0,0 +1,2 @@
"keyboard \"Fallback Key Translator\"\n"
"key Tab : \"\\t\" \0"

@ -0,0 +1,460 @@
/*
Copyright 2007-2008 Robert Knight <robertknight@gmail.com>
Copyright 1997,1998 by Lars Doelle <lars.doelle@on-line.de>
Copyright 1996 by Matthias Ettrich <ettrich@kde.org>
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
(at your option) any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
02110-1301 USA.
*/
// Own
#include "Emulation.h"
// System
#include <assert.h>
#include <stdio.h>
#include <stdlib.h>
#include <unistd.h>
// Qt
#include <QApplication>
#include <QClipboard>
#include <QHash>
#include <QKeyEvent>
#include <QRegExp>
#include <QTextStream>
#include <QThread>
#include <QTime>
// KDE
//#include <kdebug.h>
// Konsole
#include "KeyboardTranslator.h"
#include "Screen.h"
#include "TerminalCharacterDecoder.h"
#include "ScreenWindow.h"
using namespace Konsole;
Emulation::Emulation() :
_currentScreen(0),
_codec(0),
_decoder(0),
_keyTranslator(0),
_usesMouse(false)
{
// create screens with a default size
_screen[0] = new Screen(40,80);
_screen[1] = new Screen(40,80);
_currentScreen = _screen[0];
QObject::connect(&_bulkTimer1, SIGNAL(timeout()), this, SLOT(showBulk()) );
QObject::connect(&_bulkTimer2, SIGNAL(timeout()), this, SLOT(showBulk()) );
// listen for mouse status changes
connect( this , SIGNAL(programUsesMouseChanged(bool)) ,
SLOT(usesMouseChanged(bool)) );
}
bool Emulation::programUsesMouse() const
{
return _usesMouse;
}
void Emulation::usesMouseChanged(bool usesMouse)
{
_usesMouse = usesMouse;
}
ScreenWindow* Emulation::createWindow()
{
ScreenWindow* window = new ScreenWindow();
window->setScreen(_currentScreen);
_windows << window;
connect(window , SIGNAL(selectionChanged()),
this , SLOT(bufferedUpdate()));
connect(this , SIGNAL(outputChanged()),
window , SLOT(notifyOutputChanged()) );
return window;
}
Emulation::~Emulation()
{
QListIterator<ScreenWindow*> windowIter(_windows);
while (windowIter.hasNext())
{
delete windowIter.next();
}
delete _screen[0];
delete _screen[1];
delete _decoder;
}
void Emulation::setScreen(int n)
{
Screen *old = _currentScreen;
_currentScreen = _screen[n & 1];
if (_currentScreen != old)
{
// tell all windows onto this emulation to switch to the newly active screen
foreach(ScreenWindow* window,_windows)
window->setScreen(_currentScreen);
}
}
void Emulation::clearHistory()
{
_screen[0]->setScroll( _screen[0]->getScroll() , false );
}
void Emulation::setHistory(const HistoryType& t)
{
_screen[0]->setScroll(t);
showBulk();
}
const HistoryType& Emulation::history() const
{
return _screen[0]->getScroll();
}
void Emulation::setCodec(const QTextCodec * qtc)
{
if (qtc)
_codec = qtc;
else
setCodec(LocaleCodec);
delete _decoder;
_decoder = _codec->makeDecoder();
emit useUtf8Request(utf8());
}
void Emulation::setCodec(EmulationCodec codec)
{
if ( codec == Utf8Codec )
setCodec( QTextCodec::codecForName("utf8") );
else if ( codec == LocaleCodec )
setCodec( QTextCodec::codecForLocale() );
}
void Emulation::setKeyBindings(const QString& name)
{
_keyTranslator = KeyboardTranslatorManager::instance()->findTranslator(name);
if (!_keyTranslator)
{
_keyTranslator = KeyboardTranslatorManager::instance()->defaultTranslator();
}
}
QString Emulation::keyBindings() const
{
return _keyTranslator->name();
}
void Emulation::receiveChar(int c)
// process application unicode input to terminal
// this is a trivial scanner
{
c &= 0xff;
switch (c)
{
case '\b' : _currentScreen->backspace(); break;
case '\t' : _currentScreen->tab(); break;
case '\n' : _currentScreen->newLine(); break;
case '\r' : _currentScreen->toStartOfLine(); break;
case 0x07 : emit stateSet(NOTIFYBELL);
break;
default : _currentScreen->displayCharacter(c); break;
};
}
void Emulation::sendKeyEvent( QKeyEvent* ev )
{
emit stateSet(NOTIFYNORMAL);
if (!ev->text().isEmpty())
{ // A block of text
// Note that the text is proper unicode.
// We should do a conversion here
emit sendData(ev->text().toUtf8(),ev->text().length());
}
}
void Emulation::sendString(const char*,int)
{
// default implementation does nothing
}
void Emulation::sendMouseEvent(int /*buttons*/, int /*column*/, int /*row*/, int /*eventType*/)
{
// default implementation does nothing
}
/*
We are doing code conversion from locale to unicode first.
TODO: Character composition from the old code. See #96536
*/
void Emulation::receiveData(const char* text, int length)
{
emit stateSet(NOTIFYACTIVITY);
bufferedUpdate();
QString unicodeText = _decoder->toUnicode(text,length);
//send characters to terminal emulator
for (int i=0;i<unicodeText.length();i++)
receiveChar(unicodeText[i].unicode());
//look for z-modem indicator
//-- someone who understands more about z-modems that I do may be able to move
//this check into the above for loop?
for (int i=0;i<length;i++)
{
if (text[i] == '\030')
{
if ((length-i-1 > 3) && (strncmp(text+i+1, "B00", 3) == 0))
emit zmodemDetected();
}
}
}
//OLDER VERSION
//This version of onRcvBlock was commented out because
// a) It decoded incoming characters one-by-one, which is slow in the current version of Qt (4.2 tech preview)
// b) It messed up decoding of non-ASCII characters, with the result that (for example) chinese characters
// were not printed properly.
//
//There is something about stopping the _decoder if "we get a control code halfway a multi-byte sequence" (see below)
//which hasn't been ported into the newer function (above). Hopefully someone who understands this better
//can find an alternative way of handling the check.
/*void Emulation::onRcvBlock(const char *s, int len)
{
emit notifySessionState(NOTIFYACTIVITY);
bufferedUpdate();
for (int i = 0; i < len; i++)
{
QString result = _decoder->toUnicode(&s[i],1);
int reslen = result.length();
// If we get a control code halfway a multi-byte sequence
// we flush the _decoder and continue with the control code.
if ((s[i] < 32) && (s[i] > 0))
{
// Flush _decoder
while(!result.length())
result = _decoder->toUnicode(&s[i],1);
reslen = 1;
result.resize(reslen);
result[0] = QChar(s[i]);
}
for (int j = 0; j < reslen; j++)
{
if (result[j].characterategory() == QChar::Mark_NonSpacing)
_currentScreen->compose(result.mid(j,1));
else
onRcvChar(result[j].unicode());
}
if (s[i] == '\030')
{
if ((len-i-1 > 3) && (strncmp(s+i+1, "B00", 3) == 0))
emit zmodemDetected();
}
}
}*/
void Emulation::writeToStream( TerminalCharacterDecoder* _decoder ,
int startLine ,
int endLine)
{
_currentScreen->writeLinesToStream(_decoder,startLine,endLine);
}
int Emulation::lineCount() const
{
// sum number of lines currently on _screen plus number of lines in history
return _currentScreen->getLines() + _currentScreen->getHistLines();
}
#define BULK_TIMEOUT1 10
#define BULK_TIMEOUT2 40
void Emulation::showBulk()
{
_bulkTimer1.stop();
_bulkTimer2.stop();
emit outputChanged();
_currentScreen->resetScrolledLines();
_currentScreen->resetDroppedLines();
}
void Emulation::bufferedUpdate()
{
_bulkTimer1.setSingleShot(true);
_bulkTimer1.start(BULK_TIMEOUT1);
if (!_bulkTimer2.isActive())
{
_bulkTimer2.setSingleShot(true);
_bulkTimer2.start(BULK_TIMEOUT2);
}
}
char Emulation::eraseChar() const
{
return '\b';
}
void Emulation::setImageSize(int lines, int columns)
{
if ((lines < 1) || (columns < 1))
return;
QSize screenSize[2] = { QSize(_screen[0]->getColumns(),
_screen[0]->getLines()),
QSize(_screen[1]->getColumns(),
_screen[1]->getLines()) };
QSize newSize(columns,lines);
if (newSize == screenSize[0] && newSize == screenSize[1])
return;
_screen[0]->resizeImage(lines,columns);
_screen[1]->resizeImage(lines,columns);
emit imageSizeChanged(lines,columns);
bufferedUpdate();
}
QSize Emulation::imageSize() const
{
return QSize(_currentScreen->getColumns(), _currentScreen->getLines());
}
ushort ExtendedCharTable::extendedCharHash(ushort* unicodePoints , ushort length) const
{
ushort hash = 0;
for ( ushort i = 0 ; i < length ; i++ )
{
hash = 31*hash + unicodePoints[i];
}
return hash;
}
bool ExtendedCharTable::extendedCharMatch(ushort hash , ushort* unicodePoints , ushort length) const
{
ushort* entry = extendedCharTable[hash];
// compare given length with stored sequence length ( given as the first ushort in the
// stored buffer )
if ( entry == 0 || entry[0] != length )
return false;
// if the lengths match, each character must be checked. the stored buffer starts at
// entry[1]
for ( int i = 0 ; i < length ; i++ )
{
if ( entry[i+1] != unicodePoints[i] )
return false;
}
return true;
}
ushort ExtendedCharTable::createExtendedChar(ushort* unicodePoints , ushort length)
{
// look for this sequence of points in the table
ushort hash = extendedCharHash(unicodePoints,length);
// check existing entry for match
while ( extendedCharTable.contains(hash) )
{
if ( extendedCharMatch(hash,unicodePoints,length) )
{
// this sequence already has an entry in the table,
// return its hash
return hash;
}
else
{
// if hash is already used by another, different sequence of unicode character
// points then try next hash
hash++;
}
}
// add the new sequence to the table and
// return that index
ushort* buffer = new ushort[length+1];
buffer[0] = length;
for ( int i = 0 ; i < length ; i++ )
buffer[i+1] = unicodePoints[i];
extendedCharTable.insert(hash,buffer);
return hash;
}
ushort* ExtendedCharTable::lookupExtendedChar(ushort hash , ushort& length) const
{
// lookup index in table and if found, set the length
// argument and return a pointer to the character sequence
ushort* buffer = extendedCharTable[hash];
if ( buffer )
{
length = buffer[0];
return buffer+1;
}
else
{
length = 0;
return 0;
}
}
ExtendedCharTable::ExtendedCharTable()
{
}
ExtendedCharTable::~ExtendedCharTable()
{
// free all allocated character buffers
QHashIterator<ushort,ushort*> iter(extendedCharTable);
while ( iter.hasNext() )
{
iter.next();
delete[] iter.value();
}
}
// global instance
ExtendedCharTable ExtendedCharTable::instance;
//#include "Emulation.moc"

@ -0,0 +1,471 @@
/*
This file is part of Konsole, an X terminal.
Copyright 2007-2008 by Robert Knight <robertknight@gmail.com>
Copyright 1997,1998 by Lars Doelle <lars.doelle@on-line.de>
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
(at your option) any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
02110-1301 USA.
*/
#ifndef EMULATION_H
#define EMULATION_H
// System
#include <stdio.h>
// Qt
#include <QKeyEvent>
//#include <QPointer>
#include <QTextCodec>
#include <QTextStream>
#include <QTimer>
// Konsole
//#include "konsole_export.h"
#define KONSOLEPRIVATE_EXPORT
namespace Konsole
{
class KeyboardTranslator;
class HistoryType;
class Screen;
class ScreenWindow;
class TerminalCharacterDecoder;
/**
* This enum describes the available states which
* the terminal emulation may be set to.
*
* These are the values used by Emulation::stateChanged()
*/
enum
{
/** The emulation is currently receiving user input. */
NOTIFYNORMAL=0,
/**
* The terminal program has triggered a bell event
* to get the user's attention.
*/
NOTIFYBELL=1,
/**
* The emulation is currently receiving data from its
* terminal input.
*/
NOTIFYACTIVITY=2,
// unused here?
NOTIFYSILENCE=3
};
/**
* Base class for terminal emulation back-ends.
*
* The back-end is responsible for decoding an incoming character stream and
* producing an output image of characters.
*
* When input from the terminal is received, the receiveData() slot should be called with
* the data which has arrived. The emulation will process the data and update the
* screen image accordingly. The codec used to decode the incoming character stream
* into the unicode characters used internally can be specified using setCodec()
*
* The size of the screen image can be specified by calling setImageSize() with the
* desired number of lines and columns. When new lines are added, old content
* is moved into a history store, which can be set by calling setHistory().
*
* The screen image can be accessed by creating a ScreenWindow onto this emulation
* by calling createWindow(). Screen windows provide access to a section of the
* output. Each screen window covers the same number of lines and columns as the
* image size returned by imageSize(). The screen window can be moved up and down
* and provides transparent access to both the current on-screen image and the
* previous output. The screen windows emit an outputChanged signal
* when the section of the image they are looking at changes.
* Graphical views can then render the contents of a screen window, listening for notifications
* of output changes from the screen window which they are associated with and updating
* accordingly.
*
* The emulation also is also responsible for converting input from the connected views such
* as keypresses and mouse activity into a character string which can be sent
* to the terminal program. Key presses can be processed by calling the sendKeyEvent() slot,
* while mouse events can be processed using the sendMouseEvent() slot. When the character
* stream has been produced, the emulation will emit a sendData() signal with a pointer
* to the character buffer. This data should be fed to the standard input of the terminal
* process. The translation of key presses into an output character stream is performed
* using a lookup in a set of key bindings which map key sequences to output
* character sequences. The name of the key bindings set used can be specified using
* setKeyBindings()
*
* The emulation maintains certain state information which changes depending on the
* input received. The emulation can be reset back to its starting state by calling
* reset().
*
* The emulation also maintains an activity state, which specifies whether
* terminal is currently active ( when data is received ), normal
* ( when the terminal is idle or receiving user input ) or trying
* to alert the user ( also known as a "Bell" event ). The stateSet() signal
* is emitted whenever the activity state is set. This can be used to determine
* how long the emulation has been active/idle for and also respond to
* a 'bell' event in different ways.
*/
class KONSOLEPRIVATE_EXPORT Emulation : public QObject
{
Q_OBJECT
public:
/** Constructs a new terminal emulation */
Emulation();
~Emulation();
/**
* Creates a new window onto the output from this emulation. The contents
* of the window are then rendered by views which are set to use this window using the
* TerminalDisplay::setScreenWindow() method.
*/
ScreenWindow* createWindow();
/** Returns the size of the screen image which the emulation produces */
QSize imageSize() const;
/**
* Returns the total number of lines, including those stored in the history.
*/
int lineCount() const;
/**
* Sets the history store used by this emulation. When new lines
* are added to the output, older lines at the top of the screen are transferred to a history
* store.
*
* The number of lines which are kept and the storage location depend on the
* type of store.
*/
void setHistory(const HistoryType&);
/** Returns the history store used by this emulation. See setHistory() */
const HistoryType& history() const;
/** Clears the history scroll. */
void clearHistory();
/**
* Copies the output history from @p startLine to @p endLine
* into @p stream, using @p decoder to convert the terminal
* characters into text.
*
* @param decoder A decoder which converts lines of terminal characters with
* appearance attributes into output text. PlainTextDecoder is the most commonly
* used decoder.
* @param startLine Index of first line to copy
* @param endLine Index of last line to copy
*/
virtual void writeToStream(TerminalCharacterDecoder* decoder,int startLine,int endLine);
/** Returns the codec used to decode incoming characters. See setCodec() */
const QTextCodec* codec() const { return _codec; }
/** Sets the codec used to decode incoming characters. */
void setCodec(const QTextCodec*);
/**
* Convenience method.
* Returns true if the current codec used to decode incoming
* characters is UTF-8
*/
bool utf8() const
{ Q_ASSERT(_codec); return _codec->mibEnum() == 106; }
/** TODO Document me */
virtual char eraseChar() const;
/**
* Sets the key bindings used to key events
* ( received through sendKeyEvent() ) into character
* streams to send to the terminal.
*/
void setKeyBindings(const QString& name);
/**
* Returns the name of the emulation's current key bindings.
* See setKeyBindings()
*/
QString keyBindings() const;
/**
* Copies the current image into the history and clears the screen.
*/
virtual void clearEntireScreen() =0;
/** Resets the state of the terminal. */
virtual void reset() =0;
/**
* Returns true if the active terminal program wants
* mouse input events.
*
* The programUsesMouseChanged() signal is emitted when this
* changes.
*/
bool programUsesMouse() const;
public slots:
/** Change the size of the emulation's image */
virtual void setImageSize(int lines, int columns);
/**
* Interprets a sequence of characters and sends the result to the terminal.
* This is equivalent to calling sendKeyEvent() for each character in @p text in succession.
*/
virtual void sendText(const QString& text) = 0;
/**
* Interprets a key press event and emits the sendData() signal with
* the resulting character stream.
*/
virtual void sendKeyEvent(QKeyEvent*);
/**
* Converts information about a mouse event into an xterm-compatible escape
* sequence and emits the character sequence via sendData()
*/
virtual void sendMouseEvent(int buttons, int column, int line, int eventType);
/**
* Sends a string of characters to the foreground terminal process.
*
* @param string The characters to send.
* @param length Length of @p string or if set to a negative value, @p string will
* be treated as a null-terminated string and its length will be determined automatically.
*/
virtual void sendString(const char* string, int length = -1) = 0;
/**
* Processes an incoming stream of characters. receiveData() decodes the incoming
* character buffer using the current codec(), and then calls receiveChar() for
* each unicode character in the resulting buffer.
*
* receiveData() also starts a timer which causes the outputChanged() signal
* to be emitted when it expires. The timer allows multiple updates in quick
* succession to be buffered into a single outputChanged() signal emission.
*
* @param buffer A string of characters received from the terminal program.
* @param len The length of @p buffer
*/
void receiveData(const char* buffer,int len);
signals:
/**
* Emitted when a buffer of data is ready to send to the
* standard input of the terminal.
*
* @param data The buffer of data ready to be sent
* @param len The length of @p data in bytes
*/
void sendData(const char* data,int len);
/**
* Requests that sending of input to the emulation
* from the terminal process be suspended or resumed.
*
* @param suspend If true, requests that sending of
* input from the terminal process' stdout be
* suspended. Otherwise requests that sending of
* input be resumed.
*/
void lockPtyRequest(bool suspend);
/**
* Requests that the pty used by the terminal process
* be set to UTF 8 mode.
*
* TODO: More documentation
*/
void useUtf8Request(bool);
/**
* Emitted when the activity state of the emulation is set.
*
* @param state The new activity state, one of NOTIFYNORMAL, NOTIFYACTIVITY
* or NOTIFYBELL
*/
void stateSet(int state);
/** TODO Document me */
void zmodemDetected();
/**
* Requests that the color of the text used
* to represent the tabs associated with this
* emulation be changed. This is a Konsole-specific
* extension from pre-KDE 4 times.
*
* TODO: Document how the parameter works.
*/
void changeTabTextColorRequest(int color);
/**
* This is emitted when the program running in the shell indicates whether or
* not it is interested in mouse events.
*
* @param usesMouse This will be true if the program wants to be informed about
* mouse events or false otherwise.
*/
void programUsesMouseChanged(bool usesMouse);
/**
* Emitted when the contents of the screen image change.
* The emulation buffers the updates from successive image changes,
* and only emits outputChanged() at sensible intervals when
* there is a lot of terminal activity.
*
* Normally there is no need for objects other than the screen windows
* created with createWindow() to listen for this signal.
*
* ScreenWindow objects created using createWindow() will emit their
* own outputChanged() signal in response to this signal.
*/
void outputChanged();
/**
* Emitted when the program running in the terminal wishes to update the
* session's title. This also allows terminal programs to customize other
* aspects of the terminal emulation display.
*
* This signal is emitted when the escape sequence "\033]ARG;VALUE\007"
* is received in the input string, where ARG is a number specifying what
* should change and VALUE is a string specifying the new value.
*
* TODO: The name of this method is not very accurate since this method
* is used to perform a whole range of tasks besides just setting
* the user-title of the session.
*
* @param title Specifies what to change.
* <ul>
* <li>0 - Set window icon text and session title to @p newTitle</li>
* <li>1 - Set window icon text to @p newTitle</li>
* <li>2 - Set session title to @p newTitle</li>
* <li>11 - Set the session's default background color to @p newTitle,
* where @p newTitle can be an HTML-style string ("#RRGGBB") or a named
* color (eg 'red', 'blue').
* See http://doc.trolltech.com/4.2/qcolor.html#setNamedColor for more
* details.
* </li>
* <li>31 - Supposedly treats @p newTitle as a URL and opens it (NOT IMPLEMENTED)</li>
* <li>32 - Sets the icon associated with the session. @p newTitle is the name
* of the icon to use, which can be the name of any icon in the current KDE icon
* theme (eg: 'konsole', 'kate', 'folder_home')</li>
* </ul>
* @param newTitle Specifies the new title
*/
void titleChanged(int title,const QString& newTitle);
/**
* Emitted when the program running in the terminal changes the
* screen size.
*/
void imageSizeChanged(int lineCount , int columnCount);
/**
* Emitted when the terminal program requests to change various properties
* of the terminal display.
*
* A profile change command occurs when a special escape sequence, followed
* by a string containing a series of name and value pairs is received.
* This string can be parsed using a ProfileCommandParser instance.
*
* @param text A string expected to contain a series of key and value pairs in
* the form: name=value;name2=value2 ...
*/
void profileChangeCommandReceived(const QString& text);
/**
* Emitted when a flow control key combination ( Ctrl+S or Ctrl+Q ) is pressed.
* @param suspendKeyPressed True if Ctrl+S was pressed to suspend output or Ctrl+Q to
* resume output.
*/
void flowControlKeyPressed(bool suspendKeyPressed);
protected:
virtual void setMode(int mode) = 0;
virtual void resetMode(int mode) = 0;
/**
* Processes an incoming character. See receiveData()
* @p ch A unicode character code.
*/
virtual void receiveChar(int ch);
/**
* Sets the active screen. The terminal has two screens, primary and alternate.
* The primary screen is used by default. When certain interactive programs such
* as Vim are run, they trigger a switch to the alternate screen.
*
* @param index 0 to switch to the primary screen, or 1 to switch to the alternate screen
*/
void setScreen(int index);
enum EmulationCodec
{
LocaleCodec = 0,
Utf8Codec = 1
};
void setCodec(EmulationCodec codec); // codec number, 0 = locale, 1=utf8
QList<ScreenWindow*> _windows;
Screen* _currentScreen; // pointer to the screen which is currently active,
// this is one of the elements in the screen[] array
Screen* _screen[2]; // 0 = primary screen ( used by most programs, including the shell
// scrollbars are enabled in this mode )
// 1 = alternate ( used by vi , emacs etc.
// scrollbars are not enabled in this mode )
//decodes an incoming C-style character stream into a unicode QString using
//the current text codec. (this allows for rendering of non-ASCII characters in text files etc.)
const QTextCodec* _codec;
QTextDecoder* _decoder;
const KeyboardTranslator* _keyTranslator; // the keyboard layout
protected slots:
/**
* Schedules an update of attached views.
* Repeated calls to bufferedUpdate() in close succession will result in only a single update,
* much like the Qt buffered update of widgets.
*/
void bufferedUpdate();
private slots:
// triggered by timer, causes the emulation to send an updated screen image to each
// view
void showBulk();
void usesMouseChanged(bool usesMouse);
private:
bool _usesMouse;
QTimer _bulkTimer1;
QTimer _bulkTimer2;
};
}
#endif // ifndef EMULATION_H

@ -0,0 +1,74 @@
"keyboard \"Default (XFree 4)\""
"key Escape : \"\\E\""
"key Tab -Shift : \"\\t\"\n"
"key Tab +Shift+Ansi : \"\\E[Z\"\n"
"key Tab +Shift-Ansi : \"\\t\"\n"
"key Backtab +Ansi : \"\\E[Z\"\n"
"key Backtab -Ansi : \"\\t\"\n"
"key Return-Shift-NewLine : \"\\r\"\n"
"key Return-Shift+NewLine : \"\\r\\n\"\n"
"key Return+Shift : \"\\EOM\"\n"
"key Backspace : \"\\x7f\"\n"
"key Up -Shift-Ansi : \"\\EA\"\n"
"key Down -Shift-Ansi : \"\\EB\"\n"
"key Right-Shift-Ansi : \"\\EC\"\n"
"key Left -Shift-Ansi : \"\\ED\"\n"
"key Up -Shift-AnyMod+Ansi+AppCuKeys : \"\\EOA\"\n"
"key Down -Shift-AnyMod+Ansi+AppCuKeys : \"\\EOB\"\n"
"key Right -Shift-AnyMod+Ansi+AppCuKeys : \"\\EOC\"\n"
"key Left -Shift-AnyMod+Ansi+AppCuKeys : \"\\EOD\"\n"
"key Up -Shift-AnyMod+Ansi-AppCuKeys : \"\\E[A\"\n"
"key Down -Shift-AnyMod+Ansi-AppCuKeys : \"\\E[B\"\n"
"key Right -Shift-AnyMod+Ansi-AppCuKeys : \"\\E[C\"\n"
"key Left -Shift-AnyMod+Ansi-AppCuKeys : \"\\E[D\"\n"
"key Up -Shift+AnyMod+Ansi : \"\\E[1;*A\"\n"
"key Down -Shift+AnyMod+Ansi : \"\\E[1;*B\"\n"
"key Right -Shift+AnyMod+Ansi : \"\\E[1;*C\"\n"
"key Left -Shift+AnyMod+Ansi : \"\\E[1;*D\"\n"
"key Enter+NewLine : \"\\r\\n\"\n"
"key Enter-NewLine : \"\\r\"\n"
"key Home -AnyMod -AppCuKeys : \"\\E[H\" \n"
"key End -AnyMod -AppCuKeys : \"\\E[F\" \n"
"key Home -AnyMod +AppCuKeys : \"\\EOH\" \n"
"key End -AnyMod +AppCuKeys : \"\\EOF\" \n"
"key Home +AnyMod : \"\\E[1;*H\"\n"
"key End +AnyMod : \"\\E[1;*F\"\n"
"key Insert -AnyMod : \"\\E[2~\"\n"
"key Delete -AnyMod : \"\\E[3~\"\n"
"key Insert +AnyMod : \"\\E[2;*~\"\n"
"key Delete +AnyMod : \"\\E[3;*~\"\n"
"key Prior -Shift-AnyMod : \"\\E[5~\"\n"
"key Next -Shift-AnyMod : \"\\E[6~\"\n"
"key Prior -Shift+AnyMod : \"\\E[5;*~\"\n"
"key Next -Shift+AnyMod : \"\\E[6;*~\"\n"
"key F1 -AnyMod : \"\\EOP\"\n"
"key F2 -AnyMod : \"\\EOQ\"\n"
"key F3 -AnyMod : \"\\EOR\"\n"
"key F4 -AnyMod : \"\\EOS\"\n"
"key F5 -AnyMod : \"\\E[15~\"\n"
"key F6 -AnyMod : \"\\E[17~\"\n"
"key F7 -AnyMod : \"\\E[18~\"\n"
"key F8 -AnyMod : \"\\E[19~\"\n"
"key F9 -AnyMod : \"\\E[20~\"\n"
"key F10 -AnyMod : \"\\E[21~\"\n"
"key F11 -AnyMod : \"\\E[23~\"\n"
"key F12 -AnyMod : \"\\E[24~\"\n"
"key F1 +AnyMod : \"\\EO*P\"\n"
"key F2 +AnyMod : \"\\EO*Q\"\n"
"key F3 +AnyMod : \"\\EO*R\"\n"
"key F4 +AnyMod : \"\\EO*S\"\n"
"key F5 +AnyMod : \"\\E[15;*~\"\n"
"key F6 +AnyMod : \"\\E[17;*~\"\n"
"key F7 +AnyMod : \"\\E[18;*~\"\n"
"key F8 +AnyMod : \"\\E[19;*~\"\n"
"key F9 +AnyMod : \"\\E[20;*~\"\n"
"key F10 +AnyMod : \"\\E[21;*~\"\n"
"key F11 +AnyMod : \"\\E[23;*~\"\n"
"key F12 +AnyMod : \"\\E[24;*~\"\n"
"key Space +Control : \"\\x00\"\n"
"key Up +Shift-AppScreen : scrollLineUp\n"
"key Prior +Shift-AppScreen : scrollPageUp\n"
"key Down +Shift-AppScreen : scrollLineDown\n"
"key Next +Shift-AppScreen : scrollPageDown\n"
"key ScrollLock : scrollLock\n"
"\0"

@ -0,0 +1,557 @@
/*
Copyright 2007-2008 by Robert Knight <robertknight@gmail.com>
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
(at your option) any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
02110-1301 USA.
*/
// Own
#include "Filter.h"
// System
#include <iostream>
// Qt
#include <QAction>
#include <QApplication>
#include <QClipboard>
#include <QString>
#include <QTextStream>
#include <QSharedData>
#include <QFile>
#include <QDesktopServices>
#include <QUrl>
// KDE
//#include <KLocale>
//#include <KRun>
// Konsole
#include "TerminalCharacterDecoder.h"
#include "konsole_wcwidth.h"
using namespace Konsole;
FilterChain::~FilterChain()
{
QMutableListIterator<Filter*> iter(*this);
while ( iter.hasNext() )
{
Filter* filter = iter.next();
iter.remove();
delete filter;
}
}
void FilterChain::addFilter(Filter* filter)
{
append(filter);
}
void FilterChain::removeFilter(Filter* filter)
{
removeAll(filter);
}
bool FilterChain::containsFilter(Filter* filter)
{
return contains(filter);
}
void FilterChain::reset()
{
QListIterator<Filter*> iter(*this);
while (iter.hasNext())
iter.next()->reset();
}
void FilterChain::setBuffer(const QString* buffer , const QList<int>* linePositions)
{
QListIterator<Filter*> iter(*this);
while (iter.hasNext())
iter.next()->setBuffer(buffer,linePositions);
}
void FilterChain::process()
{
QListIterator<Filter*> iter(*this);
while (iter.hasNext())
iter.next()->process();
}
void FilterChain::clear()
{
QList<Filter*>::clear();
}
Filter::HotSpot* FilterChain::hotSpotAt(int line , int column) const
{
QListIterator<Filter*> iter(*this);
while (iter.hasNext())
{
Filter* filter = iter.next();
Filter::HotSpot* spot = filter->hotSpotAt(line,column);
if ( spot != 0 )
{
return spot;
}
}
return 0;
}
QList<Filter::HotSpot*> FilterChain::hotSpots() const
{
QList<Filter::HotSpot*> list;
QListIterator<Filter*> iter(*this);
while (iter.hasNext())
{
Filter* filter = iter.next();
list << filter->hotSpots();
}
return list;
}
//QList<Filter::HotSpot*> FilterChain::hotSpotsAtLine(int line) const;
TerminalImageFilterChain::TerminalImageFilterChain()
: _buffer(0)
, _linePositions(0)
{
}
TerminalImageFilterChain::~TerminalImageFilterChain()
{
delete _buffer;
delete _linePositions;
}
void TerminalImageFilterChain::setImage(const Character* const image , int lines , int columns, const QVector<LineProperty>& lineProperties)
{
if (empty())
return;
// reset all filters and hotspots
reset();
PlainTextDecoder decoder;
decoder.setTrailingWhitespace(false);
// setup new shared buffers for the filters to process on
QString* newBuffer = new QString();
QList<int>* newLinePositions = new QList<int>();
setBuffer( newBuffer , newLinePositions );
// free the old buffers
delete _buffer;
delete _linePositions;
_buffer = newBuffer;
_linePositions = newLinePositions;
QTextStream lineStream(_buffer);
decoder.begin(&lineStream);
for (int i=0 ; i < lines ; i++)
{
_linePositions->append(_buffer->length());
decoder.decodeLine(image + i*columns,columns,LINE_DEFAULT);
// pretend that each line ends with a newline character.
// this prevents a link that occurs at the end of one line
// being treated as part of a link that occurs at the start of the next line
//
// the downside is that links which are spread over more than one line are not
// highlighted.
//
// TODO - Use the "line wrapped" attribute associated with lines in a
// terminal image to avoid adding this imaginary character for wrapped
// lines
if ( !(lineProperties.value(i,LINE_DEFAULT) & LINE_WRAPPED) )
lineStream << QChar('\n');
}
decoder.end();
}
Filter::Filter() :
_linePositions(0),
_buffer(0)
{
}
Filter::~Filter()
{
QListIterator<HotSpot*> iter(_hotspotList);
while (iter.hasNext())
{
delete iter.next();
}
}
void Filter::reset()
{
_hotspots.clear();
_hotspotList.clear();
}
void Filter::setBuffer(const QString* buffer , const QList<int>* linePositions)
{
_buffer = buffer;
_linePositions = linePositions;
}
void Filter::getLineColumn(int position , int& startLine , int& startColumn)
{
Q_ASSERT( _linePositions );
Q_ASSERT( _buffer );
for (int i = 0 ; i < _linePositions->count() ; i++)
{
int nextLine = 0;
if ( i == _linePositions->count()-1 )
nextLine = _buffer->length() + 1;
else
nextLine = _linePositions->value(i+1);
if ( _linePositions->value(i) <= position && position < nextLine )
{
startLine = i;
startColumn = string_width(buffer()->mid(_linePositions->value(i),position - _linePositions->value(i)));
return;
}
}
}
/*void Filter::addLine(const QString& text)
{
_linePositions << _buffer.length();
_buffer.append(text);
}*/
const QString* Filter::buffer()
{
return _buffer;
}
Filter::HotSpot::~HotSpot()
{
}
void Filter::addHotSpot(HotSpot* spot)
{
_hotspotList << spot;
for (int line = spot->startLine() ; line <= spot->endLine() ; line++)
{
_hotspots.insert(line,spot);
}
}
QList<Filter::HotSpot*> Filter::hotSpots() const
{
return _hotspotList;
}
QList<Filter::HotSpot*> Filter::hotSpotsAtLine(int line) const
{
return _hotspots.values(line);
}
Filter::HotSpot* Filter::hotSpotAt(int line , int column) const
{
QListIterator<HotSpot*> spotIter(_hotspots.values(line));
while (spotIter.hasNext())
{
HotSpot* spot = spotIter.next();
if ( spot->startLine() == line && spot->startColumn() > column )
continue;
if ( spot->endLine() == line && spot->endColumn() < column )
continue;
return spot;
}
return 0;
}
Filter::HotSpot::HotSpot(int startLine , int startColumn , int endLine , int endColumn)
: _startLine(startLine)
, _startColumn(startColumn)
, _endLine(endLine)
, _endColumn(endColumn)
, _type(NotSpecified)
{
}
QString Filter::HotSpot::tooltip() const
{
return QString();
}
QList<QAction*> Filter::HotSpot::actions()
{
return QList<QAction*>();
}
int Filter::HotSpot::startLine() const
{
return _startLine;
}
int Filter::HotSpot::endLine() const
{
return _endLine;
}
int Filter::HotSpot::startColumn() const
{
return _startColumn;
}
int Filter::HotSpot::endColumn() const
{
return _endColumn;
}
Filter::HotSpot::Type Filter::HotSpot::type() const
{
return _type;
}
void Filter::HotSpot::setType(Type type)
{
_type = type;
}
RegExpFilter::RegExpFilter()
{
}
RegExpFilter::HotSpot::HotSpot(int startLine,int startColumn,int endLine,int endColumn)
: Filter::HotSpot(startLine,startColumn,endLine,endColumn)
{
setType(Marker);
}
void RegExpFilter::HotSpot::activate(const QString&)
{
}
void RegExpFilter::HotSpot::setCapturedTexts(const QStringList& texts)
{
_capturedTexts = texts;
}
QStringList RegExpFilter::HotSpot::capturedTexts() const
{
return _capturedTexts;
}
void RegExpFilter::setRegExp(const QRegExp& regExp)
{
_searchText = regExp;
}
QRegExp RegExpFilter::regExp() const
{
return _searchText;
}
/*void RegExpFilter::reset(int)
{
_buffer = QString();
}*/
void RegExpFilter::process()
{
int pos = 0;
const QString* text = buffer();
Q_ASSERT( text );
// ignore any regular expressions which match an empty string.
// otherwise the while loop below will run indefinitely
static const QString emptyString("");
if ( _searchText.exactMatch(emptyString) )
return;
while(pos >= 0)
{
pos = _searchText.indexIn(*text,pos);
if ( pos >= 0 )
{
int startLine = 0;
int endLine = 0;
int startColumn = 0;
int endColumn = 0;
getLineColumn(pos,startLine,startColumn);
getLineColumn(pos + _searchText.matchedLength(),endLine,endColumn);
RegExpFilter::HotSpot* spot = newHotSpot(startLine,startColumn,
endLine,endColumn);
spot->setCapturedTexts(_searchText.capturedTexts());
addHotSpot( spot );
pos += _searchText.matchedLength();
// if matchedLength == 0, the program will get stuck in an infinite loop
if ( _searchText.matchedLength() == 0 )
pos = -1;
}
}
}
RegExpFilter::HotSpot* RegExpFilter::newHotSpot(int startLine,int startColumn,
int endLine,int endColumn)
{
return new RegExpFilter::HotSpot(startLine,startColumn,
endLine,endColumn);
}
RegExpFilter::HotSpot* UrlFilter::newHotSpot(int startLine,int startColumn,int endLine,
int endColumn)
{
HotSpot *spot = new UrlFilter::HotSpot(startLine,startColumn,
endLine,endColumn);
connect(spot->getUrlObject(), SIGNAL(activated(QUrl)), this, SIGNAL(activated(QUrl)));
return spot;
}
UrlFilter::HotSpot::HotSpot(int startLine,int startColumn,int endLine,int endColumn)
: RegExpFilter::HotSpot(startLine,startColumn,endLine,endColumn)
, _urlObject(new FilterObject(this))
{
setType(Link);
}
QString UrlFilter::HotSpot::tooltip() const
{
QString url = capturedTexts().first();
const UrlType kind = urlType();
if ( kind == StandardUrl )
return QString();
else if ( kind == Email )
return QString();
else
return QString();
}
UrlFilter::HotSpot::UrlType UrlFilter::HotSpot::urlType() const
{
QString url = capturedTexts().first();
if ( FullUrlRegExp.exactMatch(url) )
return StandardUrl;
else if ( EmailAddressRegExp.exactMatch(url) )
return Email;
else
return Unknown;
}
void UrlFilter::HotSpot::activate(const QString& actionName)
{
QString url = capturedTexts().first();
const UrlType kind = urlType();
if ( actionName == "copy-action" )
{
QApplication::clipboard()->setText(url);
return;
}
if ( actionName.isEmpty() || actionName == "open-action" )
{
if ( kind == StandardUrl )
{
// if the URL path does not include the protocol ( eg. "www.kde.org" ) then
// prepend http:// ( eg. "www.kde.org" --> "http://www.kde.org" )
if (!url.contains("://"))
{
url.prepend("http://");
}
}
else if ( kind == Email )
{
url.prepend("mailto:");
}
_urlObject->emitActivated(url);
}
}
// Note: Altering these regular expressions can have a major effect on the performance of the filters
// used for finding URLs in the text, especially if they are very general and could match very long
// pieces of text.
// Please be careful when altering them.
//regexp matches:
// full url:
// protocolname:// or www. followed by anything other than whitespaces, <, >, ' or ", and ends before whitespaces, <, >, ', ", ], !, comma and dot
const QRegExp UrlFilter::FullUrlRegExp("(www\\.(?!\\.)|[a-z][a-z0-9+.-]*://)[^\\s<>'\"]+[^!,\\.\\s<>'\"\\]]");
// email address:
// [word chars, dots or dashes]@[word chars, dots or dashes].[word chars]
const QRegExp UrlFilter::EmailAddressRegExp("\\b(\\w|\\.|-)+@(\\w|\\.|-)+\\.\\w+\\b");
// matches full url or email address
const QRegExp UrlFilter::CompleteUrlRegExp('('+FullUrlRegExp.pattern()+'|'+
EmailAddressRegExp.pattern()+')');
UrlFilter::UrlFilter()
{
setRegExp( CompleteUrlRegExp );
}
UrlFilter::HotSpot::~HotSpot()
{
delete _urlObject;
}
void FilterObject::emitActivated(const QUrl& url)
{
emit activated(url);
}
void FilterObject::activated()
{
_filter->activate(sender()->objectName());
}
FilterObject* UrlFilter::HotSpot::getUrlObject() const
{
return _urlObject;
}
QList<QAction*> UrlFilter::HotSpot::actions()
{
QList<QAction*> list;
const UrlType kind = urlType();
QAction* openAction = new QAction(_urlObject);
QAction* copyAction = new QAction(_urlObject);;
Q_ASSERT( kind == StandardUrl || kind == Email );
if ( kind == StandardUrl )
{
openAction->setText(QObject::tr("Open Link"));
copyAction->setText(QObject::tr("Copy Link Address"));
}
else if ( kind == Email )
{
openAction->setText(QObject::tr("Send Email To..."));
copyAction->setText(QObject::tr("Copy Email Address"));
}
// object names are set here so that the hotspot performs the
// correct action when activated() is called with the triggered
// action passed as a parameter.
openAction->setObjectName( QLatin1String("open-action" ));
copyAction->setObjectName( QLatin1String("copy-action" ));
QObject::connect( openAction , SIGNAL(triggered()) , _urlObject , SLOT(activated()) );
QObject::connect( copyAction , SIGNAL(triggered()) , _urlObject , SLOT(activated()) );
list << openAction;
list << copyAction;
return list;
}
//#include "Filter.moc"

@ -0,0 +1,396 @@
/*
Copyright 2007-2008 by Robert Knight <robertknight@gmail.com>
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
(at your option) any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
02110-1301 USA.
*/
#ifndef FILTER_H
#define FILTER_H
// Qt
#include <QAction>
#include <QList>
#include <QObject>
#include <QStringList>
#include <QHash>
#include <QRegExp>
// Local
namespace Konsole
{
typedef unsigned char LineProperty;
class Character;
/**
* A filter processes blocks of text looking for certain patterns (such as URLs or keywords from a list)
* and marks the areas which match the filter's patterns as 'hotspots'.
*
* Each hotspot has a type identifier associated with it ( such as a link or a highlighted section ),
* and an action. When the user performs some activity such as a mouse-click in a hotspot area ( the exact
* action will depend on what is displaying the block of text which the filter is processing ), the hotspot's
* activate() method should be called. Depending on the type of hotspot this will trigger a suitable response.
*
* For example, if a hotspot represents a URL then a suitable action would be opening that URL in a web browser.
* Hotspots may have more than one action, in which case the list of actions can be obtained using the
* actions() method.
*
* Different subclasses of filter will return different types of hotspot.
* Subclasses must reimplement the process() method to examine a block of text and identify sections of interest.
* When processing the text they should create instances of Filter::HotSpot subclasses for sections of interest
* and add them to the filter's list of hotspots using addHotSpot()
*/
class Filter : public QObject
{
public:
/**
* Represents an area of text which matched the pattern a particular filter has been looking for.
*
* Each hotspot has a type identifier associated with it ( such as a link or a highlighted section ),
* and an action. When the user performs some activity such as a mouse-click in a hotspot area ( the exact
* action will depend on what is displaying the block of text which the filter is processing ), the hotspot's
* activate() method should be called. Depending on the type of hotspot this will trigger a suitable response.
*
* For example, if a hotspot represents a URL then a suitable action would be opening that URL in a web browser.
* Hotspots may have more than one action, in which case the list of actions can be obtained using the
* actions() method. These actions may then be displayed in a popup menu or toolbar for example.
*/
class HotSpot
{
public:
/**
* Constructs a new hotspot which covers the area from (@p startLine,@p startColumn) to (@p endLine,@p endColumn)
* in a block of text.
*/
HotSpot(int startLine , int startColumn , int endLine , int endColumn);
virtual ~HotSpot();
enum Type
{
// the type of the hotspot is not specified
NotSpecified,
// this hotspot represents a clickable link
Link,
// this hotspot represents a marker
Marker
};
/** Returns the line when the hotspot area starts */
int startLine() const;
/** Returns the line where the hotspot area ends */
int endLine() const;
/** Returns the column on startLine() where the hotspot area starts */
int startColumn() const;
/** Returns the column on endLine() where the hotspot area ends */
int endColumn() const;
/**
* Returns the type of the hotspot. This is usually used as a hint for views on how to represent
* the hotspot graphically. eg. Link hotspots are typically underlined when the user mouses over them
*/
Type type() const;
/**
* Causes the an action associated with a hotspot to be triggered.
*
* @param action The action to trigger. This is
* typically empty ( in which case the default action should be performed ) or
* one of the object names from the actions() list. In which case the associated
* action should be performed.
*/
virtual void activate(const QString& action = QString()) = 0;
/**
* Returns a list of actions associated with the hotspot which can be used in a
* menu or toolbar
*/
virtual QList<QAction*> actions();
/**
* Returns the text of a tooltip to be shown when the mouse moves over the hotspot, or
* an empty string if there is no tooltip associated with this hotspot.
*
* The default implementation returns an empty string.
*/
virtual QString tooltip() const;
protected:
/** Sets the type of a hotspot. This should only be set once */
void setType(Type type);
private:
int _startLine;
int _startColumn;
int _endLine;
int _endColumn;
Type _type;
};
/** Constructs a new filter. */
Filter();
virtual ~Filter();
/** Causes the filter to process the block of text currently in its internal buffer */
virtual void process() = 0;
/**
* Empties the filters internal buffer and resets the line count back to 0.
* All hotspots are deleted.
*/
void reset();
/** Adds a new line of text to the filter and increments the line count */
//void addLine(const QString& string);
/** Returns the hotspot which covers the given @p line and @p column, or 0 if no hotspot covers that area */
HotSpot* hotSpotAt(int line , int column) const;
/** Returns the list of hotspots identified by the filter */
QList<HotSpot*> hotSpots() const;
/** Returns the list of hotspots identified by the filter which occur on a given line */
QList<HotSpot*> hotSpotsAtLine(int line) const;
/**
* TODO: Document me
*/
void setBuffer(const QString* buffer , const QList<int>* linePositions);
protected:
/** Adds a new hotspot to the list */
void addHotSpot(HotSpot*);
/** Returns the internal buffer */
const QString* buffer();
/** Converts a character position within buffer() to a line and column */
void getLineColumn(int position , int& startLine , int& startColumn);
private:
QMultiHash<int,HotSpot*> _hotspots;
QList<HotSpot*> _hotspotList;
const QList<int>* _linePositions;
const QString* _buffer;
};
/**
* A filter which searches for sections of text matching a regular expression and creates a new RegExpFilter::HotSpot
* instance for them.
*
* Subclasses can reimplement newHotSpot() to return custom hotspot types when matches for the regular expression
* are found.
*/
class RegExpFilter : public Filter
{
public:
/**
* Type of hotspot created by RegExpFilter. The capturedTexts() method can be used to find the text
* matched by the filter's regular expression.
*/
class HotSpot : public Filter::HotSpot
{
public:
HotSpot(int startLine, int startColumn, int endLine , int endColumn);
virtual void activate(const QString& action = QString());
/** Sets the captured texts associated with this hotspot */
void setCapturedTexts(const QStringList& texts);
/** Returns the texts found by the filter when matching the filter's regular expression */
QStringList capturedTexts() const;
private:
QStringList _capturedTexts;
};
/** Constructs a new regular expression filter */
RegExpFilter();
/**
* Sets the regular expression which the filter searches for in blocks of text.
*
* Regular expressions which match the empty string are treated as not matching
* anything.
*/
void setRegExp(const QRegExp& text);
/** Returns the regular expression which the filter searches for in blocks of text */
QRegExp regExp() const;
/**
* Reimplemented to search the filter's text buffer for text matching regExp()
*
* If regexp matches the empty string, then process() will return immediately
* without finding results.
*/
virtual void process();
protected:
/**
* Called when a match for the regular expression is encountered. Subclasses should reimplement this
* to return custom hotspot types
*/
virtual RegExpFilter::HotSpot* newHotSpot(int startLine,int startColumn,
int endLine,int endColumn);
private:
QRegExp _searchText;
};
class FilterObject;
/** A filter which matches URLs in blocks of text */
class UrlFilter : public RegExpFilter
{
Q_OBJECT
public:
/**
* Hotspot type created by UrlFilter instances. The activate() method opens a web browser
* at the given URL when called.
*/
class HotSpot : public RegExpFilter::HotSpot
{
public:
HotSpot(int startLine,int startColumn,int endLine,int endColumn);
virtual ~HotSpot();
FilterObject* getUrlObject() const;
virtual QList<QAction*> actions();
/**
* Open a web browser at the current URL. The url itself can be determined using
* the capturedTexts() method.
*/
virtual void activate(const QString& action = QString());
virtual QString tooltip() const;
private:
enum UrlType
{
StandardUrl,
Email,
Unknown
};
UrlType urlType() const;
FilterObject* _urlObject;
};
UrlFilter();
protected:
virtual RegExpFilter::HotSpot* newHotSpot(int,int,int,int);
private:
static const QRegExp FullUrlRegExp;
static const QRegExp EmailAddressRegExp;
// combined OR of FullUrlRegExp and EmailAddressRegExp
static const QRegExp CompleteUrlRegExp;
signals:
void activated(const QUrl& url);
};
class FilterObject : public QObject
{
Q_OBJECT
public:
FilterObject(Filter::HotSpot* filter) : _filter(filter) {}
void emitActivated(const QUrl& url);
private slots:
void activated();
private:
Filter::HotSpot* _filter;
signals:
void activated(const QUrl& url);
};
/**
* A chain which allows a group of filters to be processed as one.
* The chain owns the filters added to it and deletes them when the chain itself is destroyed.
*
* Use addFilter() to add a new filter to the chain.
* When new text to be filtered arrives, use addLine() to add each additional
* line of text which needs to be processed and then after adding the last line, use
* process() to cause each filter in the chain to process the text.
*
* After processing a block of text, the reset() method can be used to set the filter chain's
* internal cursor back to the first line.
*
* The hotSpotAt() method will return the first hotspot which covers a given position.
*
* The hotSpots() and hotSpotsAtLine() method return all of the hotspots in the text and on
* a given line respectively.
*/
class FilterChain : protected QList<Filter*>
{
public:
virtual ~FilterChain();
/** Adds a new filter to the chain. The chain will delete this filter when it is destroyed */
void addFilter(Filter* filter);
/** Removes a filter from the chain. The chain will no longer delete the filter when destroyed */
void removeFilter(Filter* filter);
/** Returns true if the chain contains @p filter */
bool containsFilter(Filter* filter);
/** Removes all filters from the chain */
void clear();
/** Resets each filter in the chain */
void reset();
/**
* Processes each filter in the chain
*/
void process();
/** Sets the buffer for each filter in the chain to process. */
void setBuffer(const QString* buffer , const QList<int>* linePositions);
/** Returns the first hotspot which occurs at @p line, @p column or 0 if no hotspot was found */
Filter::HotSpot* hotSpotAt(int line , int column) const;
/** Returns a list of all the hotspots in all the chain's filters */
QList<Filter::HotSpot*> hotSpots() const;
/** Returns a list of all hotspots at the given line in all the chain's filters */
QList<Filter::HotSpot> hotSpotsAtLine(int line) const;
};
/** A filter chain which processes character images from terminal displays */
class TerminalImageFilterChain : public FilterChain
{
public:
TerminalImageFilterChain();
virtual ~TerminalImageFilterChain();
/**
* Set the current terminal image to @p image.
*
* @param image The terminal image
* @param lines The number of lines in the terminal image
* @param columns The number of columns in the terminal image
* @param lineProperties The line properties to set for image
*/
void setImage(const Character* const image , int lines , int columns,
const QVector<LineProperty>& lineProperties);
private:
QString* _buffer;
QList<int>* _linePositions;
};
}
typedef Konsole::Filter Filter;
#endif //FILTER_H

@ -0,0 +1,987 @@
/*
This file is part of Konsole, an X terminal.
Copyright 1997,1998 by Lars Doelle <lars.doelle@on-line.de>
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
(at your option) any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
02110-1301 USA.
*/
// Own
#include "History.h"
// System
#include <iostream>
#include <stdlib.h>
#include <assert.h>
#include <stdio.h>
#include <sys/types.h>
#include <sys/mman.h>
#include <unistd.h>
#include <errno.h>
#include <QtDebug>
// KDE
//#include <kde_file.h>
//#include <kdebug.h>
// Reasonable line size
#define LINE_SIZE 1024
#define KDE_lseek lseek
using namespace Konsole;
/*
An arbitrary long scroll.
One can modify the scroll only by adding either cells
or newlines, but access it randomly.
The model is that of an arbitrary wide typewriter scroll
in that the scroll is a serie of lines and each line is
a serie of cells with no overwriting permitted.
The implementation provides arbitrary length and numbers
of cells and line/column indexed read access to the scroll
at constant costs.
KDE4: Can we use QTemporaryFile here, instead of KTempFile?
FIXME: some complain about the history buffer comsuming the
memory of their machines. This problem is critical
since the history does not behave gracefully in cases
where the memory is used up completely.
I put in a workaround that should handle it problem
now gracefully. I'm not satisfied with the solution.
FIXME: Terminating the history is not properly indicated
in the menu. We should throw a signal.
FIXME: There is noticeable decrease in speed, also. Perhaps,
there whole feature needs to be revisited therefore.
Disadvantage of a more elaborated, say block-oriented
scheme with wrap around would be it's complexity.
*/
//FIXME: tempory replacement for tmpfile
// this is here one for debugging purpose.
//#define tmpfile xTmpFile
// History File ///////////////////////////////////////////
/*
A Row(X) data type which allows adding elements to the end.
*/
HistoryFile::HistoryFile()
: ion(-1),
length(0),
fileMap(0)
{
if (tmpFile.open())
{
tmpFile.setAutoRemove(true);
ion = tmpFile.handle();
}
}
HistoryFile::~HistoryFile()
{
if (fileMap)
unmap();
}
//TODO: Mapping the entire file in will cause problems if the history file becomes exceedingly large,
//(ie. larger than available memory). HistoryFile::map() should only map in sections of the file at a time,
//to avoid this.
void HistoryFile::map()
{
assert( fileMap == 0 );
fileMap = (char*)mmap( 0 , length , PROT_READ , MAP_PRIVATE , ion , 0 );
//if mmap'ing fails, fall back to the read-lseek combination
if ( fileMap == MAP_FAILED )
{
readWriteBalance = 0;
fileMap = 0;
qDebug() << __FILE__ << __LINE__ << ": mmap'ing history failed. errno = " << errno;
}
}
void HistoryFile::unmap()
{
int result = munmap( fileMap , length );
assert( result == 0 ); Q_UNUSED( result );
fileMap = 0;
}
bool HistoryFile::isMapped()
{
return (fileMap != 0);
}
void HistoryFile::add(const unsigned char* bytes, int len)
{
if ( fileMap )
unmap();
readWriteBalance++;
int rc = 0;
rc = KDE_lseek(ion,length,SEEK_SET); if (rc < 0) { perror("HistoryFile::add.seek"); return; }
rc = write(ion,bytes,len); if (rc < 0) { perror("HistoryFile::add.write"); return; }
length += rc;
}
void HistoryFile::get(unsigned char* bytes, int len, int loc)
{
//count number of get() calls vs. number of add() calls.
//If there are many more get() calls compared with add()
//calls (decided by using MAP_THRESHOLD) then mmap the log
//file to improve performance.
readWriteBalance--;
if ( !fileMap && readWriteBalance < MAP_THRESHOLD )
map();
if ( fileMap )
{
for (int i=0;i<len;i++)
bytes[i]=fileMap[loc+i];
}
else
{
int rc = 0;
if (loc < 0 || len < 0 || loc + len > length)
fprintf(stderr,"getHist(...,%d,%d): invalid args.\n",len,loc);
rc = KDE_lseek(ion,loc,SEEK_SET); if (rc < 0) { perror("HistoryFile::get.seek"); return; }
rc = read(ion,bytes,len); if (rc < 0) { perror("HistoryFile::get.read"); return; }
}
}
int HistoryFile::len()
{
return length;
}
// History Scroll abstract base class //////////////////////////////////////
HistoryScroll::HistoryScroll(HistoryType* t)
: m_histType(t)
{
}
HistoryScroll::~HistoryScroll()
{
delete m_histType;
}
bool HistoryScroll::hasScroll()
{
return true;
}
// History Scroll File //////////////////////////////////////
/*
The history scroll makes a Row(Row(Cell)) from
two history buffers. The index buffer contains
start of line positions which refere to the cells
buffer.
Note that index[0] addresses the second line
(line #1), while the first line (line #0) starts
at 0 in cells.
*/
HistoryScrollFile::HistoryScrollFile(const QString &logFileName)
: HistoryScroll(new HistoryTypeFile(logFileName)),
m_logFileName(logFileName)
{
}
HistoryScrollFile::~HistoryScrollFile()
{
}
int HistoryScrollFile::getLines()
{
return index.len() / sizeof(int);
}
int HistoryScrollFile::getLineLen(int lineno)
{
return (startOfLine(lineno+1) - startOfLine(lineno)) / sizeof(Character);
}
bool HistoryScrollFile::isWrappedLine(int lineno)
{
if (lineno>=0 && lineno <= getLines()) {
unsigned char flag;
lineflags.get((unsigned char*)&flag,sizeof(unsigned char),(lineno)*sizeof(unsigned char));
return flag;
}
return false;
}
int HistoryScrollFile::startOfLine(int lineno)
{
if (lineno <= 0) return 0;
if (lineno <= getLines())
{
if (!index.isMapped())
index.map();
int res;
index.get((unsigned char*)&res,sizeof(int),(lineno-1)*sizeof(int));
return res;
}
return cells.len();
}
void HistoryScrollFile::getCells(int lineno, int colno, int count, Character res[])
{
cells.get((unsigned char*)res,count*sizeof(Character),startOfLine(lineno)+colno*sizeof(Character));
}
void HistoryScrollFile::addCells(const Character text[], int count)
{
cells.add((unsigned char*)text,count*sizeof(Character));
}
void HistoryScrollFile::addLine(bool previousWrapped)
{
if (index.isMapped())
index.unmap();
int locn = cells.len();
index.add((unsigned char*)&locn,sizeof(int));
unsigned char flags = previousWrapped ? 0x01 : 0x00;
lineflags.add((unsigned char*)&flags,sizeof(unsigned char));
}
// History Scroll Buffer //////////////////////////////////////
HistoryScrollBuffer::HistoryScrollBuffer(unsigned int maxLineCount)
: HistoryScroll(new HistoryTypeBuffer(maxLineCount))
,_historyBuffer()
,_maxLineCount(0)
,_usedLines(0)
,_head(0)
{
setMaxNbLines(maxLineCount);
}
HistoryScrollBuffer::~HistoryScrollBuffer()
{
delete[] _historyBuffer;
}
void HistoryScrollBuffer::addCellsVector(const QVector<Character>& cells)
{
_head++;
if ( _usedLines < _maxLineCount )
_usedLines++;
if ( _head >= _maxLineCount )
{
_head = 0;
}
_historyBuffer[bufferIndex(_usedLines-1)] = cells;
_wrappedLine[bufferIndex(_usedLines-1)] = false;
}
void HistoryScrollBuffer::addCells(const Character a[], int count)
{
HistoryLine newLine(count);
qCopy(a,a+count,newLine.begin());
addCellsVector(newLine);
}
void HistoryScrollBuffer::addLine(bool previousWrapped)
{
_wrappedLine[bufferIndex(_usedLines-1)] = previousWrapped;
}
int HistoryScrollBuffer::getLines()
{
return _usedLines;
}
int HistoryScrollBuffer::getLineLen(int lineNumber)
{
Q_ASSERT( lineNumber >= 0 && lineNumber < _maxLineCount );
if ( lineNumber < _usedLines )
{
return _historyBuffer[bufferIndex(lineNumber)].size();
}
else
{
return 0;
}
}
bool HistoryScrollBuffer::isWrappedLine(int lineNumber)
{
Q_ASSERT( lineNumber >= 0 && lineNumber < _maxLineCount );
if (lineNumber < _usedLines)
{
//kDebug() << "Line" << lineNumber << "wrapped is" << _wrappedLine[bufferIndex(lineNumber)];
return _wrappedLine[bufferIndex(lineNumber)];
}
else
return false;
}
void HistoryScrollBuffer::getCells(int lineNumber, int startColumn, int count, Character buffer[])
{
if ( count == 0 ) return;
Q_ASSERT( lineNumber < _maxLineCount );
if (lineNumber >= _usedLines)
{
memset(buffer, 0, count * sizeof(Character));
return;
}
const HistoryLine& line = _historyBuffer[bufferIndex(lineNumber)];
//kDebug() << "startCol " << startColumn;
//kDebug() << "line.size() " << line.size();
//kDebug() << "count " << count;
Q_ASSERT( startColumn <= line.size() - count );
memcpy(buffer, line.constData() + startColumn , count * sizeof(Character));
}
void HistoryScrollBuffer::setMaxNbLines(unsigned int lineCount)
{
HistoryLine* oldBuffer = _historyBuffer;
HistoryLine* newBuffer = new HistoryLine[lineCount];
for ( int i = 0 ; i < qMin(_usedLines,(int)lineCount) ; i++ )
{
newBuffer[i] = oldBuffer[bufferIndex(i)];
}
_usedLines = qMin(_usedLines,(int)lineCount);
_maxLineCount = lineCount;
_head = ( _usedLines == _maxLineCount ) ? 0 : _usedLines-1;
_historyBuffer = newBuffer;
delete[] oldBuffer;
_wrappedLine.resize(lineCount);
dynamic_cast<HistoryTypeBuffer*>(m_histType)->m_nbLines = lineCount;
}
int HistoryScrollBuffer::bufferIndex(int lineNumber)
{
Q_ASSERT( lineNumber >= 0 );
Q_ASSERT( lineNumber < _maxLineCount );
Q_ASSERT( (_usedLines == _maxLineCount) || lineNumber <= _head );
if ( _usedLines == _maxLineCount )
{
return (_head+lineNumber+1) % _maxLineCount;
}
else
{
return lineNumber;
}
}
// History Scroll None //////////////////////////////////////
HistoryScrollNone::HistoryScrollNone()
: HistoryScroll(new HistoryTypeNone())
{
}
HistoryScrollNone::~HistoryScrollNone()
{
}
bool HistoryScrollNone::hasScroll()
{
return false;
}
int HistoryScrollNone::getLines()
{
return 0;
}
int HistoryScrollNone::getLineLen(int)
{
return 0;
}
bool HistoryScrollNone::isWrappedLine(int /*lineno*/)
{
return false;
}
void HistoryScrollNone::getCells(int, int, int, Character [])
{
}
void HistoryScrollNone::addCells(const Character [], int)
{
}
void HistoryScrollNone::addLine(bool)
{
}
// History Scroll BlockArray //////////////////////////////////////
HistoryScrollBlockArray::HistoryScrollBlockArray(size_t size)
: HistoryScroll(new HistoryTypeBlockArray(size))
{
m_blockArray.setHistorySize(size); // nb. of lines.
}
HistoryScrollBlockArray::~HistoryScrollBlockArray()
{
}
int HistoryScrollBlockArray::getLines()
{
return m_lineLengths.count();
}
int HistoryScrollBlockArray::getLineLen(int lineno)
{
if ( m_lineLengths.contains(lineno) )
return m_lineLengths[lineno];
else
return 0;
}
bool HistoryScrollBlockArray::isWrappedLine(int /*lineno*/)
{
return false;
}
void HistoryScrollBlockArray::getCells(int lineno, int colno,
int count, Character res[])
{
if (!count) return;
const Block *b = m_blockArray.at(lineno);
if (!b) {
memset(res, 0, count * sizeof(Character)); // still better than random data
return;
}
assert(((colno + count) * sizeof(Character)) < ENTRIES);
memcpy(res, b->data + (colno * sizeof(Character)), count * sizeof(Character));
}
void HistoryScrollBlockArray::addCells(const Character a[], int count)
{
Block *b = m_blockArray.lastBlock();
if (!b) return;
// put cells in block's data
assert((count * sizeof(Character)) < ENTRIES);
memset(b->data, 0, ENTRIES);
memcpy(b->data, a, count * sizeof(Character));
b->size = count * sizeof(Character);
size_t res = m_blockArray.newBlock();
assert (res > 0);
Q_UNUSED( res );
m_lineLengths.insert(m_blockArray.getCurrent(), count);
}
void HistoryScrollBlockArray::addLine(bool)
{
}
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
// Compact History Scroll //////////////////////////////////////
////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
void* CompactHistoryBlock::allocate ( size_t length )
{
Q_ASSERT ( length > 0 );
if ( tail-blockStart+length > blockLength )
return NULL;
void* block = tail;
tail += length;
//kDebug() << "allocated " << length << " bytes at address " << block;
allocCount++;
return block;
}
void CompactHistoryBlock::deallocate ( )
{
allocCount--;
Q_ASSERT ( allocCount >= 0 );
}
void* CompactHistoryBlockList::allocate(size_t size)
{
CompactHistoryBlock* block;
if ( list.isEmpty() || list.last()->remaining() < size)
{
block = new CompactHistoryBlock();
list.append ( block );
//kDebug() << "new block created, remaining " << block->remaining() << "number of blocks=" << list.size();
}
else
{
block = list.last();
//kDebug() << "old block used, remaining " << block->remaining();
}
return block->allocate(size);
}
void CompactHistoryBlockList::deallocate(void* ptr)
{
Q_ASSERT( !list.isEmpty());
int i=0;
CompactHistoryBlock *block = list.at(i);
while ( i<list.size() && !block->contains(ptr) )
{
i++;
block=list.at(i);
}
Q_ASSERT( i<list.size() );
block->deallocate();
if (!block->isInUse())
{
list.removeAt(i);
delete block;
//kDebug() << "block deleted, new size = " << list.size();
}
}
CompactHistoryBlockList::~CompactHistoryBlockList()
{
qDeleteAll ( list.begin(), list.end() );
list.clear();
}
void* CompactHistoryLine::operator new (size_t size, CompactHistoryBlockList& blockList)
{
return blockList.allocate(size);
}
CompactHistoryLine::CompactHistoryLine ( const TextLine& line, CompactHistoryBlockList& bList )
: blockList(bList),
formatLength(0)
{
length=line.size();
if (line.size() > 0) {
formatLength=1;
int k=1;
// count number of different formats in this text line
Character c = line[0];
while ( k<length )
{
if ( !(line[k].equalsFormat(c)))
{
formatLength++; // format change detected
c=line[k];
}
k++;
}
//kDebug() << "number of different formats in string: " << formatLength;
formatArray = (CharacterFormat*) blockList.allocate(sizeof(CharacterFormat)*formatLength);
Q_ASSERT (formatArray!=NULL);
text = (quint16*) blockList.allocate(sizeof(quint16)*line.size());
Q_ASSERT (text!=NULL);
length=line.size();
formatLength=formatLength;
wrapped=false;
// record formats and their positions in the format array
c=line[0];
formatArray[0].setFormat ( c );
formatArray[0].startPos=0; // there's always at least 1 format (for the entire line, unless a change happens)
k=1; // look for possible format changes
int j=1;
while ( k<length && j<formatLength )
{
if (!(line[k].equalsFormat(c)))
{
c=line[k];
formatArray[j].setFormat(c);
formatArray[j].startPos=k;
//kDebug() << "format entry " << j << " at pos " << formatArray[j].startPos << " " << &(formatArray[j].startPos) ;
j++;
}
k++;
}
// copy character values
for ( int i=0; i<line.size(); i++ )
{
text[i]=line[i].character;
//kDebug() << "char " << i << " at mem " << &(text[i]);
}
}
//kDebug() << "line created, length " << length << " at " << &(length);
}
CompactHistoryLine::~CompactHistoryLine()
{
//kDebug() << "~CHL";
if (length>0) {
blockList.deallocate(text);
blockList.deallocate(formatArray);
}
blockList.deallocate(this);
}
void CompactHistoryLine::getCharacter ( int index, Character &r )
{
Q_ASSERT ( index < length );
int formatPos=0;
while ( ( formatPos+1 ) < formatLength && index >= formatArray[formatPos+1].startPos )
formatPos++;
r.character=text[index];
r.rendition = formatArray[formatPos].rendition;
r.foregroundColor = formatArray[formatPos].fgColor;
r.backgroundColor = formatArray[formatPos].bgColor;
}
void CompactHistoryLine::getCharacters ( Character* array, int length, int startColumn )
{
Q_ASSERT ( startColumn >= 0 && length >= 0 );
Q_ASSERT ( startColumn+length <= ( int ) getLength() );
for ( int i=startColumn; i<length+startColumn; i++ )
{
getCharacter ( i, array[i-startColumn] );
}
}
CompactHistoryScroll::CompactHistoryScroll ( unsigned int maxLineCount )
: HistoryScroll ( new CompactHistoryType ( maxLineCount ) )
,lines()
,blockList()
{
//kDebug() << "scroll of length " << maxLineCount << " created";
setMaxNbLines ( maxLineCount );
}
CompactHistoryScroll::~CompactHistoryScroll()
{
qDeleteAll ( lines.begin(), lines.end() );
lines.clear();
}
void CompactHistoryScroll::addCellsVector ( const TextLine& cells )
{
CompactHistoryLine *line;
line = new(blockList) CompactHistoryLine ( cells, blockList );
if ( lines.size() > ( int ) _maxLineCount )
{
delete lines.takeAt ( 0 );
}
lines.append ( line );
}
void CompactHistoryScroll::addCells ( const Character a[], int count )
{
TextLine newLine ( count );
qCopy ( a,a+count,newLine.begin() );
addCellsVector ( newLine );
}
void CompactHistoryScroll::addLine ( bool previousWrapped )
{
CompactHistoryLine *line = lines.last();
//kDebug() << "last line at address " << line;
line->setWrapped(previousWrapped);
}
int CompactHistoryScroll::getLines()
{
return lines.size();
}
int CompactHistoryScroll::getLineLen ( int lineNumber )
{
Q_ASSERT ( lineNumber >= 0 && lineNumber < lines.size() );
CompactHistoryLine* line = lines[lineNumber];
//kDebug() << "request for line at address " << line;
return line->getLength();
}
void CompactHistoryScroll::getCells ( int lineNumber, int startColumn, int count, Character buffer[] )
{
if ( count == 0 ) return;
Q_ASSERT ( lineNumber < lines.size() );
CompactHistoryLine* line = lines[lineNumber];
Q_ASSERT ( startColumn >= 0 );
Q_ASSERT ( (unsigned int)startColumn <= line->getLength() - count );
line->getCharacters ( buffer, count, startColumn );
}
void CompactHistoryScroll::setMaxNbLines ( unsigned int lineCount )
{
_maxLineCount = lineCount;
while (lines.size() > (int) lineCount) {
delete lines.takeAt(0);
}
//kDebug() << "set max lines to: " << _maxLineCount;
}
bool CompactHistoryScroll::isWrappedLine ( int lineNumber )
{
Q_ASSERT ( lineNumber < lines.size() );
return lines[lineNumber]->isWrapped();
}
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
// History Types
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
HistoryType::HistoryType()
{
}
HistoryType::~HistoryType()
{
}
//////////////////////////////
HistoryTypeNone::HistoryTypeNone()
{
}
bool HistoryTypeNone::isEnabled() const
{
return false;
}
HistoryScroll* HistoryTypeNone::scroll(HistoryScroll *old) const
{
delete old;
return new HistoryScrollNone();
}
int HistoryTypeNone::maximumLineCount() const
{
return 0;
}
//////////////////////////////
HistoryTypeBlockArray::HistoryTypeBlockArray(size_t size)
: m_size(size)
{
}
bool HistoryTypeBlockArray::isEnabled() const
{
return true;
}
int HistoryTypeBlockArray::maximumLineCount() const
{
return m_size;
}
HistoryScroll* HistoryTypeBlockArray::scroll(HistoryScroll *old) const
{
delete old;
return new HistoryScrollBlockArray(m_size);
}
//////////////////////////////
HistoryTypeBuffer::HistoryTypeBuffer(unsigned int nbLines)
: m_nbLines(nbLines)
{
}
bool HistoryTypeBuffer::isEnabled() const
{
return true;
}
int HistoryTypeBuffer::maximumLineCount() const
{
return m_nbLines;
}
HistoryScroll* HistoryTypeBuffer::scroll(HistoryScroll *old) const
{
if (old)
{
HistoryScrollBuffer *oldBuffer = dynamic_cast<HistoryScrollBuffer*>(old);
if (oldBuffer)
{
oldBuffer->setMaxNbLines(m_nbLines);
return oldBuffer;
}
HistoryScroll *newScroll = new HistoryScrollBuffer(m_nbLines);
int lines = old->getLines();
int startLine = 0;
if (lines > (int) m_nbLines)
startLine = lines - m_nbLines;
Character line[LINE_SIZE];
for(int i = startLine; i < lines; i++)
{
int size = old->getLineLen(i);
if (size > LINE_SIZE)
{
Character *tmp_line = new Character[size];
old->getCells(i, 0, size, tmp_line);
newScroll->addCells(tmp_line, size);
newScroll->addLine(old->isWrappedLine(i));
delete [] tmp_line;
}
else
{
old->getCells(i, 0, size, line);
newScroll->addCells(line, size);
newScroll->addLine(old->isWrappedLine(i));
}
}
delete old;
return newScroll;
}
return new HistoryScrollBuffer(m_nbLines);
}
//////////////////////////////
HistoryTypeFile::HistoryTypeFile(const QString& fileName)
: m_fileName(fileName)
{
}
bool HistoryTypeFile::isEnabled() const
{
return true;
}
const QString& HistoryTypeFile::getFileName() const
{
return m_fileName;
}
HistoryScroll* HistoryTypeFile::scroll(HistoryScroll *old) const
{
if (dynamic_cast<HistoryFile *>(old))
return old; // Unchanged.
HistoryScroll *newScroll = new HistoryScrollFile(m_fileName);
Character line[LINE_SIZE];
int lines = (old != 0) ? old->getLines() : 0;
for(int i = 0; i < lines; i++)
{
int size = old->getLineLen(i);
if (size > LINE_SIZE)
{
Character *tmp_line = new Character[size];
old->getCells(i, 0, size, tmp_line);
newScroll->addCells(tmp_line, size);
newScroll->addLine(old->isWrappedLine(i));
delete [] tmp_line;
}
else
{
old->getCells(i, 0, size, line);
newScroll->addCells(line, size);
newScroll->addLine(old->isWrappedLine(i));
}
}
delete old;
return newScroll;
}
int HistoryTypeFile::maximumLineCount() const
{
return 0;
}
//////////////////////////////
CompactHistoryType::CompactHistoryType ( unsigned int nbLines )
: m_nbLines ( nbLines )
{
}
bool CompactHistoryType::isEnabled() const
{
return true;
}
int CompactHistoryType::maximumLineCount() const
{
return m_nbLines;
}
HistoryScroll* CompactHistoryType::scroll ( HistoryScroll *old ) const
{
if ( old )
{
CompactHistoryScroll *oldBuffer = dynamic_cast<CompactHistoryScroll*> ( old );
if ( oldBuffer )
{
oldBuffer->setMaxNbLines ( m_nbLines );
return oldBuffer;
}
delete old;
}
return new CompactHistoryScroll ( m_nbLines );
}

@ -0,0 +1,493 @@
/*
This file is part of Konsole, an X terminal.
Copyright 1997,1998 by Lars Doelle <lars.doelle@on-line.de>
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
(at your option) any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
02110-1301 USA.
*/
#ifndef TEHISTORY_H
#define TEHISTORY_H
// Qt
#include <QBitRef>
#include <QHash>
#include <QVector>
#include <QTemporaryFile>
// KDE
//#include <ktemporaryfile.h>
// Konsole
#include "BlockArray.h"
#include "Character.h"
// map
#include <sys/mman.h>
namespace Konsole
{
#if 1
/*
An extendable tmpfile(1) based buffer.
*/
class HistoryFile
{
public:
HistoryFile();
virtual ~HistoryFile();
virtual void add(const unsigned char* bytes, int len);
virtual void get(unsigned char* bytes, int len, int loc);
virtual int len();
//mmaps the file in read-only mode
void map();
//un-mmaps the file
void unmap();
//returns true if the file is mmap'ed
bool isMapped();
private:
int ion;
int length;
QTemporaryFile tmpFile;
//pointer to start of mmap'ed file data, or 0 if the file is not mmap'ed
char* fileMap;
//incremented whenver 'add' is called and decremented whenever
//'get' is called.
//this is used to detect when a large number of lines are being read and processed from the history
//and automatically mmap the file for better performance (saves the overhead of many lseek-read calls).
int readWriteBalance;
//when readWriteBalance goes below this threshold, the file will be mmap'ed automatically
static const int MAP_THRESHOLD = -1000;
};
#endif
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
// Abstract base class for file and buffer versions
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
class HistoryType;
class HistoryScroll
{
public:
HistoryScroll(HistoryType*);
virtual ~HistoryScroll();
virtual bool hasScroll();
// access to history
virtual int getLines() = 0;
virtual int getLineLen(int lineno) = 0;
virtual void getCells(int lineno, int colno, int count, Character res[]) = 0;
virtual bool isWrappedLine(int lineno) = 0;
// backward compatibility (obsolete)
Character getCell(int lineno, int colno) { Character res; getCells(lineno,colno,1,&res); return res; }
// adding lines.
virtual void addCells(const Character a[], int count) = 0;
// convenience method - this is virtual so that subclasses can take advantage
// of QVector's implicit copying
virtual void addCellsVector(const QVector<Character>& cells)
{
addCells(cells.data(),cells.size());
}
virtual void addLine(bool previousWrapped=false) = 0;
//
// FIXME: Passing around constant references to HistoryType instances
// is very unsafe, because those references will no longer
// be valid if the history scroll is deleted.
//
const HistoryType& getType() { return *m_histType; }
protected:
HistoryType* m_histType;
};
#if 1
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
// File-based history (e.g. file log, no limitation in length)
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
class HistoryScrollFile : public HistoryScroll
{
public:
HistoryScrollFile(const QString &logFileName);
virtual ~HistoryScrollFile();
virtual int getLines();
virtual int getLineLen(int lineno);
virtual void getCells(int lineno, int colno, int count, Character res[]);
virtual bool isWrappedLine(int lineno);
virtual void addCells(const Character a[], int count);
virtual void addLine(bool previousWrapped=false);
private:
int startOfLine(int lineno);
QString m_logFileName;
HistoryFile index; // lines Row(int)
HistoryFile cells; // text Row(Character)
HistoryFile lineflags; // flags Row(unsigned char)
};
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
// Buffer-based history (limited to a fixed nb of lines)
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
class HistoryScrollBuffer : public HistoryScroll
{
public:
typedef QVector<Character> HistoryLine;
HistoryScrollBuffer(unsigned int maxNbLines = 1000);
virtual ~HistoryScrollBuffer();
virtual int getLines();
virtual int getLineLen(int lineno);
virtual void getCells(int lineno, int colno, int count, Character res[]);
virtual bool isWrappedLine(int lineno);
virtual void addCells(const Character a[], int count);
virtual void addCellsVector(const QVector<Character>& cells);
virtual void addLine(bool previousWrapped=false);
void setMaxNbLines(unsigned int nbLines);
unsigned int maxNbLines() { return _maxLineCount; }
private:
int bufferIndex(int lineNumber);
HistoryLine* _historyBuffer;
QBitArray _wrappedLine;
int _maxLineCount;
int _usedLines;
int _head;
//QVector<histline*> m_histBuffer;
//QBitArray m_wrappedLine;
//unsigned int m_maxNbLines;
//unsigned int m_nbLines;
//unsigned int m_arrayIndex;
//bool m_buffFilled;
};
/*class HistoryScrollBufferV2 : public HistoryScroll
{
public:
virtual int getLines();
virtual int getLineLen(int lineno);
virtual void getCells(int lineno, int colno, int count, Character res[]);
virtual bool isWrappedLine(int lineno);
virtual void addCells(const Character a[], int count);
virtual void addCells(const QVector<Character>& cells);
virtual void addLine(bool previousWrapped=false);
};*/
#endif
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
// Nothing-based history (no history :-)
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
class HistoryScrollNone : public HistoryScroll
{
public:
HistoryScrollNone();
virtual ~HistoryScrollNone();
virtual bool hasScroll();
virtual int getLines();
virtual int getLineLen(int lineno);
virtual void getCells(int lineno, int colno, int count, Character res[]);
virtual bool isWrappedLine(int lineno);
virtual void addCells(const Character a[], int count);
virtual void addLine(bool previousWrapped=false);
};
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
// BlockArray-based history
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
class HistoryScrollBlockArray : public HistoryScroll
{
public:
HistoryScrollBlockArray(size_t size);
virtual ~HistoryScrollBlockArray();
virtual int getLines();
virtual int getLineLen(int lineno);
virtual void getCells(int lineno, int colno, int count, Character res[]);
virtual bool isWrappedLine(int lineno);
virtual void addCells(const Character a[], int count);
virtual void addLine(bool previousWrapped=false);
protected:
BlockArray m_blockArray;
QHash<int,size_t> m_lineLengths;
};
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
// History using compact storage
// This implementation uses a list of fixed-sized blocks
// where history lines are allocated in (avoids heap fragmentation)
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
typedef QVector<Character> TextLine;
class CharacterFormat
{
public:
bool equalsFormat(const CharacterFormat &other) const {
return other.rendition==rendition && other.fgColor==fgColor && other.bgColor==bgColor;
}
bool equalsFormat(const Character &c) const {
return c.rendition==rendition && c.foregroundColor==fgColor && c.backgroundColor==bgColor;
}
void setFormat(const Character& c) {
rendition=c.rendition;
fgColor=c.foregroundColor;
bgColor=c.backgroundColor;
}
CharacterColor fgColor, bgColor;
quint16 startPos;
quint8 rendition;
};
class CompactHistoryBlock
{
public:
CompactHistoryBlock(){
blockLength = 4096*64; // 256kb
head = (quint8*) mmap(0, blockLength, PROT_READ|PROT_WRITE, MAP_PRIVATE|MAP_ANON, -1, 0);
//head = (quint8*) malloc(blockLength);
Q_ASSERT(head != MAP_FAILED);
tail = blockStart = head;
allocCount=0;
}
virtual ~CompactHistoryBlock(){
//free(blockStart);
munmap(blockStart, blockLength);
}
virtual unsigned int remaining(){ return blockStart+blockLength-tail;}
virtual unsigned length() { return blockLength; }
virtual void* allocate(size_t length);
virtual bool contains(void *addr) {return addr>=blockStart && addr<(blockStart+blockLength);}
virtual void deallocate();
virtual bool isInUse(){ return allocCount!=0; } ;
private:
size_t blockLength;
quint8* head;
quint8* tail;
quint8* blockStart;
int allocCount;
};
class CompactHistoryBlockList {
public:
CompactHistoryBlockList() {};
~CompactHistoryBlockList();
void *allocate( size_t size );
void deallocate(void *);
int length() {return list.size();}
private:
QList<CompactHistoryBlock*> list;
};
class CompactHistoryLine
{
public:
CompactHistoryLine(const TextLine&, CompactHistoryBlockList& blockList);
virtual ~CompactHistoryLine();
// custom new operator to allocate memory from custom pool instead of heap
static void *operator new( size_t size, CompactHistoryBlockList& blockList);
static void operator delete( void *) { /* do nothing, deallocation from pool is done in destructor*/ } ;
virtual void getCharacters(Character* array, int length, int startColumn) ;
virtual void getCharacter(int index, Character &r) ;
virtual bool isWrapped() const {return wrapped;};
virtual void setWrapped(bool isWrapped) { wrapped=isWrapped;};
virtual unsigned int getLength() const {return length;};
protected:
CompactHistoryBlockList& blockList;
CharacterFormat* formatArray;
quint16 length;
quint16* text;
quint16 formatLength;
bool wrapped;
};
class CompactHistoryScroll : public HistoryScroll
{
typedef QList<CompactHistoryLine*> HistoryArray;
public:
CompactHistoryScroll(unsigned int maxNbLines = 1000);
virtual ~CompactHistoryScroll();
virtual int getLines();
virtual int getLineLen(int lineno);
virtual void getCells(int lineno, int colno, int count, Character res[]);
virtual bool isWrappedLine(int lineno);
virtual void addCells(const Character a[], int count);
virtual void addCellsVector(const TextLine& cells);
virtual void addLine(bool previousWrapped=false);
void setMaxNbLines(unsigned int nbLines);
unsigned int maxNbLines() const { return _maxLineCount; }
private:
bool hasDifferentColors(const TextLine& line) const;
HistoryArray lines;
CompactHistoryBlockList blockList;
unsigned int _maxLineCount;
};
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
// History type
//////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
class HistoryType
{
public:
HistoryType();
virtual ~HistoryType();
/**
* Returns true if the history is enabled ( can store lines of output )
* or false otherwise.
*/
virtual bool isEnabled() const = 0;
/**
* Returns true if the history size is unlimited.
*/
bool isUnlimited() const { return maximumLineCount() == 0; }
/**
* Returns the maximum number of lines which this history type
* can store or 0 if the history can store an unlimited number of lines.
*/
virtual int maximumLineCount() const = 0;
virtual HistoryScroll* scroll(HistoryScroll *) const = 0;
};
class HistoryTypeNone : public HistoryType
{
public:
HistoryTypeNone();
virtual bool isEnabled() const;
virtual int maximumLineCount() const;
virtual HistoryScroll* scroll(HistoryScroll *) const;
};
class HistoryTypeBlockArray : public HistoryType
{
public:
HistoryTypeBlockArray(size_t size);
virtual bool isEnabled() const;
virtual int maximumLineCount() const;
virtual HistoryScroll* scroll(HistoryScroll *) const;
protected:
size_t m_size;
};
#if 1
class HistoryTypeFile : public HistoryType
{
public:
HistoryTypeFile(const QString& fileName=QString());
virtual bool isEnabled() const;
virtual const QString& getFileName() const;
virtual int maximumLineCount() const;
virtual HistoryScroll* scroll(HistoryScroll *) const;
protected:
QString m_fileName;
};
class HistoryTypeBuffer : public HistoryType
{
friend class HistoryScrollBuffer;
public:
HistoryTypeBuffer(unsigned int nbLines);
virtual bool isEnabled() const;
virtual int maximumLineCount() const;
virtual HistoryScroll* scroll(HistoryScroll *) const;
protected:
unsigned int m_nbLines;
};
class CompactHistoryType : public HistoryType
{
public:
CompactHistoryType(unsigned int size);
virtual bool isEnabled() const;
virtual int maximumLineCount() const;
virtual HistoryScroll* scroll(HistoryScroll *) const;
protected:
unsigned int m_nbLines;
};
#endif
}
#endif // TEHISTORY_H

@ -0,0 +1,157 @@
/*
Copyright 2013 Christian Surlykke
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
(at your option) any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
02110-1301 USA.
*/
#include <QApplication>
#include <QTextStream>
#include <QDebug>
#include "TerminalCharacterDecoder.h"
#include "Emulation.h"
#include "HistorySearch.h"
HistorySearch::HistorySearch(EmulationPtr emulation, QRegExp regExp,
bool forwards, int startColumn, int startLine,
QObject* parent) :
QObject(parent),
m_emulation(emulation),
m_regExp(regExp),
m_forwards(forwards),
m_startColumn(startColumn),
m_startLine(startLine) {
}
HistorySearch::~HistorySearch() {
}
void HistorySearch::search() {
bool found = false;
if (! m_regExp.isEmpty())
{
if (m_forwards) {
found = search(m_startColumn, m_startLine, -1, m_emulation->lineCount()) || search(0, 0, m_startColumn, m_startLine);
} else {
found = search(0, 0, m_startColumn, m_startLine) || search(m_startColumn, m_startLine, -1, m_emulation->lineCount());
}
if (found) {
emit matchFound(m_foundStartColumn, m_foundStartLine, m_foundEndColumn, m_foundEndLine);
}
else {
emit noMatchFound();
}
}
deleteLater();
}
bool HistorySearch::search(int startColumn, int startLine, int endColumn, int endLine) {
qDebug() << "search from" << startColumn << "," << startLine
<< "to" << endColumn << "," << endLine;
int linesRead = 0;
int linesToRead = endLine - startLine + 1;
qDebug() << "linesToRead:" << linesToRead;
// We read process history from (and including) startLine to (and including) endLine in
// blocks of at most 10K lines so that we do not use unhealthy amounts of memory
int blockSize;
while ((blockSize = qMin(10000, linesToRead - linesRead)) > 0) {
QString string;
QTextStream searchStream(&string);
PlainTextDecoder decoder;
decoder.begin(&searchStream);
decoder.setRecordLinePositions(true);
// Calculate lines to read and read them
int blockStartLine = m_forwards ? startLine + linesRead : endLine - linesRead - blockSize + 1;
int chunkEndLine = blockStartLine + blockSize - 1;
m_emulation->writeToStream(&decoder, blockStartLine, chunkEndLine);
// We search between startColumn in the first line of the string and endColumn in the last
// line of the string. First we calculate the position (in the string) of endColumn in the
// last line of the string
int endPosition;
// The String that Emulator.writeToStream produces has a newline at the end, and so ends with an
// empty line - we ignore that.
int numberOfLinesInString = decoder.linePositions().size() - 1;
if (numberOfLinesInString > 0 && endColumn > -1 )
{
endPosition = decoder.linePositions().at(numberOfLinesInString - 1) + endColumn;
}
else
{
endPosition = string.size();
}
// So now we can log for m_regExp in the string between startColumn and endPosition
int matchStart;
if (m_forwards)
{
matchStart = string.indexOf(m_regExp, startColumn);
if (matchStart >= endPosition)
matchStart = -1;
}
else
{
matchStart = string.lastIndexOf(m_regExp, endPosition - 1);
if (matchStart < startColumn)
matchStart = -1;
}
if (matchStart > -1)
{
int matchEnd = matchStart + m_regExp.matchedLength() - 1;
qDebug() << "Found in string from" << matchStart << "to" << matchEnd;
// Translate startPos and endPos to startColum, startLine, endColumn and endLine in history.
int startLineNumberInString = findLineNumberInString(decoder.linePositions(), matchStart);
m_foundStartColumn = matchStart - decoder.linePositions().at(startLineNumberInString);
m_foundStartLine = startLineNumberInString + startLine + linesRead;
int endLineNumberInString = findLineNumberInString(decoder.linePositions(), matchEnd);
m_foundEndColumn = matchEnd - decoder.linePositions().at(endLineNumberInString);
m_foundEndLine = endLineNumberInString + startLine + linesRead;
qDebug() << "m_foundStartColumn" << m_foundStartColumn
<< "m_foundStartLine" << m_foundEndLine
<< "m_foundEndColumn" << m_foundEndColumn
<< "m_foundEndLine" << m_foundEndLine;
return true;
}
linesRead += blockSize;
}
qDebug() << "Not found";
return false;
}
int HistorySearch::findLineNumberInString(QList<int> linePositions, int position) {
int lineNum = 0;
while (lineNum + 1 < linePositions.size() && linePositions[lineNum + 1] <= position)
lineNum++;
return lineNum;
}

@ -0,0 +1,70 @@
/*
Copyright 2013 Christian Surlykke
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
(at your option) any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
02110-1301 USA.
*/
#ifndef TASK_H
#define TASK_H
#include <QObject>
#include <QPointer>
#include <QMap>
#include <Session.h>
#include <ScreenWindow.h>
#include "Emulation.h"
#include "TerminalCharacterDecoder.h"
using namespace Konsole;
typedef QPointer<Emulation> EmulationPtr;
class HistorySearch : public QObject
{
Q_OBJECT
public:
explicit HistorySearch(EmulationPtr emulation, QRegExp regExp, bool forwards,
int startColumn, int startLine, QObject* parent);
~HistorySearch();
void search();
signals:
void matchFound(int startColumn, int startLine, int endColumn, int endLine);
void noMatchFound();
private:
bool search(int startColumn, int startLine, int endColumn, int endLine);
int findLineNumberInString(QList<int> linePositions, int position);
EmulationPtr m_emulation;
QRegExp m_regExp;
bool m_forwards;
int m_startColumn;
int m_startLine;
int m_foundStartColumn;
int m_foundStartLine;
int m_foundEndColumn;
int m_foundEndLine;
};
#endif /* TASK_H */

@ -0,0 +1,894 @@
/*
This source file is part of Konsole, a terminal emulator.
Copyright 2007-2008 by Robert Knight <robertknight@gmail.com>
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
(at your option) any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
02110-1301 USA.
*/
// Own
#include "KeyboardTranslator.h"
// System
#include <ctype.h>
#include <stdio.h>
// Qt
#include <QBuffer>
#include <QFile>
#include <QFileInfo>
#include <QTextStream>
#include <QKeySequence>
#include <QDir>
#include <QtDebug>
#include "tools.h"
// KDE
//#include <KDebug>
//#include <KLocale>
//#include <KStandardDirs>
using namespace Konsole;
const QByteArray KeyboardTranslatorManager::defaultTranslatorText(
"keyboard \"Fallback Key Translator\"\n"
"key Tab : \"\\t\""
);
KeyboardTranslatorManager::KeyboardTranslatorManager()
: _haveLoadedAll(false)
{
}
KeyboardTranslatorManager::~KeyboardTranslatorManager()
{
qDeleteAll(_translators);
}
QString KeyboardTranslatorManager::findTranslatorPath(const QString& name)
{
return QString(get_kb_layout_dir() + name + ".keytab");
//return KGlobal::dirs()->findResource("data","konsole/"+name+".keytab");
}
void KeyboardTranslatorManager::findTranslators()
{
QDir dir(get_kb_layout_dir());
QStringList filters;
filters << "*.keytab";
dir.setNameFilters(filters);
QStringList list = dir.entryList(filters);
list = dir.entryList(filters);
// QStringList list = KGlobal::dirs()->findAllResources("data",
// "konsole/*.keytab",
// KStandardDirs::NoDuplicates);
// add the name of each translator to the list and associated
// the name with a null pointer to indicate that the translator
// has not yet been loaded from disk
QStringListIterator listIter(list);
while (listIter.hasNext())
{
QString translatorPath = listIter.next();
QString name = QFileInfo(translatorPath).baseName();
if ( !_translators.contains(name) )
_translators.insert(name,0);
}
_haveLoadedAll = true;
}
const KeyboardTranslator* KeyboardTranslatorManager::findTranslator(const QString& name)
{
if ( name.isEmpty() )
return defaultTranslator();
if ( _translators.contains(name) && _translators[name] != 0 )
return _translators[name];
KeyboardTranslator* translator = loadTranslator(name);
if ( translator != 0 )
_translators[name] = translator;
else if ( !name.isEmpty() )
qDebug() << "Unable to load translator" << name;
return translator;
}
bool KeyboardTranslatorManager::saveTranslator(const KeyboardTranslator* translator)
{
qDebug() << "KeyboardTranslatorManager::saveTranslator" << "unimplemented";
Q_UNUSED(translator);
#if 0
const QString path = KGlobal::dirs()->saveLocation("data","konsole/")+translator->name()
+".keytab";
//kDebug() << "Saving translator to" << path;
QFile destination(path);
if (!destination.open(QIODevice::WriteOnly | QIODevice::Text))
{
qDebug() << "Unable to save keyboard translation:"
<< destination.errorString();
return false;
}
{
KeyboardTranslatorWriter writer(&destination);
writer.writeHeader(translator->description());
QListIterator<KeyboardTranslator::Entry> iter(translator->entries());
while ( iter.hasNext() )
writer.writeEntry(iter.next());
}
destination.close();
#endif
return true;
}
KeyboardTranslator* KeyboardTranslatorManager::loadTranslator(const QString& name)
{
const QString& path = findTranslatorPath(name);
QFile source(path);
if (name.isEmpty() || !source.open(QIODevice::ReadOnly | QIODevice::Text))
return 0;
return loadTranslator(&source,name);
}
const KeyboardTranslator* KeyboardTranslatorManager::defaultTranslator()
{
// Try to find the default.keytab file if it exists, otherwise
// fall back to the hard-coded one
const KeyboardTranslator* translator = findTranslator("default");
if (!translator)
{
QBuffer textBuffer;
textBuffer.setData(defaultTranslatorText);
textBuffer.open(QIODevice::ReadOnly);
translator = loadTranslator(&textBuffer,"fallback");
}
return translator;
}
KeyboardTranslator* KeyboardTranslatorManager::loadTranslator(QIODevice* source,const QString& name)
{
KeyboardTranslator* translator = new KeyboardTranslator(name);
KeyboardTranslatorReader reader(source);
translator->setDescription( reader.description() );
while ( reader.hasNextEntry() )
translator->addEntry(reader.nextEntry());
source->close();
if ( !reader.parseError() )
{
return translator;
}
else
{
delete translator;
return 0;
}
}
KeyboardTranslatorWriter::KeyboardTranslatorWriter(QIODevice* destination)
: _destination(destination)
{
Q_ASSERT( destination && destination->isWritable() );
_writer = new QTextStream(_destination);
}
KeyboardTranslatorWriter::~KeyboardTranslatorWriter()
{
delete _writer;
}
void KeyboardTranslatorWriter::writeHeader( const QString& description )
{
*_writer << "keyboard \"" << description << '\"' << '\n';
}
void KeyboardTranslatorWriter::writeEntry( const KeyboardTranslator::Entry& entry )
{
QString result;
if ( entry.command() != KeyboardTranslator::NoCommand )
result = entry.resultToString();
else
result = '\"' + entry.resultToString() + '\"';
*_writer << "key " << entry.conditionToString() << " : " << result << '\n';
}
// each line of the keyboard translation file is one of:
//
// - keyboard "name"
// - key KeySequence : "characters"
// - key KeySequence : CommandName
//
// KeySequence begins with the name of the key ( taken from the Qt::Key enum )
// and is followed by the keyboard modifiers and state flags ( with + or - in front
// of each modifier or flag to indicate whether it is required ). All keyboard modifiers
// and flags are optional, if a particular modifier or state is not specified it is
// assumed not to be a part of the sequence. The key sequence may contain whitespace
//
// eg: "key Up+Shift : scrollLineUp"
// "key Next-Shift : "\E[6~"
//
// (lines containing only whitespace are ignored, parseLine assumes that comments have
// already been removed)
//
KeyboardTranslatorReader::KeyboardTranslatorReader( QIODevice* source )
: _source(source)
, _hasNext(false)
{
// read input until we find the description
while ( _description.isEmpty() && !source->atEnd() )
{
QList<Token> tokens = tokenize( QString(source->readLine()) );
if ( !tokens.isEmpty() && tokens.first().type == Token::TitleKeyword )
_description = tokens[1].text.toUtf8();
}
// read first entry (if any)
readNext();
}
void KeyboardTranslatorReader::readNext()
{
// find next entry
while ( !_source->atEnd() )
{
const QList<Token>& tokens = tokenize( QString(_source->readLine()) );
if ( !tokens.isEmpty() && tokens.first().type == Token::KeyKeyword )
{
KeyboardTranslator::States flags = KeyboardTranslator::NoState;
KeyboardTranslator::States flagMask = KeyboardTranslator::NoState;
Qt::KeyboardModifiers modifiers = Qt::NoModifier;
Qt::KeyboardModifiers modifierMask = Qt::NoModifier;
int keyCode = Qt::Key_unknown;
decodeSequence(tokens[1].text.toLower(),
keyCode,
modifiers,
modifierMask,
flags,
flagMask);
KeyboardTranslator::Command command = KeyboardTranslator::NoCommand;
QByteArray text;
// get text or command
if ( tokens[2].type == Token::OutputText )
{
text = tokens[2].text.toLocal8Bit();
}
else if ( tokens[2].type == Token::Command )
{
// identify command
if (!parseAsCommand(tokens[2].text,command))
qDebug() << "Command" << tokens[2].text << "not understood.";
}
KeyboardTranslator::Entry newEntry;
newEntry.setKeyCode( keyCode );
newEntry.setState( flags );
newEntry.setStateMask( flagMask );
newEntry.setModifiers( modifiers );
newEntry.setModifierMask( modifierMask );
newEntry.setText( text );
newEntry.setCommand( command );
_nextEntry = newEntry;
_hasNext = true;
return;
}
}
_hasNext = false;
}
bool KeyboardTranslatorReader::parseAsCommand(const QString& text,KeyboardTranslator::Command& command)
{
if ( text.compare("erase",Qt::CaseInsensitive) == 0 )
command = KeyboardTranslator::EraseCommand;
else if ( text.compare("scrollpageup",Qt::CaseInsensitive) == 0 )
command = KeyboardTranslator::ScrollPageUpCommand;
else if ( text.compare("scrollpagedown",Qt::CaseInsensitive) == 0 )
command = KeyboardTranslator::ScrollPageDownCommand;
else if ( text.compare("scrolllineup",Qt::CaseInsensitive) == 0 )
command = KeyboardTranslator::ScrollLineUpCommand;
else if ( text.compare("scrolllinedown",Qt::CaseInsensitive) == 0 )
command = KeyboardTranslator::ScrollLineDownCommand;
else if ( text.compare("scrolllock",Qt::CaseInsensitive) == 0 )
command = KeyboardTranslator::ScrollLockCommand;
else
return false;
return true;
}
bool KeyboardTranslatorReader::decodeSequence(const QString& text,
int& keyCode,
Qt::KeyboardModifiers& modifiers,
Qt::KeyboardModifiers& modifierMask,
KeyboardTranslator::States& flags,
KeyboardTranslator::States& flagMask)
{
bool isWanted = true;
bool endOfItem = false;
QString buffer;
Qt::KeyboardModifiers tempModifiers = modifiers;
Qt::KeyboardModifiers tempModifierMask = modifierMask;
KeyboardTranslator::States tempFlags = flags;
KeyboardTranslator::States tempFlagMask = flagMask;
for ( int i = 0 ; i < text.count() ; i++ )
{
const QChar& ch = text[i];
bool isFirstLetter = i == 0;
bool isLastLetter = ( i == text.count()-1 );
endOfItem = true;
if ( ch.isLetterOrNumber() )
{
endOfItem = false;
buffer.append(ch);
} else if ( isFirstLetter )
{
buffer.append(ch);
}
if ( (endOfItem || isLastLetter) && !buffer.isEmpty() )
{
Qt::KeyboardModifier itemModifier = Qt::NoModifier;
int itemKeyCode = 0;
KeyboardTranslator::State itemFlag = KeyboardTranslator::NoState;
if ( parseAsModifier(buffer,itemModifier) )
{
tempModifierMask |= itemModifier;
if ( isWanted )
tempModifiers |= itemModifier;
}
else if ( parseAsStateFlag(buffer,itemFlag) )
{
tempFlagMask |= itemFlag;
if ( isWanted )
tempFlags |= itemFlag;
}
else if ( parseAsKeyCode(buffer,itemKeyCode) )
keyCode = itemKeyCode;
else
qDebug() << "Unable to parse key binding item:" << buffer;
buffer.clear();
}
// check if this is a wanted / not-wanted flag and update the
// state ready for the next item
if ( ch == '+' )
isWanted = true;
else if ( ch == '-' )
isWanted = false;
}
modifiers = tempModifiers;
modifierMask = tempModifierMask;
flags = tempFlags;
flagMask = tempFlagMask;
return true;
}
bool KeyboardTranslatorReader::parseAsModifier(const QString& item , Qt::KeyboardModifier& modifier)
{
if ( item == "shift" )
modifier = Qt::ShiftModifier;
else if ( item == "ctrl" || item == "control" )
modifier = Qt::ControlModifier;
else if ( item == "alt" )
modifier = Qt::AltModifier;
else if ( item == "meta" )
modifier = Qt::MetaModifier;
else if ( item == "keypad" )
modifier = Qt::KeypadModifier;
else
return false;
return true;
}
bool KeyboardTranslatorReader::parseAsStateFlag(const QString& item , KeyboardTranslator::State& flag)
{
if ( item == "appcukeys" || item == "appcursorkeys" )
flag = KeyboardTranslator::CursorKeysState;
else if ( item == "ansi" )
flag = KeyboardTranslator::AnsiState;
else if ( item == "newline" )
flag = KeyboardTranslator::NewLineState;
else if ( item == "appscreen" )
flag = KeyboardTranslator::AlternateScreenState;
else if ( item == "anymod" || item == "anymodifier" )
flag = KeyboardTranslator::AnyModifierState;
else if ( item == "appkeypad" )
flag = KeyboardTranslator::ApplicationKeypadState;
else
return false;
return true;
}
bool KeyboardTranslatorReader::parseAsKeyCode(const QString& item , int& keyCode)
{
QKeySequence sequence = QKeySequence::fromString(item);
if ( !sequence.isEmpty() )
{
keyCode = sequence[0];
if ( sequence.count() > 1 )
{
qDebug() << "Unhandled key codes in sequence: " << item;
}
}
// additional cases implemented for backwards compatibility with KDE 3
else if ( item == "prior" )
keyCode = Qt::Key_PageUp;
else if ( item == "next" )
keyCode = Qt::Key_PageDown;
else
return false;
return true;
}
QString KeyboardTranslatorReader::description() const
{
return _description;
}
bool KeyboardTranslatorReader::hasNextEntry()
{
return _hasNext;
}
KeyboardTranslator::Entry KeyboardTranslatorReader::createEntry( const QString& condition ,
const QString& result )
{
QString entryString("keyboard \"temporary\"\nkey ");
entryString.append(condition);
entryString.append(" : ");
// if 'result' is the name of a command then the entry result will be that command,
// otherwise the result will be treated as a string to echo when the key sequence
// specified by 'condition' is pressed
KeyboardTranslator::Command command;
if (parseAsCommand(result,command))
entryString.append(result);
else
entryString.append('\"' + result + '\"');
QByteArray array = entryString.toUtf8();
QBuffer buffer(&array);
buffer.open(QIODevice::ReadOnly);
KeyboardTranslatorReader reader(&buffer);
KeyboardTranslator::Entry entry;
if ( reader.hasNextEntry() )
entry = reader.nextEntry();
return entry;
}
KeyboardTranslator::Entry KeyboardTranslatorReader::nextEntry()
{
Q_ASSERT( _hasNext );
KeyboardTranslator::Entry entry = _nextEntry;
readNext();
return entry;
}
bool KeyboardTranslatorReader::parseError()
{
return false;
}
QList<KeyboardTranslatorReader::Token> KeyboardTranslatorReader::tokenize(const QString& line)
{
QString text = line;
// remove comments
bool inQuotes = false;
int commentPos = -1;
for (int i=text.length()-1;i>=0;i--)
{
QChar ch = text[i];
if (ch == '\"')
inQuotes = !inQuotes;
else if (ch == '#' && !inQuotes)
commentPos = i;
}
if (commentPos != -1)
text.remove(commentPos,text.length());
text = text.simplified();
// title line: keyboard "title"
static QRegExp title("keyboard\\s+\"(.*)\"");
// key line: key KeySequence : "output"
// key line: key KeySequence : command
static QRegExp key("key\\s+([\\w\\+\\s\\-\\*\\.]+)\\s*:\\s*(\"(.*)\"|\\w+)");
QList<Token> list;
if ( text.isEmpty() )
{
return list;
}
if ( title.exactMatch(text) )
{
Token titleToken = { Token::TitleKeyword , QString() };
Token textToken = { Token::TitleText , title.capturedTexts()[1] };
list << titleToken << textToken;
}
else if ( key.exactMatch(text) )
{
Token keyToken = { Token::KeyKeyword , QString() };
Token sequenceToken = { Token::KeySequence , key.capturedTexts()[1].remove(' ') };
list << keyToken << sequenceToken;
if ( key.capturedTexts()[3].isEmpty() )
{
// capturedTexts()[2] is a command
Token commandToken = { Token::Command , key.capturedTexts()[2] };
list << commandToken;
}
else
{
// capturedTexts()[3] is the output string
Token outputToken = { Token::OutputText , key.capturedTexts()[3] };
list << outputToken;
}
}
else
{
qDebug() << "Line in keyboard translator file could not be understood:" << text;
}
return list;
}
QList<QString> KeyboardTranslatorManager::allTranslators()
{
if ( !_haveLoadedAll )
{
findTranslators();
}
return _translators.keys();
}
KeyboardTranslator::Entry::Entry()
: _keyCode(0)
, _modifiers(Qt::NoModifier)
, _modifierMask(Qt::NoModifier)
, _state(NoState)
, _stateMask(NoState)
, _command(NoCommand)
{
}
bool KeyboardTranslator::Entry::operator==(const Entry& rhs) const
{
return _keyCode == rhs._keyCode &&
_modifiers == rhs._modifiers &&
_modifierMask == rhs._modifierMask &&
_state == rhs._state &&
_stateMask == rhs._stateMask &&
_command == rhs._command &&
_text == rhs._text;
}
bool KeyboardTranslator::Entry::matches(int keyCode ,
Qt::KeyboardModifiers modifiers,
States testState) const
{
if ( _keyCode != keyCode )
return false;
if ( (modifiers & _modifierMask) != (_modifiers & _modifierMask) )
return false;
// if modifiers is non-zero, the 'any modifier' state is implicit
if ( modifiers != 0 )
testState |= AnyModifierState;
if ( (testState & _stateMask) != (_state & _stateMask) )
return false;
// special handling for the 'Any Modifier' state, which checks for the presence of
// any or no modifiers. In this context, the 'keypad' modifier does not count.
bool anyModifiersSet = modifiers != 0 && modifiers != Qt::KeypadModifier;
bool wantAnyModifier = _state & KeyboardTranslator::AnyModifierState;
if ( _stateMask & KeyboardTranslator::AnyModifierState )
{
if ( wantAnyModifier != anyModifiersSet )
return false;
}
return true;
}
QByteArray KeyboardTranslator::Entry::escapedText(bool expandWildCards,Qt::KeyboardModifiers modifiers) const
{
QByteArray result(text(expandWildCards,modifiers));
for ( int i = 0 ; i < result.count() ; i++ )
{
char ch = result[i];
char replacement = 0;
switch ( ch )
{
case 27 : replacement = 'E'; break;
case 8 : replacement = 'b'; break;
case 12 : replacement = 'f'; break;
case 9 : replacement = 't'; break;
case 13 : replacement = 'r'; break;
case 10 : replacement = 'n'; break;
default:
// any character which is not printable is replaced by an equivalent
// \xhh escape sequence (where 'hh' are the corresponding hex digits)
if ( !QChar(ch).isPrint() )
replacement = 'x';
}
if ( replacement == 'x' )
{
result.replace(i,1,"\\x"+QByteArray(1,ch).toHex());
} else if ( replacement != 0 )
{
result.remove(i,1);
result.insert(i,'\\');
result.insert(i+1,replacement);
}
}
return result;
}
QByteArray KeyboardTranslator::Entry::unescape(const QByteArray& input) const
{
QByteArray result(input);
for ( int i = 0 ; i < result.count()-1 ; i++ )
{
QByteRef ch = result[i];
if ( ch == '\\' )
{
char replacement[2] = {0,0};
int charsToRemove = 2;
bool escapedChar = true;
switch ( result[i+1] )
{
case 'E' : replacement[0] = 27; break;
case 'b' : replacement[0] = 8 ; break;
case 'f' : replacement[0] = 12; break;
case 't' : replacement[0] = 9 ; break;
case 'r' : replacement[0] = 13; break;
case 'n' : replacement[0] = 10; break;
case 'x' :
{
// format is \xh or \xhh where 'h' is a hexadecimal
// digit from 0-9 or A-F which should be replaced
// with the corresponding character value
char hexDigits[3] = {0};
if ( (i < result.count()-2) && isxdigit(result[i+2]) )
hexDigits[0] = result[i+2];
if ( (i < result.count()-3) && isxdigit(result[i+3]) )
hexDigits[1] = result[i+3];
unsigned charValue = 0;
sscanf(hexDigits,"%x",&charValue);
replacement[0] = (char)charValue;
charsToRemove = 2 + strlen(hexDigits);
}
break;
default:
escapedChar = false;
}
if ( escapedChar )
result.replace(i,charsToRemove,replacement);
}
}
return result;
}
void KeyboardTranslator::Entry::insertModifier( QString& item , int modifier ) const
{
if ( !(modifier & _modifierMask) )
return;
if ( modifier & _modifiers )
item += '+';
else
item += '-';
if ( modifier == Qt::ShiftModifier )
item += "Shift";
else if ( modifier == Qt::ControlModifier )
item += "Ctrl";
else if ( modifier == Qt::AltModifier )
item += "Alt";
else if ( modifier == Qt::MetaModifier )
item += "Meta";
else if ( modifier == Qt::KeypadModifier )
item += "KeyPad";
}
void KeyboardTranslator::Entry::insertState( QString& item , int state ) const
{
if ( !(state & _stateMask) )
return;
if ( state & _state )
item += '+' ;
else
item += '-' ;
if ( state == KeyboardTranslator::AlternateScreenState )
item += "AppScreen";
else if ( state == KeyboardTranslator::NewLineState )
item += "NewLine";
else if ( state == KeyboardTranslator::AnsiState )
item += "Ansi";
else if ( state == KeyboardTranslator::CursorKeysState )
item += "AppCursorKeys";
else if ( state == KeyboardTranslator::AnyModifierState )
item += "AnyModifier";
else if ( state == KeyboardTranslator::ApplicationKeypadState )
item += "AppKeypad";
}
QString KeyboardTranslator::Entry::resultToString(bool expandWildCards,Qt::KeyboardModifiers modifiers) const
{
if ( !_text.isEmpty() )
return escapedText(expandWildCards,modifiers);
else if ( _command == EraseCommand )
return "Erase";
else if ( _command == ScrollPageUpCommand )
return "ScrollPageUp";
else if ( _command == ScrollPageDownCommand )
return "ScrollPageDown";
else if ( _command == ScrollLineUpCommand )
return "ScrollLineUp";
else if ( _command == ScrollLineDownCommand )
return "ScrollLineDown";
else if ( _command == ScrollLockCommand )
return "ScrollLock";
return QString();
}
QString KeyboardTranslator::Entry::conditionToString() const
{
QString result = QKeySequence(_keyCode).toString();
insertModifier( result , Qt::ShiftModifier );
insertModifier( result , Qt::ControlModifier );
insertModifier( result , Qt::AltModifier );
insertModifier( result , Qt::MetaModifier );
insertModifier( result , Qt::KeypadModifier );
insertState( result , KeyboardTranslator::AlternateScreenState );
insertState( result , KeyboardTranslator::NewLineState );
insertState( result , KeyboardTranslator::AnsiState );
insertState( result , KeyboardTranslator::CursorKeysState );
insertState( result , KeyboardTranslator::AnyModifierState );
insertState( result , KeyboardTranslator::ApplicationKeypadState );
return result;
}
KeyboardTranslator::KeyboardTranslator(const QString& name)
: _name(name)
{
}
void KeyboardTranslator::setDescription(const QString& description)
{
_description = description;
}
QString KeyboardTranslator::description() const
{
return _description;
}
void KeyboardTranslator::setName(const QString& name)
{
_name = name;
}
QString KeyboardTranslator::name() const
{
return _name;
}
QList<KeyboardTranslator::Entry> KeyboardTranslator::entries() const
{
return _entries.values();
}
void KeyboardTranslator::addEntry(const Entry& entry)
{
const int keyCode = entry.keyCode();
_entries.insert(keyCode,entry);
}
void KeyboardTranslator::replaceEntry(const Entry& existing , const Entry& replacement)
{
if ( !existing.isNull() )
_entries.remove(existing.keyCode(),existing);
_entries.insert(replacement.keyCode(),replacement);
}
void KeyboardTranslator::removeEntry(const Entry& entry)
{
_entries.remove(entry.keyCode(),entry);
}
KeyboardTranslator::Entry KeyboardTranslator::findEntry(int keyCode, Qt::KeyboardModifiers modifiers, States state) const
{
foreach(const Entry& entry, _entries.values(keyCode))
{
if ( entry.matches(keyCode,modifiers,state) )
return entry;
}
return Entry(); // entry not found
}
void KeyboardTranslatorManager::addTranslator(KeyboardTranslator* translator)
{
_translators.insert(translator->name(),translator);
if ( !saveTranslator(translator) )
qDebug() << "Unable to save translator" << translator->name()
<< "to disk.";
}
bool KeyboardTranslatorManager::deleteTranslator(const QString& name)
{
Q_ASSERT( _translators.contains(name) );
// locate and delete
QString path = findTranslatorPath(name);
if ( QFile::remove(path) )
{
_translators.remove(name);
return true;
}
else
{
qDebug() << "Failed to remove translator - " << path;
return false;
}
}
//K_GLOBAL_STATIC( KeyboardTranslatorManager , theKeyboardTranslatorManager )
KeyboardTranslatorManager* KeyboardTranslatorManager::theKeyboardTranslatorManager = 0;
KeyboardTranslatorManager* KeyboardTranslatorManager::instance()
{
if (! theKeyboardTranslatorManager)
theKeyboardTranslatorManager = new KeyboardTranslatorManager();
return theKeyboardTranslatorManager;
}

@ -0,0 +1,587 @@
/*
This source file is part of Konsole, a terminal emulator.
Copyright 2007-2008 by Robert Knight <robertknight@gmail.com>
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
(at your option) any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
02110-1301 USA.
*/
#ifndef KEYBOARDTRANSLATOR_H
#define KEYBOARDTRANSLATOR_H
// Qt
#include <QHash>
#include <QList>
#include <QKeySequence>
#include <QMetaType>
#include <QVarLengthArray>
// Konsole
//#include "konsole_export.h"
#define KONSOLEPRIVATE_EXPORT
class QIODevice;
class QTextStream;
namespace Konsole
{
/**
* A convertor which maps between key sequences pressed by the user and the
* character strings which should be sent to the terminal and commands
* which should be invoked when those character sequences are pressed.
*
* Konsole supports multiple keyboard translators, allowing the user to
* specify the character sequences which are sent to the terminal
* when particular key sequences are pressed.
*
* A key sequence is defined as a key code, associated keyboard modifiers
* (Shift,Ctrl,Alt,Meta etc.) and state flags which indicate the state
* which the terminal must be in for the key sequence to apply.
*/
class KeyboardTranslator
{
public:
/**
* The meaning of a particular key sequence may depend upon the state which
* the terminal emulation is in. Therefore findEntry() may return a different
* Entry depending upon the state flags supplied.
*
* This enum describes the states which may be associated with with a particular
* entry in the keyboard translation entry.
*/
enum State
{
/** Indicates that no special state is active */
NoState = 0,
/**
* TODO More documentation
*/
NewLineState = 1,
/**
* Indicates that the terminal is in 'Ansi' mode.
* TODO: More documentation
*/
AnsiState = 2,
/**
* TODO More documentation
*/
CursorKeysState = 4,
/**
* Indicates that the alternate screen ( typically used by interactive programs
* such as screen or vim ) is active
*/
AlternateScreenState = 8,
/** Indicates that any of the modifier keys is active. */
AnyModifierState = 16,
/** Indicates that the numpad is in application mode. */
ApplicationKeypadState = 32
};
Q_DECLARE_FLAGS(States,State)
/**
* This enum describes commands which are associated with particular key sequences.
*/
enum Command
{
/** Indicates that no command is associated with this command sequence */
NoCommand = 0,
/** TODO Document me */
SendCommand = 1,
/** Scroll the terminal display up one page */
ScrollPageUpCommand = 2,
/** Scroll the terminal display down one page */
ScrollPageDownCommand = 4,
/** Scroll the terminal display up one line */
ScrollLineUpCommand = 8,
/** Scroll the terminal display down one line */
ScrollLineDownCommand = 16,
/** Toggles scroll lock mode */
ScrollLockCommand = 32,
/** Echos the operating system specific erase character. */
EraseCommand = 64
};
Q_DECLARE_FLAGS(Commands,Command)
/**
* Represents an association between a key sequence pressed by the user
* and the character sequence and commands associated with it for a particular
* KeyboardTranslator.
*/
class Entry
{
public:
/**
* Constructs a new entry for a keyboard translator.
*/
Entry();
/**
* Returns true if this entry is null.
* This is true for newly constructed entries which have no properties set.
*/
bool isNull() const;
/** Returns the commands associated with this entry */
Command command() const;
/** Sets the command associated with this entry. */
void setCommand(Command command);
/**
* Returns the character sequence associated with this entry, optionally replacing
* wildcard '*' characters with numbers to indicate the keyboard modifiers being pressed.
*
* TODO: The numbers used to replace '*' characters are taken from the Konsole/KDE 3 code.
* Document them.
*
* @param expandWildCards Specifies whether wild cards (occurrences of the '*' character) in
* the entry should be replaced with a number to indicate the modifier keys being pressed.
*
* @param modifiers The keyboard modifiers being pressed.
*/
QByteArray text(bool expandWildCards = false,
Qt::KeyboardModifiers modifiers = Qt::NoModifier) const;
/** Sets the character sequence associated with this entry */
void setText(const QByteArray& text);
/**
* Returns the character sequence associated with this entry,
* with any non-printable characters replaced with escape sequences.
*
* eg. \\E for Escape, \\t for tab, \\n for new line.
*
* @param expandWildCards See text()
* @param modifiers See text()
*/
QByteArray escapedText(bool expandWildCards = false,
Qt::KeyboardModifiers modifiers = Qt::NoModifier) const;
/** Returns the character code ( from the Qt::Key enum ) associated with this entry */
int keyCode() const;
/** Sets the character code associated with this entry */
void setKeyCode(int keyCode);
/**
* Returns a bitwise-OR of the enabled keyboard modifiers associated with this entry.
* If a modifier is set in modifierMask() but not in modifiers(), this means that the entry
* only matches when that modifier is NOT pressed.
*
* If a modifier is not set in modifierMask() then the entry matches whether the modifier
* is pressed or not.
*/
Qt::KeyboardModifiers modifiers() const;
/** Returns the keyboard modifiers which are valid in this entry. See modifiers() */
Qt::KeyboardModifiers modifierMask() const;
/** See modifiers() */
void setModifiers( Qt::KeyboardModifiers modifiers );
/** See modifierMask() and modifiers() */
void setModifierMask( Qt::KeyboardModifiers modifiers );
/**
* Returns a bitwise-OR of the enabled state flags associated with this entry.
* If flag is set in stateMask() but not in state(), this means that the entry only
* matches when the terminal is NOT in that state.
*
* If a state is not set in stateMask() then the entry matches whether the terminal
* is in that state or not.
*/
States state() const;
/** Returns the state flags which are valid in this entry. See state() */
States stateMask() const;
/** See state() */
void setState( States state );
/** See stateMask() */
void setStateMask( States mask );
/**
* Returns the key code and modifiers associated with this entry
* as a QKeySequence
*/
//QKeySequence keySequence() const;
/**
* Returns this entry's conditions ( ie. its key code, modifier and state criteria )
* as a string.
*/
QString conditionToString() const;
/**
* Returns this entry's result ( ie. its command or character sequence )
* as a string.
*
* @param expandWildCards See text()
* @param modifiers See text()
*/
QString resultToString(bool expandWildCards = false,
Qt::KeyboardModifiers modifiers = Qt::NoModifier) const;
/**
* Returns true if this entry matches the given key sequence, specified
* as a combination of @p keyCode , @p modifiers and @p state.
*/
bool matches( int keyCode ,
Qt::KeyboardModifiers modifiers ,
States flags ) const;
bool operator==(const Entry& rhs) const;
private:
void insertModifier( QString& item , int modifier ) const;
void insertState( QString& item , int state ) const;
QByteArray unescape(const QByteArray& text) const;
int _keyCode;
Qt::KeyboardModifiers _modifiers;
Qt::KeyboardModifiers _modifierMask;
States _state;
States _stateMask;
Command _command;
QByteArray _text;
};
/** Constructs a new keyboard translator with the given @p name */
KeyboardTranslator(const QString& name);
//KeyboardTranslator(const KeyboardTranslator& other);
/** Returns the name of this keyboard translator */
QString name() const;
/** Sets the name of this keyboard translator */
void setName(const QString& name);
/** Returns the descriptive name of this keyboard translator */
QString description() const;
/** Sets the descriptive name of this keyboard translator */
void setDescription(const QString& description);
/**
* Looks for an entry in this keyboard translator which matches the given
* key code, keyboard modifiers and state flags.
*
* Returns the matching entry if found or a null Entry otherwise ( ie.
* entry.isNull() will return true )
*
* @param keyCode A key code from the Qt::Key enum
* @param modifiers A combination of modifiers
* @param state Optional flags which specify the current state of the terminal
*/
Entry findEntry(int keyCode ,
Qt::KeyboardModifiers modifiers ,
States state = NoState) const;
/**
* Adds an entry to this keyboard translator's table. Entries can be looked up according
* to their key sequence using findEntry()
*/
void addEntry(const Entry& entry);
/**
* Replaces an entry in the translator. If the @p existing entry is null,
* then this is equivalent to calling addEntry(@p replacement)
*/
void replaceEntry(const Entry& existing , const Entry& replacement);
/**
* Removes an entry from the table.
*/
void removeEntry(const Entry& entry);
/** Returns a list of all entries in the translator. */
QList<Entry> entries() const;
private:
QMultiHash<int,Entry> _entries; // entries in this keyboard translation,
// entries are indexed according to
// their keycode
QString _name;
QString _description;
};
Q_DECLARE_OPERATORS_FOR_FLAGS(KeyboardTranslator::States)
Q_DECLARE_OPERATORS_FOR_FLAGS(KeyboardTranslator::Commands)
/**
* Parses the contents of a Keyboard Translator (.keytab) file and
* returns the entries found in it.
*
* Usage example:
*
* @code
* QFile source( "/path/to/keytab" );
* source.open( QIODevice::ReadOnly );
*
* KeyboardTranslator* translator = new KeyboardTranslator( "name-of-translator" );
*
* KeyboardTranslatorReader reader(source);
* while ( reader.hasNextEntry() )
* translator->addEntry(reader.nextEntry());
*
* source.close();
*
* if ( !reader.parseError() )
* {
* // parsing succeeded, do something with the translator
* }
* else
* {
* // parsing failed
* }
* @endcode
*/
class KeyboardTranslatorReader
{
public:
/** Constructs a new reader which parses the given @p source */
KeyboardTranslatorReader( QIODevice* source );
/**
* Returns the description text.
* TODO: More documentation
*/
QString description() const;
/** Returns true if there is another entry in the source stream */
bool hasNextEntry();
/** Returns the next entry found in the source stream */
KeyboardTranslator::Entry nextEntry();
/**
* Returns true if an error occurred whilst parsing the input or
* false if no error occurred.
*/
bool parseError();
/**
* Parses a condition and result string for a translator entry
* and produces a keyboard translator entry.
*
* The condition and result strings are in the same format as in
*/
static KeyboardTranslator::Entry createEntry( const QString& condition ,
const QString& result );
private:
struct Token
{
enum Type
{
TitleKeyword,
TitleText,
KeyKeyword,
KeySequence,
Command,
OutputText
};
Type type;
QString text;
};
QList<Token> tokenize(const QString&);
void readNext();
bool decodeSequence(const QString& ,
int& keyCode,
Qt::KeyboardModifiers& modifiers,
Qt::KeyboardModifiers& modifierMask,
KeyboardTranslator::States& state,
KeyboardTranslator::States& stateFlags);
static bool parseAsModifier(const QString& item , Qt::KeyboardModifier& modifier);
static bool parseAsStateFlag(const QString& item , KeyboardTranslator::State& state);
static bool parseAsKeyCode(const QString& item , int& keyCode);
static bool parseAsCommand(const QString& text , KeyboardTranslator::Command& command);
QIODevice* _source;
QString _description;
KeyboardTranslator::Entry _nextEntry;
bool _hasNext;
};
/** Writes a keyboard translation to disk. */
class KeyboardTranslatorWriter
{
public:
/**
* Constructs a new writer which saves data into @p destination.
* The caller is responsible for closing the device when writing is complete.
*/
KeyboardTranslatorWriter(QIODevice* destination);
~KeyboardTranslatorWriter();
/**
* Writes the header for the keyboard translator.
* @param description Description of the keyboard translator.
*/
void writeHeader( const QString& description );
/** Writes a translator entry. */
void writeEntry( const KeyboardTranslator::Entry& entry );
private:
QIODevice* _destination;
QTextStream* _writer;
};
/**
* Manages the keyboard translations available for use by terminal sessions,
* see KeyboardTranslator.
*/
class KONSOLEPRIVATE_EXPORT KeyboardTranslatorManager
{
public:
/**
* Constructs a new KeyboardTranslatorManager and loads the list of
* available keyboard translations.
*
* The keyboard translations themselves are not loaded until they are
* first requested via a call to findTranslator()
*/
KeyboardTranslatorManager();
~KeyboardTranslatorManager();
/**
* Adds a new translator. If a translator with the same name
* already exists, it will be replaced by the new translator.
*
* TODO: More documentation.
*/
void addTranslator(KeyboardTranslator* translator);
/**
* Deletes a translator. Returns true on successful deletion or false otherwise.
*
* TODO: More documentation
*/
bool deleteTranslator(const QString& name);
/** Returns the default translator for Konsole. */
const KeyboardTranslator* defaultTranslator();
/**
* Returns the keyboard translator with the given name or 0 if no translator
* with that name exists.
*
* The first time that a translator with a particular name is requested,
* the on-disk .keyboard file is loaded and parsed.
*/
const KeyboardTranslator* findTranslator(const QString& name);
/**
* Returns a list of the names of available keyboard translators.
*
* The first time this is called, a search for available
* translators is started.
*/
QList<QString> allTranslators();
/** Returns the global KeyboardTranslatorManager instance. */
static KeyboardTranslatorManager* instance();
private:
static const QByteArray defaultTranslatorText;
void findTranslators(); // locate the available translators
KeyboardTranslator* loadTranslator(const QString& name); // loads the translator
// with the given name
KeyboardTranslator* loadTranslator(QIODevice* device,const QString& name);
bool saveTranslator(const KeyboardTranslator* translator);
QString findTranslatorPath(const QString& name);
QHash<QString,KeyboardTranslator*> _translators; // maps translator-name -> KeyboardTranslator
// instance
bool _haveLoadedAll;
static KeyboardTranslatorManager * theKeyboardTranslatorManager;
};
inline int KeyboardTranslator::Entry::keyCode() const { return _keyCode; }
inline void KeyboardTranslator::Entry::setKeyCode(int keyCode) { _keyCode = keyCode; }
inline void KeyboardTranslator::Entry::setModifiers( Qt::KeyboardModifiers modifier )
{
_modifiers = modifier;
}
inline Qt::KeyboardModifiers KeyboardTranslator::Entry::modifiers() const { return _modifiers; }
inline void KeyboardTranslator::Entry::setModifierMask( Qt::KeyboardModifiers mask )
{
_modifierMask = mask;
}
inline Qt::KeyboardModifiers KeyboardTranslator::Entry::modifierMask() const { return _modifierMask; }
inline bool KeyboardTranslator::Entry::isNull() const
{
return ( *this == Entry() );
}
inline void KeyboardTranslator::Entry::setCommand( Command command )
{
_command = command;
}
inline KeyboardTranslator::Command KeyboardTranslator::Entry::command() const { return _command; }
inline void KeyboardTranslator::Entry::setText( const QByteArray& text )
{
_text = unescape(text);
}
inline int oneOrZero(int value)
{
return value ? 1 : 0;
}
inline QByteArray KeyboardTranslator::Entry::text(bool expandWildCards,Qt::KeyboardModifiers modifiers) const
{
QByteArray expandedText = _text;
if (expandWildCards)
{
int modifierValue = 1;
modifierValue += oneOrZero(modifiers & Qt::ShiftModifier);
modifierValue += oneOrZero(modifiers & Qt::AltModifier) << 1;
modifierValue += oneOrZero(modifiers & Qt::ControlModifier) << 2;
for (int i=0;i<_text.length();i++)
{
if (expandedText[i] == '*')
expandedText[i] = '0' + modifierValue;
}
}
return expandedText;
}
inline void KeyboardTranslator::Entry::setState( States state )
{
_state = state;
}
inline KeyboardTranslator::States KeyboardTranslator::Entry::state() const { return _state; }
inline void KeyboardTranslator::Entry::setStateMask( States stateMask )
{
_stateMask = stateMask;
}
inline KeyboardTranslator::States KeyboardTranslator::Entry::stateMask() const { return _stateMask; }
}
Q_DECLARE_METATYPE(Konsole::KeyboardTranslator::Entry)
Q_DECLARE_METATYPE(const Konsole::KeyboardTranslator*)
#endif // KEYBOARDTRANSLATOR_H

@ -0,0 +1,21 @@
// WARNING: Autogenerated by "fontembedder ./linefont.src".
// You probably do not want to hand-edit this!
static const quint32 LineChars[] = {
0x00007c00, 0x000fffe0, 0x00421084, 0x00e739ce, 0x00000000, 0x00000000, 0x00000000, 0x00000000,
0x00000000, 0x00000000, 0x00000000, 0x00000000, 0x00427000, 0x004e7380, 0x00e77800, 0x00ef7bc0,
0x00421c00, 0x00439ce0, 0x00e73c00, 0x00e7bde0, 0x00007084, 0x000e7384, 0x000079ce, 0x000f7bce,
0x00001c84, 0x00039ce4, 0x00003dce, 0x0007bdee, 0x00427084, 0x004e7384, 0x004279ce, 0x00e77884,
0x00e779ce, 0x004f7bce, 0x00ef7bc4, 0x00ef7bce, 0x00421c84, 0x00439ce4, 0x00423dce, 0x00e73c84,
0x00e73dce, 0x0047bdee, 0x00e7bde4, 0x00e7bdee, 0x00427c00, 0x0043fce0, 0x004e7f80, 0x004fffe0,
0x004fffe0, 0x00e7fde0, 0x006f7fc0, 0x00efffe0, 0x00007c84, 0x0003fce4, 0x000e7f84, 0x000fffe4,
0x00007dce, 0x0007fdee, 0x000f7fce, 0x000fffee, 0x00427c84, 0x0043fce4, 0x004e7f84, 0x004fffe4,
0x00427dce, 0x00e77c84, 0x00e77dce, 0x0047fdee, 0x004e7fce, 0x00e7fde4, 0x00ef7f84, 0x004fffee,
0x00efffe4, 0x00e7fdee, 0x00ef7fce, 0x00efffee, 0x00000000, 0x00000000, 0x00000000, 0x00000000,
0x000f83e0, 0x00a5294a, 0x004e1380, 0x00a57800, 0x00ad0bc0, 0x004390e0, 0x00a53c00, 0x00a5a1e0,
0x000e1384, 0x0000794a, 0x000f0b4a, 0x000390e4, 0x00003d4a, 0x0007a16a, 0x004e1384, 0x00a5694a,
0x00ad2b4a, 0x004390e4, 0x00a52d4a, 0x00a5a16a, 0x004f83e0, 0x00a57c00, 0x00ad83e0, 0x000f83e4,
0x00007d4a, 0x000f836a, 0x004f93e4, 0x00a57d4a, 0x00ad836a, 0x00000000, 0x00000000, 0x00000000,
0x00000000, 0x00000000, 0x00000000, 0x00000000, 0x00001c00, 0x00001084, 0x00007000, 0x00421000,
0x00039ce0, 0x000039ce, 0x000e7380, 0x00e73800, 0x000e7f80, 0x00e73884, 0x0003fce0, 0x004239ce
};

@ -0,0 +1,786 @@
#2500: single horizontal line
2500
-----
#2501: triple horizontal line
2501
-----
-----
-----
#2502: single vertical line
2502
|
|
|
|
|
#2503: triple vertical line
2503
|||
|||
|||
|||
|||
#2504-250B are dashed - not handled
#250C: top-left corner (lines on bottom + right)
250C
.--
|
|
#250D: as above, but top line triple-width
250D
.--
.--
|--
|
#250E: now the vert line triple-width
250E
..--
|||
|||
#250F: and now both lines triple-width
250F
.___
|.--
||._
|||
#2510: top-right corner
2510
--.
|
|
2511
==.
==.
==|
|
2512
==..
|||
|||
2513
===.
==.|
=.||
|||
#2514: bottom-left corner
2514
|
|
.==
2515
|
|==
|==
===
2516
|||
|||
|.==
2517
|||
||.=
|.==
.===
#2518: bottm-right corner
2518
|
|
==.
2519
|
==|
==|
===
251A
|||
|||
====
251B
|||
=.||
==.|
===.
#251C: Join of vertical line and one from the right
251C
|
|
|==
|
|
251D
|
|==
|==
|==
|
251E
|||
|||
||==
|
|
251F
|
|
||==
|||
|||
2520
|||
|||
||==
|||
|||
2521
|||
|||=
||==
.|==
|
2522
|
.|==
||==
|||=
|||
2523
|||
||.=
||==
||.=
|||
#2524: Join of vertical line and one from the left
2524
|
|
==|
|
|
2525
|
==|
==|
==|
|
2526
|||
|||
==+|
|
|
2527
|
|
==+|
|||
|||
2528
|||
|||
==+|
|||
|||
2529
|||
=+||
==+|
===+
|
252A
|
=+||
==+|
===+
|||
252B
|||
=+||
==+|
=+||
|||
#252C: horizontal line joined to from below
252C
=====
|
|
252D
===
==|==
==|
|
252E
===
==|==
|==
|
252F
==+==
==|==
==|==
|
2530
=====
=====
==|==
|
2531
===|
==||=
=|||
|||
2532
|===
=||==
||==
||
2533
=====
==|==
=+|+=
|||
#2534: bottom line, connected to from top
2534
|
|
=====
2535
|
==|
=====
===
2536
|
|==
=====
===
2537
|
==|==
=====
=====
2538
|||
|||
=====
2539
|||
==||
=====
===|
253A
|||
||==
=|===
|===
253B
|||
==|==
=====
=====
#253C: vertical + horizontal lines intersecting
253C
|
|
=====
|
|
253D
|
==|
=====
==|
|
253E
|
|==
=====
|==
|
253F
|
==|==
=====
==|==
|
2540
|||
|||
=====
|
|
2541
|
|
=====
|||
|||
2542
|||
|||
=====
|||
|||
2543
|||
=|||
=====
==|+
|
2544
|||
||==
=====
|==
|
2545
|
==|+
=====
=|||
|||
2546
|
|==
=====
||==
|||
2547
|||
=|||=
=====
=|||=
|
2548
|
=|||=
=====
=|||=
|||
2549
|||
=|||
=====
=|||
|||
254A
|||
|||=
=====
|||=
|||
254B
|||
=|||=
=====
=|||=
|||
#254C-254F are dashed
2550
_____
_____
2551
| |
| |
| |
| |
| |
2552
|--
|
|--
|
2553
----
| |
| |
2554
+---
|
+ +-
| |
2555
--+
|
--+
|
2556
-+-+
| |
| |
2557
---+
|
-+ |
| |
2558
|
+--
|
+--
2559
| |
| |
+-+-
255A
| |
| +-
|
+---
255B
|
--+
|
--+
255C
| |
| |
-+-+
255D
| |
-+ |
|
---+
255E
|
+--
|
+--
|
255F
| |
| |
| +-
| |
| |
2560
| |
| +-
| |
| +-
| |
2561
|
--+
|
--+
|
2562
| |
| |
-+ +
| |
| |
2563
| |
-+ |
|
-+ |
| |
2564
-----
--+--
|
2565
-+-+-
| |
| |
2566
-----
-+ +-
| |
2567
|
--+--
-----
2568
| |
| |
-+-+-
2569
| |
-+ +-
-----
256A
|
--+--
|
--+--
|
256B
| |
| |
-+-+-
| |
| |
256C
| |
-+ +-
-+ +-
| |
#256F-2570 are curly,
#2571-2573 are slashes and X
2574
___
2575
|
|
|
2576
___
2577
|
|
|
2578
___
___
___
2579
|||
|||
|||
257A
___
___
___
257B
|||
|||
|||
257C
___
_____
___
257D
|
|
|||
|||
|||
257E
___
_____
___
257F
|||
|||
|||
|
|

@ -0,0 +1,316 @@
/*
* This file is a part of QTerminal - http://gitorious.org/qterminal
*
* This file was un-linked from KDE and modified
* by Maxim Bourmistrov <maxim@unixconn.com>
*
*/
/*
This file is part of Konsole, an X terminal.
Copyright 1997,1998 by Lars Doelle <lars.doelle@on-line.de>
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
(at your option) any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
02110-1301 USA.
*/
// Own
#include "Pty.h"
// System
#include <sys/types.h>
#include <sys/stat.h>
#include <unistd.h>
#include <errno.h>
#include <termios.h>
#include <signal.h>
// Qt
#include <QStringList>
#include <QtDebug>
#include "kpty.h"
#include "kptydevice.h"
using namespace Konsole;
void Pty::setWindowSize(int lines, int cols)
{
_windowColumns = cols;
_windowLines = lines;
if (pty()->masterFd() >= 0)
pty()->setWinSize(lines, cols);
}
QSize Pty::windowSize() const
{
return QSize(_windowColumns,_windowLines);
}
void Pty::setFlowControlEnabled(bool enable)
{
_xonXoff = enable;
if (pty()->masterFd() >= 0)
{
struct ::termios ttmode;
pty()->tcGetAttr(&ttmode);
if (!enable)
ttmode.c_iflag &= ~(IXOFF | IXON);
else
ttmode.c_iflag |= (IXOFF | IXON);
if (!pty()->tcSetAttr(&ttmode))
qWarning() << "Unable to set terminal attributes.";
}
}
bool Pty::flowControlEnabled() const
{
if (pty()->masterFd() >= 0)
{
struct ::termios ttmode;
pty()->tcGetAttr(&ttmode);
return ttmode.c_iflag & IXOFF &&
ttmode.c_iflag & IXON;
}
qWarning() << "Unable to get flow control status, terminal not connected.";
return false;
}
void Pty::setUtf8Mode(bool enable)
{
#ifdef IUTF8 // XXX not a reasonable place to check it.
_utf8 = enable;
if (pty()->masterFd() >= 0)
{
struct ::termios ttmode;
pty()->tcGetAttr(&ttmode);
if (!enable)
ttmode.c_iflag &= ~IUTF8;
else
ttmode.c_iflag |= IUTF8;
if (!pty()->tcSetAttr(&ttmode))
qWarning() << "Unable to set terminal attributes.";
}
#endif
}
void Pty::setErase(char erase)
{
_eraseChar = erase;
if (pty()->masterFd() >= 0)
{
struct ::termios ttmode;
pty()->tcGetAttr(&ttmode);
ttmode.c_cc[VERASE] = erase;
if (!pty()->tcSetAttr(&ttmode))
qWarning() << "Unable to set terminal attributes.";
}
}
char Pty::erase() const
{
if (pty()->masterFd() >= 0)
{
struct ::termios ttyAttributes;
pty()->tcGetAttr(&ttyAttributes);
return ttyAttributes.c_cc[VERASE];
}
return _eraseChar;
}
void Pty::addEnvironmentVariables(const QStringList& environment)
{
QListIterator<QString> iter(environment);
while (iter.hasNext())
{
QString pair = iter.next();
// split on the first '=' character
int pos = pair.indexOf('=');
if ( pos >= 0 )
{
QString variable = pair.left(pos);
QString value = pair.mid(pos+1);
setEnv(variable,value);
}
}
}
int Pty::start(const QString& program,
const QStringList& programArguments,
const QStringList& environment,
ulong winid,
bool addToUtmp
//const QString& dbusService,
//const QString& dbusSession
)
{
clearProgram();
// For historical reasons, the first argument in programArguments is the
// name of the program to execute, so create a list consisting of all
// but the first argument to pass to setProgram()
Q_ASSERT(programArguments.count() >= 1);
setProgram(program.toLatin1(),programArguments.mid(1));
addEnvironmentVariables(environment);
setEnv("WINDOWID", QString::number(winid));
// unless the LANGUAGE environment variable has been set explicitly
// set it to a null string
// this fixes the problem where KCatalog sets the LANGUAGE environment
// variable during the application's startup to something which
// differs from LANG,LC_* etc. and causes programs run from
// the terminal to display messages in the wrong language
//
// this can happen if LANG contains a language which KDE
// does not have a translation for
//
// BR:149300
setEnv("LANGUAGE",QString(),false /* do not overwrite existing value if any */);
setUseUtmp(addToUtmp);
struct ::termios ttmode;
pty()->tcGetAttr(&ttmode);
if (!_xonXoff)
ttmode.c_iflag &= ~(IXOFF | IXON);
else
ttmode.c_iflag |= (IXOFF | IXON);
#ifdef IUTF8 // XXX not a reasonable place to check it.
if (!_utf8)
ttmode.c_iflag &= ~IUTF8;
else
ttmode.c_iflag |= IUTF8;
#endif
if (_eraseChar != 0)
ttmode.c_cc[VERASE] = _eraseChar;
if (!pty()->tcSetAttr(&ttmode))
qWarning() << "Unable to set terminal attributes.";
pty()->setWinSize(_windowLines, _windowColumns);
KProcess::start();
if (!waitForStarted())
return -1;
return 0;
}
void Pty::setWriteable(bool writeable)
{
struct stat sbuf;
stat(pty()->ttyName(), &sbuf);
if (writeable)
chmod(pty()->ttyName(), sbuf.st_mode | S_IWGRP);
else
chmod(pty()->ttyName(), sbuf.st_mode & ~(S_IWGRP|S_IWOTH));
}
Pty::Pty(int masterFd, QObject* parent)
: KPtyProcess(masterFd,parent)
{
init();
}
Pty::Pty(QObject* parent)
: KPtyProcess(parent)
{
init();
}
void Pty::init()
{
_windowColumns = 0;
_windowLines = 0;
_eraseChar = 0;
_xonXoff = true;
_utf8 =true;
connect(pty(), SIGNAL(readyRead()) , this , SLOT(dataReceived()));
setPtyChannels(KPtyProcess::AllChannels);
}
Pty::~Pty()
{
}
void Pty::sendData(const char* data, int length)
{
if (!length)
return;
if (!pty()->write(data,length))
{
qWarning() << "Pty::doSendJobs - Could not send input data to terminal process.";
return;
}
}
void Pty::dataReceived()
{
QByteArray data = pty()->readAll();
emit receivedData(data.constData(),data.count());
}
void Pty::lockPty(bool lock)
{
Q_UNUSED(lock);
// TODO: Support for locking the Pty
//if (lock)
//suspend();
//else
//resume();
}
int Pty::foregroundProcessGroup() const
{
int pid = tcgetpgrp(pty()->masterFd());
if ( pid != -1 )
{
return pid;
}
return 0;
}
void Pty::setupChildProcess()
{
KPtyProcess::setupChildProcess();
// reset all signal handlers
// this ensures that terminal applications respond to
// signals generated via key sequences such as Ctrl+C
// (which sends SIGINT)
struct sigaction action;
sigset_t sigset;
sigemptyset(&action.sa_mask);
action.sa_handler = SIG_DFL;
action.sa_flags = 0;
for (int signal=1;signal < NSIG; signal++) {
sigaction(signal,&action,0L);
sigaddset(&sigset, signal);
}
sigprocmask(SIG_UNBLOCK, &sigset, NULL);
}

@ -0,0 +1,209 @@
/*
* This file is a part of QTerminal - http://gitorious.org/qterminal
*
* This file was un-linked from KDE and modified
* by Maxim Bourmistrov <maxim@unixconn.com>
*
*/
/*
This file is part of Konsole, KDE's terminal emulator.
Copyright 2007-2008 by Robert Knight <robertknight@gmail.com>
Copyright 1997,1998 by Lars Doelle <lars.doelle@on-line.de>
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
(at your option) any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
02110-1301 USA.
*/
#ifndef PTY_H
#define PTY_H
// Qt
#include <QStringList>
#include <QVector>
#include <QList>
#include <QSize>
// KDE
#include "kptyprocess.h"
namespace Konsole {
/**
* The Pty class is used to start the terminal process,
* send data to it, receive data from it and manipulate
* various properties of the pseudo-teletype interface
* used to communicate with the process.
*
* To use this class, construct an instance and connect
* to the sendData slot and receivedData signal to
* send data to or receive data from the process.
*
* To start the terminal process, call the start() method
* with the program name and appropriate arguments.
*/
class Pty: public KPtyProcess
{
Q_OBJECT
public:
/**
* Constructs a new Pty.
*
* Connect to the sendData() slot and receivedData() signal to prepare
* for sending and receiving data from the terminal process.
*
* To start the terminal process, call the run() method with the
* name of the program to start and appropriate arguments.
*/
explicit Pty(QObject* parent = 0);
/**
* Construct a process using an open pty master.
* See KPtyProcess::KPtyProcess()
*/
explicit Pty(int ptyMasterFd, QObject* parent = 0);
~Pty();
/**
* Starts the terminal process.
*
* Returns 0 if the process was started successfully or non-zero
* otherwise.
*
* @param program Path to the program to start
* @param arguments Arguments to pass to the program being started
* @param environment A list of key=value pairs which will be added
* to the environment for the new process. At the very least this
* should include an assignment for the TERM environment variable.
* @param winid Specifies the value of the WINDOWID environment variable
* in the process's environment.
* @param addToUtmp Specifies whether a utmp entry should be created for
* the pty used. See K3Process::setUsePty()
* @param dbusService Specifies the value of the KONSOLE_DBUS_SERVICE
* environment variable in the process's environment.
* @param dbusSession Specifies the value of the KONSOLE_DBUS_SESSION
* environment variable in the process's environment.
*/
int start( const QString& program,
const QStringList& arguments,
const QStringList& environment,
ulong winid,
bool addToUtmp
);
/** TODO: Document me */
void setWriteable(bool writeable);
/**
* Enables or disables Xon/Xoff flow control. The flow control setting
* may be changed later by a terminal application, so flowControlEnabled()
* may not equal the value of @p on in the previous call to setFlowControlEnabled()
*/
void setFlowControlEnabled(bool on);
/** Queries the terminal state and returns true if Xon/Xoff flow control is enabled. */
bool flowControlEnabled() const;
/**
* Sets the size of the window (in lines and columns of characters)
* used by this teletype.
*/
void setWindowSize(int lines, int cols);
/** Returns the size of the window used by this teletype. See setWindowSize() */
QSize windowSize() const;
/** TODO Document me */
void setErase(char erase);
/** */
char erase() const;
/**
* Returns the process id of the teletype's current foreground
* process. This is the process which is currently reading
* input sent to the terminal via. sendData()
*
* If there is a problem reading the foreground process group,
* 0 will be returned.
*/
int foregroundProcessGroup() const;
public slots:
/**
* Put the pty into UTF-8 mode on systems which support it.
*/
void setUtf8Mode(bool on);
/**
* Suspend or resume processing of data from the standard
* output of the terminal process.
*
* See K3Process::suspend() and K3Process::resume()
*
* @param lock If true, processing of output is suspended,
* otherwise processing is resumed.
*/
void lockPty(bool lock);
/**
* Sends data to the process currently controlling the
* teletype ( whose id is returned by foregroundProcessGroup() )
*
* @param buffer Pointer to the data to send.
* @param length Length of @p buffer.
*/
void sendData(const char* buffer, int length);
signals:
/**
* Emitted when a new block of data is received from
* the teletype.
*
* @param buffer Pointer to the data received.
* @param length Length of @p buffer
*/
void receivedData(const char* buffer, int length);
protected:
void setupChildProcess();
private slots:
// called when data is received from the terminal process
void dataReceived();
private:
void init();
// takes a list of key=value pairs and adds them
// to the environment for the process
void addEnvironmentVariables(const QStringList& environment);
int _windowColumns;
int _windowLines;
char _eraseChar;
bool _xonXoff;
bool _utf8;
};
}
#endif // PTY_H

@ -0,0 +1,7 @@
lib.pro is a *.pro-file for qmake
It produces static lib (libqtermwidget.a) only.
For creating shared lib (*.so) uncomment "dll" in "CONFIG" line in *.pro-file
Library was tested both with HAVE_POSIX_OPENPT and HAVE_GETPT precompiler directives,
defined in "DEFINES" line. You should select variant which would be correct for your system.

File diff suppressed because it is too large Load Diff

@ -0,0 +1,675 @@
/*
This file is part of Konsole, KDE's terminal.
Copyright 2007-2008 by Robert Knight <robertknight@gmail.com>
Copyright 1997,1998 by Lars Doelle <lars.doelle@on-line.de>
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
(at your option) any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
02110-1301 USA.
*/
#ifndef SCREEN_H
#define SCREEN_H
// Qt
#include <QRect>
#include <QTextStream>
#include <QVarLengthArray>
// Konsole
#include "Character.h"
#include "History.h"
#define MODE_Origin 0
#define MODE_Wrap 1
#define MODE_Insert 2
#define MODE_Screen 3
#define MODE_Cursor 4
#define MODE_NewLine 5
#define MODES_SCREEN 6
namespace Konsole
{
class TerminalCharacterDecoder;
/**
\brief An image of characters with associated attributes.
The terminal emulation ( Emulation ) receives a serial stream of
characters from the program currently running in the terminal.
From this stream it creates an image of characters which is ultimately
rendered by the display widget ( TerminalDisplay ). Some types of emulation
may have more than one screen image.
getImage() is used to retrieve the currently visible image
which is then used by the display widget to draw the output from the
terminal.
The number of lines of output history which are kept in addition to the current
screen image depends on the history scroll being used to store the output.
The scroll is specified using setScroll()
The output history can be retrieved using writeToStream()
The screen image has a selection associated with it, specified using
setSelectionStart() and setSelectionEnd(). The selected text can be retrieved
using selectedText(). When getImage() is used to retrieve the visible image,
characters which are part of the selection have their colours inverted.
*/
class Screen
{
public:
/** Construct a new screen image of size @p lines by @p columns. */
Screen(int lines, int columns);
~Screen();
// VT100/2 Operations
// Cursor Movement
/**
* Move the cursor up by @p n lines. The cursor will stop at the
* top margin.
*/
void cursorUp(int n);
/**
* Move the cursor down by @p n lines. The cursor will stop at the
* bottom margin.
*/
void cursorDown(int n);
/**
* Move the cursor to the left by @p n columns.
* The cursor will stop at the first column.
*/
void cursorLeft(int n);
/**
* Move the cursor to the right by @p n columns.
* The cursor will stop at the right-most column.
*/
void cursorRight(int n);
/** Position the cursor on line @p y. */
void setCursorY(int y);
/** Position the cursor at column @p x. */
void setCursorX(int x);
/** Position the cursor at line @p y, column @p x. */
void setCursorYX(int y, int x);
/**
* Sets the margins for scrolling the screen.
*
* @param topLine The top line of the new scrolling margin.
* @param bottomLine The bottom line of the new scrolling margin.
*/
void setMargins(int topLine , int bottomLine);
/** Returns the top line of the scrolling region. */
int topMargin() const;
/** Returns the bottom line of the scrolling region. */
int bottomMargin() const;
/**
* Resets the scrolling margins back to the top and bottom lines
* of the screen.
*/
void setDefaultMargins();
/**
* Moves the cursor down one line, if the MODE_NewLine mode
* flag is enabled then the cursor is returned to the leftmost
* column first.
*
* Equivalent to NextLine() if the MODE_NewLine flag is set
* or index() otherwise.
*/
void newLine();
/**
* Moves the cursor down one line and positions it at the beginning
* of the line. Equivalent to calling Return() followed by index()
*/
void nextLine();
/**
* Move the cursor down one line. If the cursor is on the bottom
* line of the scrolling region (as returned by bottomMargin()) the
* scrolling region is scrolled up by one line instead.
*/
void index();
/**
* Move the cursor up one line. If the cursor is on the top line
* of the scrolling region (as returned by topMargin()) the scrolling
* region is scrolled down by one line instead.
*/
void reverseIndex();
/**
* Scroll the scrolling region of the screen up by @p n lines.
* The scrolling region is initially the whole screen, but can be changed
* using setMargins()
*/
void scrollUp(int n);
/**
* Scroll the scrolling region of the screen down by @p n lines.
* The scrolling region is initially the whole screen, but can be changed
* using setMargins()
*/
void scrollDown(int n);
/**
* Moves the cursor to the beginning of the current line.
* Equivalent to setCursorX(0)
*/
void toStartOfLine();
/**
* Moves the cursor one column to the left and erases the character
* at the new cursor position.
*/
void backspace();
/** Moves the cursor @p n tab-stops to the right. */
void tab(int n = 1);
/** Moves the cursor @p n tab-stops to the left. */
void backtab(int n);
// Editing
/**
* Erase @p n characters beginning from the current cursor position.
* This is equivalent to over-writing @p n characters starting with the current
* cursor position with spaces.
* If @p n is 0 then one character is erased.
*/
void eraseChars(int n);
/**
* Delete @p n characters beginning from the current cursor position.
* If @p n is 0 then one character is deleted.
*/
void deleteChars(int n);
/**
* Insert @p n blank characters beginning from the current cursor position.
* The position of the cursor is not altered.
* If @p n is 0 then one character is inserted.
*/
void insertChars(int n);
/**
* Removes @p n lines beginning from the current cursor position.
* The position of the cursor is not altered.
* If @p n is 0 then one line is removed.
*/
void deleteLines(int n);
/**
* Inserts @p lines beginning from the current cursor position.
* The position of the cursor is not altered.
* If @p n is 0 then one line is inserted.
*/
void insertLines(int n);
/** Clears all the tab stops. */
void clearTabStops();
/** Sets or removes a tab stop at the cursor's current column. */
void changeTabStop(bool set);
/** Resets (clears) the specified screen @p mode. */
void resetMode(int mode);
/** Sets (enables) the specified screen @p mode. */
void setMode(int mode);
/**
* Saves the state of the specified screen @p mode. It can be restored
* using restoreMode()
*/
void saveMode(int mode);
/** Restores the state of a screen @p mode saved by calling saveMode() */
void restoreMode(int mode);
/** Returns whether the specified screen @p mode is enabled or not .*/
bool getMode(int mode) const;
/**
* Saves the current position and appearance (text color and style) of the cursor.
* It can be restored by calling restoreCursor()
*/
void saveCursor();
/** Restores the position and appearance of the cursor. See saveCursor() */
void restoreCursor();
/** Clear the whole screen, moving the current screen contents into the history first. */
void clearEntireScreen();
/**
* Clear the area of the screen from the current cursor position to the end of
* the screen.
*/
void clearToEndOfScreen();
/**
* Clear the area of the screen from the current cursor position to the start
* of the screen.
*/
void clearToBeginOfScreen();
/** Clears the whole of the line on which the cursor is currently positioned. */
void clearEntireLine();
/** Clears from the current cursor position to the end of the line. */
void clearToEndOfLine();
/** Clears from the current cursor position to the beginning of the line. */
void clearToBeginOfLine();
/** Fills the entire screen with the letter 'E' */
void helpAlign();
/**
* Enables the given @p rendition flag. Rendition flags control the appearance
* of characters on the screen.
*
* @see Character::rendition
*/
void setRendition(int rendition);
/**
* Disables the given @p rendition flag. Rendition flags control the appearance
* of characters on the screen.
*
* @see Character::rendition
*/
void resetRendition(int rendition);
/**
* Sets the cursor's foreground color.
* @param space The color space used by the @p color argument
* @param color The new foreground color. The meaning of this depends on
* the color @p space used.
*
* @see CharacterColor
*/
void setForeColor(int space, int color);
/**
* Sets the cursor's background color.
* @param space The color space used by the @p color argumnet.
* @param color The new background color. The meaning of this depends on
* the color @p space used.
*
* @see CharacterColor
*/
void setBackColor(int space, int color);
/**
* Resets the cursor's color back to the default and sets the
* character's rendition flags back to the default settings.
*/
void setDefaultRendition();
/** Returns the column which the cursor is positioned at. */
int getCursorX() const;
/** Returns the line which the cursor is positioned on. */
int getCursorY() const;
/** Clear the entire screen and move the cursor to the home position.
* Equivalent to calling clearEntireScreen() followed by home().
*/
void clear();
/**
* Sets the position of the cursor to the 'home' position at the top-left
* corner of the screen (0,0)
*/
void home();
/**
* Resets the state of the screen. This resets the various screen modes
* back to their default states. The cursor style and colors are reset
* (as if setDefaultRendition() had been called)
*
* <ul>
* <li>Line wrapping is enabled.</li>
* <li>Origin mode is disabled.</li>
* <li>Insert mode is disabled.</li>
* <li>Cursor mode is enabled. TODO Document me</li>
* <li>Screen mode is disabled. TODO Document me</li>
* <li>New line mode is disabled. TODO Document me</li>
* </ul>
*
* If @p clearScreen is true then the screen contents are erased entirely,
* otherwise they are unaltered.
*/
void reset(bool clearScreen = true);
/**
* Displays a new character at the current cursor position.
*
* If the cursor is currently positioned at the right-edge of the screen and
* line wrapping is enabled then the character is added at the start of a new
* line below the current one.
*
* If the MODE_Insert screen mode is currently enabled then the character
* is inserted at the current cursor position, otherwise it will replace the
* character already at the current cursor position.
*/
void displayCharacter(unsigned short c);
// Do composition with last shown character FIXME: Not implemented yet for KDE 4
void compose(const QString& compose);
/**
* Resizes the image to a new fixed size of @p new_lines by @p new_columns.
* In the case that @p new_columns is smaller than the current number of columns,
* existing lines are not truncated. This prevents characters from being lost
* if the terminal display is resized smaller and then larger again.
*
* The top and bottom margins are reset to the top and bottom of the new
* screen size. Tab stops are also reset and the current selection is
* cleared.
*/
void resizeImage(int new_lines, int new_columns);
/**
* Returns the current screen image.
* The result is an array of Characters of size [getLines()][getColumns()] which
* must be freed by the caller after use.
*
* @param dest Buffer to copy the characters into
* @param size Size of @p dest in Characters
* @param startLine Index of first line to copy
* @param endLine Index of last line to copy
*/
void getImage( Character* dest , int size , int startLine , int endLine ) const;
/**
* Returns the additional attributes associated with lines in the image.
* The most important attribute is LINE_WRAPPED which specifies that the
* line is wrapped,
* other attributes control the size of characters in the line.
*/
QVector<LineProperty> getLineProperties( int startLine , int endLine ) const;
/** Return the number of lines. */
int getLines() const
{ return lines; }
/** Return the number of columns. */
int getColumns() const
{ return columns; }
/** Return the number of lines in the history buffer. */
int getHistLines() const;
/**
* Sets the type of storage used to keep lines in the history.
* If @p copyPreviousScroll is true then the contents of the previous
* history buffer are copied into the new scroll.
*/
void setScroll(const HistoryType& , bool copyPreviousScroll = true);
/** Returns the type of storage used to keep lines in the history. */
const HistoryType& getScroll() const;
/**
* Returns true if this screen keeps lines that are scrolled off the screen
* in a history buffer.
*/
bool hasScroll() const;
/**
* Sets the start of the selection.
*
* @param column The column index of the first character in the selection.
* @param line The line index of the first character in the selection.
* @param blockSelectionMode True if the selection is in column mode.
*/
void setSelectionStart(const int column, const int line, const bool blockSelectionMode);
/**
* Sets the end of the current selection.
*
* @param column The column index of the last character in the selection.
* @param line The line index of the last character in the selection.
*/
void setSelectionEnd(const int column, const int line);
/**
* Retrieves the start of the selection or the cursor position if there
* is no selection.
*/
void getSelectionStart(int& column , int& line) const;
/**
* Retrieves the end of the selection or the cursor position if there
* is no selection.
*/
void getSelectionEnd(int& column , int& line) const;
/** Clears the current selection */
void clearSelection();
/**
* Returns true if the character at (@p column, @p line) is part of the
* current selection.
*/
bool isSelected(const int column,const int line) const;
/**
* Convenience method. Returns the currently selected text.
* @param preserveLineBreaks Specifies whether new line characters should
* be inserted into the returned text at the end of each terminal line.
*/
QString selectedText(bool preserveLineBreaks) const;
/**
* Copies part of the output to a stream.
*
* @param decoder A decoder which converts terminal characters into text
* @param fromLine The first line in the history to retrieve
* @param toLine The last line in the history to retrieve
*/
void writeLinesToStream(TerminalCharacterDecoder* decoder, int fromLine, int toLine) const;
/**
* Copies the selected characters, set using @see setSelBeginXY and @see setSelExtentXY
* into a stream.
*
* @param decoder A decoder which converts terminal characters into text.
* PlainTextDecoder is the most commonly used decoder which converts characters
* into plain text with no formatting.
* @param preserveLineBreaks Specifies whether new line characters should
* be inserted into the returned text at the end of each terminal line.
*/
void writeSelectionToStream(TerminalCharacterDecoder* decoder , bool
preserveLineBreaks = true) const;
/**
* Checks if the text between from and to is inside the current
* selection. If this is the case, the selection is cleared. The
* from and to are coordinates in the current viewable window.
* The loc(x,y) macro can be used to generate these values from a
* column,line pair.
*
* @param from The start of the area to check.
* @param to The end of the area to check
*/
void checkSelection(int from, int to);
/**
* Sets or clears an attribute of the current line.
*
* @param property The attribute to set or clear
* Possible properties are:
* LINE_WRAPPED: Specifies that the line is wrapped.
* LINE_DOUBLEWIDTH: Specifies that the characters in the current line
* should be double the normal width.
* LINE_DOUBLEHEIGHT:Specifies that the characters in the current line
* should be double the normal height.
* Double-height lines are formed of two lines containing the same characters,
* with both having the LINE_DOUBLEHEIGHT attribute.
* This allows other parts of the code to work on the
* assumption that all lines are the same height.
*
* @param enable true to apply the attribute to the current line or false to remove it
*/
void setLineProperty(LineProperty property , bool enable);
/**
* Returns the number of lines that the image has been scrolled up or down by,
* since the last call to resetScrolledLines().
*
* a positive return value indicates that the image has been scrolled up,
* a negative return value indicates that the image has been scrolled down.
*/
int scrolledLines() const;
/**
* Returns the region of the image which was last scrolled.
*
* This is the area of the image from the top margin to the
* bottom margin when the last scroll occurred.
*/
QRect lastScrolledRegion() const;
/**
* Resets the count of the number of lines that the image has been scrolled up or down by,
* see scrolledLines()
*/
void resetScrolledLines();
/**
* Returns the number of lines of output which have been
* dropped from the history since the last call
* to resetDroppedLines()
*
* If the history is not unlimited then it will drop
* the oldest lines of output if new lines are added when
* it is full.
*/
int droppedLines() const;
/**
* Resets the count of the number of lines dropped from
* the history.
*/
void resetDroppedLines();
/**
* Fills the buffer @p dest with @p count instances of the default (ie. blank)
* Character style.
*/
static void fillWithDefaultChar(Character* dest, int count);
private:
//copies a line of text from the screen or history into a stream using a
//specified character decoder. Returns the number of lines actually copied,
//which may be less than 'count' if (start+count) is more than the number of characters on
//the line
//
//line - the line number to copy, from 0 (the earliest line in the history) up to
// history->getLines() + lines - 1
//start - the first column on the line to copy
//count - the number of characters on the line to copy
//decoder - a decoder which converts terminal characters (an Character array) into text
//appendNewLine - if true a new line character (\n) is appended to the end of the line
int copyLineToStream(int line,
int start,
int count,
TerminalCharacterDecoder* decoder,
bool appendNewLine,
bool preserveLineBreaks) const;
//fills a section of the screen image with the character 'c'
//the parameters are specified as offsets from the start of the screen image.
//the loc(x,y) macro can be used to generate these values from a column,line pair.
void clearImage(int loca, int loce, char c);
//move screen image between 'sourceBegin' and 'sourceEnd' to 'dest'.
//the parameters are specified as offsets from the start of the screen image.
//the loc(x,y) macro can be used to generate these values from a column,line pair.
//
//NOTE: moveImage() can only move whole lines
void moveImage(int dest, int sourceBegin, int sourceEnd);
// scroll up 'i' lines in current region, clearing the bottom 'i' lines
void scrollUp(int from, int i);
// scroll down 'i' lines in current region, clearing the top 'i' lines
void scrollDown(int from, int i);
void addHistLine();
void initTabStops();
void updateEffectiveRendition();
void reverseRendition(Character& p) const;
bool isSelectionValid() const;
// copies text from 'startIndex' to 'endIndex' to a stream
// startIndex and endIndex are positions generated using the loc(x,y) macro
void writeToStream(TerminalCharacterDecoder* decoder, int startIndex,
int endIndex, bool preserveLineBreaks = true) const;
// copies 'count' lines from the screen buffer into 'dest',
// starting from 'startLine', where 0 is the first line in the screen buffer
void copyFromScreen(Character* dest, int startLine, int count) const;
// copies 'count' lines from the history buffer into 'dest',
// starting from 'startLine', where 0 is the first line in the history
void copyFromHistory(Character* dest, int startLine, int count) const;
// screen image ----------------
int lines;
int columns;
typedef QVector<Character> ImageLine; // [0..columns]
ImageLine* screenLines; // [lines]
int _scrolledLines;
QRect _lastScrolledRegion;
int _droppedLines;
QVarLengthArray<LineProperty,64> lineProperties;
// history buffer ---------------
HistoryScroll* history;
// cursor location
int cuX;
int cuY;
// cursor color and rendition info
CharacterColor currentForeground;
CharacterColor currentBackground;
quint8 currentRendition;
// margins ----------------
int _topMargin;
int _bottomMargin;
// states ----------------
int currentModes[MODES_SCREEN];
int savedModes[MODES_SCREEN];
// ----------------------------
QBitArray tabStops;
// selection -------------------
int selBegin; // The first location selected.
int selTopLeft; // TopLeft Location.
int selBottomRight; // Bottom Right Location.
bool blockSelectionMode; // Column selection mode
// effective colors and rendition ------------
CharacterColor effectiveForeground; // These are derived from
CharacterColor effectiveBackground; // the cu_* variables above
quint8 effectiveRendition; // to speed up operation
class SavedState
{
public:
SavedState()
: cursorColumn(0),cursorLine(0),rendition(0) {}
int cursorColumn;
int cursorLine;
quint8 rendition;
CharacterColor foreground;
CharacterColor background;
};
SavedState savedState;
// last position where we added a character
int lastPos;
static Character defaultChar;
};
}
#endif // SCREEN_H

@ -0,0 +1,294 @@
/*
Copyright (C) 2007 by Robert Knight <robertknight@gmail.com>
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
(at your option) any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
02110-1301 USA.
*/
// Own
#include "ScreenWindow.h"
// Qt
#include <QtDebug>
// Konsole
#include "Screen.h"
using namespace Konsole;
ScreenWindow::ScreenWindow(QObject* parent)
: QObject(parent)
, _windowBuffer(0)
, _windowBufferSize(0)
, _bufferNeedsUpdate(true)
, _windowLines(1)
, _currentLine(0)
, _trackOutput(true)
, _scrollCount(0)
{
}
ScreenWindow::~ScreenWindow()
{
delete[] _windowBuffer;
}
void ScreenWindow::setScreen(Screen* screen)
{
Q_ASSERT( screen );
_screen = screen;
}
Screen* ScreenWindow::screen() const
{
return _screen;
}
Character* ScreenWindow::getImage()
{
// reallocate internal buffer if the window size has changed
int size = windowLines() * windowColumns();
if (_windowBuffer == 0 || _windowBufferSize != size)
{
delete[] _windowBuffer;
_windowBufferSize = size;
_windowBuffer = new Character[size];
_bufferNeedsUpdate = true;
}
if (!_bufferNeedsUpdate)
return _windowBuffer;
_screen->getImage(_windowBuffer,size,
currentLine(),endWindowLine());
// this window may look beyond the end of the screen, in which
// case there will be an unused area which needs to be filled
// with blank characters
fillUnusedArea();
_bufferNeedsUpdate = false;
return _windowBuffer;
}
void ScreenWindow::fillUnusedArea()
{
int screenEndLine = _screen->getHistLines() + _screen->getLines() - 1;
int windowEndLine = currentLine() + windowLines() - 1;
int unusedLines = windowEndLine - screenEndLine;
int charsToFill = unusedLines * windowColumns();
Screen::fillWithDefaultChar(_windowBuffer + _windowBufferSize - charsToFill,charsToFill);
}
// return the index of the line at the end of this window, or if this window
// goes beyond the end of the screen, the index of the line at the end
// of the screen.
//
// when passing a line number to a Screen method, the line number should
// never be more than endWindowLine()
//
int ScreenWindow::endWindowLine() const
{
return qMin(currentLine() + windowLines() - 1,
lineCount() - 1);
}
QVector<LineProperty> ScreenWindow::getLineProperties()
{
QVector<LineProperty> result = _screen->getLineProperties(currentLine(),endWindowLine());
if (result.count() != windowLines())
result.resize(windowLines());
return result;
}
QString ScreenWindow::selectedText( bool preserveLineBreaks ) const
{
return _screen->selectedText( preserveLineBreaks );
}
void ScreenWindow::getSelectionStart( int& column , int& line )
{
_screen->getSelectionStart(column,line);
line -= currentLine();
}
void ScreenWindow::getSelectionEnd( int& column , int& line )
{
_screen->getSelectionEnd(column,line);
line -= currentLine();
}
void ScreenWindow::setSelectionStart( int column , int line , bool columnMode )
{
_screen->setSelectionStart( column , qMin(line + currentLine(),endWindowLine()) , columnMode);
_bufferNeedsUpdate = true;
emit selectionChanged();
}
void ScreenWindow::setSelectionEnd( int column , int line )
{
_screen->setSelectionEnd( column , qMin(line + currentLine(),endWindowLine()) );
_bufferNeedsUpdate = true;
emit selectionChanged();
}
bool ScreenWindow::isSelected( int column , int line )
{
return _screen->isSelected( column , qMin(line + currentLine(),endWindowLine()) );
}
void ScreenWindow::clearSelection()
{
_screen->clearSelection();
emit selectionChanged();
}
void ScreenWindow::setWindowLines(int lines)
{
Q_ASSERT(lines > 0);
_windowLines = lines;
}
int ScreenWindow::windowLines() const
{
return _windowLines;
}
int ScreenWindow::windowColumns() const
{
return _screen->getColumns();
}
int ScreenWindow::lineCount() const
{
return _screen->getHistLines() + _screen->getLines();
}
int ScreenWindow::columnCount() const
{
return _screen->getColumns();
}
QPoint ScreenWindow::cursorPosition() const
{
QPoint position;
position.setX( _screen->getCursorX() );
position.setY( _screen->getCursorY() );
return position;
}
int ScreenWindow::currentLine() const
{
return qBound(0,_currentLine,lineCount()-windowLines());
}
void ScreenWindow::scrollBy( RelativeScrollMode mode , int amount )
{
if ( mode == ScrollLines )
{
scrollTo( currentLine() + amount );
}
else if ( mode == ScrollPages )
{
scrollTo( currentLine() + amount * ( windowLines() / 2 ) );
}
}
bool ScreenWindow::atEndOfOutput() const
{
return currentLine() == (lineCount()-windowLines());
}
void ScreenWindow::scrollTo( int line )
{
int maxCurrentLineNumber = lineCount() - windowLines();
line = qBound(0,line,maxCurrentLineNumber);
const int delta = line - _currentLine;
_currentLine = line;
// keep track of number of lines scrolled by,
// this can be reset by calling resetScrollCount()
_scrollCount += delta;
_bufferNeedsUpdate = true;
emit scrolled(_currentLine);
}
void ScreenWindow::setTrackOutput(bool trackOutput)
{
_trackOutput = trackOutput;
}
bool ScreenWindow::trackOutput() const
{
return _trackOutput;
}
int ScreenWindow::scrollCount() const
{
return _scrollCount;
}
void ScreenWindow::resetScrollCount()
{
_scrollCount = 0;
}
QRect ScreenWindow::scrollRegion() const
{
bool equalToScreenSize = windowLines() == _screen->getLines();
if ( atEndOfOutput() && equalToScreenSize )
return _screen->lastScrolledRegion();
else
return QRect(0,0,windowColumns(),windowLines());
}
void ScreenWindow::notifyOutputChanged()
{
// move window to the bottom of the screen and update scroll count
// if this window is currently tracking the bottom of the screen
if ( _trackOutput )
{
_scrollCount -= _screen->scrolledLines();
_currentLine = qMax(0,_screen->getHistLines() - (windowLines()-_screen->getLines()));
}
else
{
// if the history is not unlimited then it may
// have run out of space and dropped the oldest
// lines of output - in this case the screen
// window's current line number will need to
// be adjusted - otherwise the output will scroll
_currentLine = qMax(0,_currentLine -
_screen->droppedLines());
// ensure that the screen window's current position does
// not go beyond the bottom of the screen
_currentLine = qMin( _currentLine , _screen->getHistLines() );
}
_bufferNeedsUpdate = true;
emit outputChanged();
}
//#include "ScreenWindow.moc"

@ -0,0 +1,259 @@
/*
Copyright 2007-2008 by Robert Knight <robertknight@gmail.com>
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
(at your option) any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
02110-1301 USA.
*/
#ifndef SCREENWINDOW_H
#define SCREENWINDOW_H
// Qt
#include <QObject>
#include <QPoint>
#include <QRect>
// Konsole
#include "Character.h"
namespace Konsole
{
class Screen;
/**
* Provides a window onto a section of a terminal screen. A terminal widget can then render
* the contents of the window and use the window to change the terminal screen's selection
* in response to mouse or keyboard input.
*
* A new ScreenWindow for a terminal session can be created by calling Emulation::createWindow()
*
* Use the scrollTo() method to scroll the window up and down on the screen.
* Use the getImage() method to retrieve the character image which is currently visible in the window.
*
* setTrackOutput() controls whether the window moves to the bottom of the associated screen when new
* lines are added to it.
*
* Whenever the output from the underlying screen is changed, the notifyOutputChanged() slot should
* be called. This in turn will update the window's position and emit the outputChanged() signal
* if necessary.
*/
class ScreenWindow : public QObject
{
Q_OBJECT
public:
/**
* Constructs a new screen window with the given parent.
* A screen must be specified by calling setScreen() before calling getImage() or getLineProperties().
*
* You should not call this constructor directly, instead use the Emulation::createWindow() method
* to create a window on the emulation which you wish to view. This allows the emulation
* to notify the window when the associated screen has changed and synchronize selection updates
* between all views on a session.
*/
ScreenWindow(QObject* parent = 0);
virtual ~ScreenWindow();
/** Sets the screen which this window looks onto */
void setScreen(Screen* screen);
/** Returns the screen which this window looks onto */
Screen* screen() const;
/**
* Returns the image of characters which are currently visible through this window
* onto the screen.
*
* The returned buffer is managed by the ScreenWindow instance and does not need to be
* deleted by the caller.
*/
Character* getImage();
/**
* Returns the line attributes associated with the lines of characters which
* are currently visible through this window
*/
QVector<LineProperty> getLineProperties();
/**
* Returns the number of lines which the region of the window
* specified by scrollRegion() has been scrolled by since the last call
* to resetScrollCount(). scrollRegion() is in most cases the
* whole window, but will be a smaller area in, for example, applications
* which provide split-screen facilities.
*
* This is not guaranteed to be accurate, but allows views to optimize
* rendering by reducing the amount of costly text rendering that
* needs to be done when the output is scrolled.
*/
int scrollCount() const;
/**
* Resets the count of scrolled lines returned by scrollCount()
*/
void resetScrollCount();
/**
* Returns the area of the window which was last scrolled, this is
* usually the whole window area.
*
* Like scrollCount(), this is not guaranteed to be accurate,
* but allows views to optimize rendering.
*/
QRect scrollRegion() const;
/**
* Sets the start of the selection to the given @p line and @p column within
* the window.
*/
void setSelectionStart( int column , int line , bool columnMode );
/**
* Sets the end of the selection to the given @p line and @p column within
* the window.
*/
void setSelectionEnd( int column , int line );
/**
* Retrieves the start of the selection within the window.
*/
void getSelectionStart( int& column , int& line );
/**
* Retrieves the end of the selection within the window.
*/
void getSelectionEnd( int& column , int& line );
/**
* Returns true if the character at @p line , @p column is part of the selection.
*/
bool isSelected( int column , int line );
/**
* Clears the current selection
*/
void clearSelection();
/** Sets the number of lines in the window */
void setWindowLines(int lines);
/** Returns the number of lines in the window */
int windowLines() const;
/** Returns the number of columns in the window */
int windowColumns() const;
/** Returns the total number of lines in the screen */
int lineCount() const;
/** Returns the total number of columns in the screen */
int columnCount() const;
/** Returns the index of the line which is currently at the top of this window */
int currentLine() const;
/**
* Returns the position of the cursor
* within the window.
*/
QPoint cursorPosition() const;
/**
* Convenience method. Returns true if the window is currently at the bottom
* of the screen.
*/
bool atEndOfOutput() const;
/** Scrolls the window so that @p line is at the top of the window */
void scrollTo( int line );
/** Describes the units which scrollBy() moves the window by. */
enum RelativeScrollMode
{
/** Scroll the window down by a given number of lines. */
ScrollLines,
/**
* Scroll the window down by a given number of pages, where
* one page is windowLines() lines
*/
ScrollPages
};
/**
* Scrolls the window relative to its current position on the screen.
*
* @param mode Specifies whether @p amount refers to the number of lines or the number
* of pages to scroll.
* @param amount The number of lines or pages ( depending on @p mode ) to scroll by. If
* this number is positive, the view is scrolled down. If this number is negative, the view
* is scrolled up.
*/
void scrollBy( RelativeScrollMode mode , int amount );
/**
* Specifies whether the window should automatically move to the bottom
* of the screen when new output is added.
*
* If this is set to true, the window will be moved to the bottom of the associated screen ( see
* screen() ) when the notifyOutputChanged() method is called.
*/
void setTrackOutput(bool trackOutput);
/**
* Returns whether the window automatically moves to the bottom of the screen as
* new output is added. See setTrackOutput()
*/
bool trackOutput() const;
/**
* Returns the text which is currently selected.
*
* @param preserveLineBreaks See Screen::selectedText()
*/
QString selectedText( bool preserveLineBreaks ) const;
public slots:
/**
* Notifies the window that the contents of the associated terminal screen have changed.
* This moves the window to the bottom of the screen if trackOutput() is true and causes
* the outputChanged() signal to be emitted.
*/
void notifyOutputChanged();
signals:
/**
* Emitted when the contents of the associated terminal screen (see screen()) changes.
*/
void outputChanged();
/**
* Emitted when the screen window is scrolled to a different position.
*
* @param line The line which is now at the top of the window.
*/
void scrolled(int line);
/** Emitted when the selection is changed. */
void selectionChanged();
private:
int endWindowLine() const;
void fillUnusedArea();
Screen* _screen; // see setScreen() , screen()
Character* _windowBuffer;
int _windowBufferSize;
bool _bufferNeedsUpdate;
int _windowLines;
int _currentLine; // see scrollTo() , currentLine()
bool _trackOutput; // see setTrackOutput() , trackOutput()
int _scrollCount; // count of lines which the window has been scrolled by since
// the last call to resetScrollCount()
};
}
#endif // SCREENWINDOW_H

@ -0,0 +1,118 @@
/*
Copyright 2013 Christian Surlykke
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
(at your option) any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
02110-1301 USA.
*/
#include <QMenu>
#include <QAction>
#include <QRegExp>
#include <QDebug>
#include "SearchBar.h"
SearchBar::SearchBar(QWidget *parent) : QWidget(parent)
{
widget.setupUi(this);
connect(widget.closeButton, SIGNAL(clicked()), this, SLOT(hide()));
connect(widget.searchTextEdit, SIGNAL(textChanged(QString)), this, SIGNAL(searchCriteriaChanged()));
connect(widget.findPreviousButton, SIGNAL(clicked()), this, SIGNAL(findPrevious()));
connect(widget.findNextButton, SIGNAL(clicked()), this, SIGNAL(findNext()));
connect(this, SIGNAL(searchCriteriaChanged()), this, SLOT(clearBackgroundColor()));
QMenu *optionsMenu = new QMenu(widget.optionsButton);
widget.optionsButton->setMenu(optionsMenu);
m_matchCaseMenuEntry = optionsMenu->addAction(tr("Match case"));
m_matchCaseMenuEntry->setCheckable(true);
m_matchCaseMenuEntry->setChecked(true);
connect(m_matchCaseMenuEntry, SIGNAL(toggled(bool)), this, SIGNAL(searchCriteriaChanged()));
m_useRegularExpressionMenuEntry = optionsMenu->addAction(tr("Regular expression"));
m_useRegularExpressionMenuEntry->setCheckable(true);
connect(m_useRegularExpressionMenuEntry, SIGNAL(toggled(bool)), this, SIGNAL(searchCriteriaChanged()));
m_highlightMatchesMenuEntry = optionsMenu->addAction(tr("Higlight all matches"));
m_highlightMatchesMenuEntry->setCheckable(true);
m_highlightMatchesMenuEntry->setChecked(true);
connect(m_highlightMatchesMenuEntry, SIGNAL(toggled(bool)), this, SIGNAL(highlightMatchesChanged(bool)));
}
SearchBar::~SearchBar() {
}
QString SearchBar::searchText()
{
return widget.searchTextEdit->text();
}
bool SearchBar::useRegularExpression()
{
return m_useRegularExpressionMenuEntry->isChecked();
}
bool SearchBar::matchCase()
{
return m_matchCaseMenuEntry->isChecked();
}
bool SearchBar::highlightAllMatches()
{
return m_highlightMatchesMenuEntry->isChecked();
}
void SearchBar::show()
{
QWidget::show();
widget.searchTextEdit->setFocus();
}
void SearchBar::noMatchFound()
{
QPalette palette;
palette.setColor(widget.searchTextEdit->backgroundRole(), QColor(255, 128, 128));
widget.searchTextEdit->setPalette(palette);
}
void SearchBar::keyReleaseEvent(QKeyEvent* keyEvent)
{
if (keyEvent->key() == Qt::Key_Return || keyEvent->key() == Qt::Key_Enter)
{
if (keyEvent->modifiers() == Qt::ShiftModifier)
{
findPrevious();
}
else
{
findNext();
}
}
else if (keyEvent->key() == Qt::Key_Escape)
{
hide();
}
}
void SearchBar::clearBackgroundColor()
{
QPalette p;
p.setColor(QPalette::Base, Qt::white);
widget.searchTextEdit->setPalette(p);
}

@ -0,0 +1,60 @@
/*
Copyright 2013 Christian Surlykke
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
(at your option) any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
02110-1301 USA.
*/
#ifndef _SEARCHBAR_H
#define _SEARCHBAR_H
#include <QRegExp>
#include "ui_SearchBar.h"
#include "HistorySearch.h"
class SearchBar : public QWidget {
Q_OBJECT
public:
SearchBar(QWidget* parent = 0);
virtual ~SearchBar();
virtual void show();
QString searchText();
bool useRegularExpression();
bool matchCase();
bool highlightAllMatches();
public slots:
void noMatchFound();
signals:
void searchCriteriaChanged();
void highlightMatchesChanged(bool highlightMatches);
void findNext();
void findPrevious();
protected:
virtual void keyReleaseEvent(QKeyEvent* keyEvent);
private slots:
void clearBackgroundColor();
private:
Ui::SearchBar widget;
QAction *m_matchCaseMenuEntry;
QAction *m_useRegularExpressionMenuEntry;
QAction *m_highlightMatchesMenuEntry;
};
#endif /* _SEARCHBAR_H */

@ -0,0 +1,85 @@
<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8"?>
<ui version="4.0">
<class>SearchBar</class>
<widget class="QWidget" name="SearchBar">
<property name="geometry">
<rect>
<x>0</x>
<y>0</y>
<width>399</width>
<height>40</height>
</rect>
</property>
<property name="windowTitle">
<string>SearchBar</string>
</property>
<layout class="QHBoxLayout" name="horizontalLayout">
<item>
<widget class="QToolButton" name="closeButton">
<property name="text">
<string>X</string>
</property>
<property name="icon">
<iconset theme="dialog-close">
<normaloff/>
</iconset>
</property>
</widget>
</item>
<item>
<widget class="QLabel" name="findLabel">
<property name="text">
<string>Find:</string>
</property>
</widget>
</item>
<item>
<widget class="QLineEdit" name="searchTextEdit"/>
</item>
<item>
<widget class="QToolButton" name="findPreviousButton">
<property name="text">
<string>&lt;</string>
</property>
<property name="icon">
<iconset theme="go-previous">
<normaloff/>
</iconset>
</property>
</widget>
</item>
<item>
<widget class="QToolButton" name="findNextButton">
<property name="text">
<string>&gt;</string>
</property>
<property name="icon">
<iconset theme="go-next">
<normaloff/>
</iconset>
</property>
</widget>
</item>
<item>
<widget class="QToolButton" name="optionsButton">
<property name="text">
<string>...</string>
</property>
<property name="icon">
<iconset>
<normaloff/>
</iconset>
</property>
<property name="popupMode">
<enum>QToolButton::InstantPopup</enum>
</property>
<property name="arrowType">
<enum>Qt::DownArrow</enum>
</property>
</widget>
</item>
</layout>
</widget>
<resources/>
<connections/>
</ui>

File diff suppressed because it is too large Load Diff

@ -0,0 +1,622 @@
/*
This file is part of Konsole, an X terminal.
Copyright (C) 2007 by Robert Knight <robertknight@gmail.com>
Copyright (C) 1997,1998 by Lars Doelle <lars.doelle@on-line.de>
Rewritten for QT4 by e_k <e_k at users.sourceforge.net>, Copyright (C)2008
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
(at your option) any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
02110-1301 USA.
*/
#ifndef SESSION_H
#define SESSION_H
#include <QStringList>
#include <QWidget>
#include "History.h"
class KProcess;
namespace Konsole {
class Emulation;
class Pty;
class TerminalDisplay;
//class ZModemDialog;
/**
* Represents a terminal session consisting of a pseudo-teletype and a terminal emulation.
* The pseudo-teletype (or PTY) handles I/O between the terminal process and Konsole.
* The terminal emulation ( Emulation and subclasses ) processes the output stream from the
* PTY and produces a character image which is then shown on views connected to the session.
*
* Each Session can be connected to one or more views by using the addView() method.
* The attached views can then display output from the program running in the terminal
* or send input to the program in the terminal in the form of keypresses and mouse
* activity.
*/
class Session : public QObject {
Q_OBJECT
public:
Q_PROPERTY(QString name READ nameTitle)
Q_PROPERTY(int processId READ processId)
Q_PROPERTY(QString keyBindings READ keyBindings WRITE setKeyBindings)
Q_PROPERTY(QSize size READ size WRITE setSize)
/**
* Constructs a new session.
*
* To start the terminal process, call the run() method,
* after specifying the program and arguments
* using setProgram() and setArguments()
*
* If no program or arguments are specified explicitly, the Session
* falls back to using the program specified in the SHELL environment
* variable.
*/
Session(QObject* parent = 0);
virtual ~Session();
/**
* Returns true if the session is currently running. This will be true
* after run() has been called successfully.
*/
bool isRunning() const;
/**
* Sets the profile associated with this session.
*
* @param profileKey A key which can be used to obtain the current
* profile settings from the SessionManager
*/
void setProfileKey(const QString & profileKey);
/**
* Returns the profile key associated with this session.
* This can be passed to the SessionManager to obtain the current
* profile settings.
*/
QString profileKey() const;
/**
* Adds a new view for this session.
*
* The viewing widget will display the output from the terminal and
* input from the viewing widget (key presses, mouse activity etc.)
* will be sent to the terminal.
*
* Views can be removed using removeView(). The session is automatically
* closed when the last view is removed.
*/
void addView(TerminalDisplay * widget);
/**
* Removes a view from this session. When the last view is removed,
* the session will be closed automatically.
*
* @p widget will no longer display output from or send input
* to the terminal
*/
void removeView(TerminalDisplay * widget);
/**
* Returns the views connected to this session
*/
QList<TerminalDisplay *> views() const;
/**
* Returns the terminal emulation instance being used to encode / decode
* characters to / from the process.
*/
Emulation * emulation() const;
/**
* Returns the environment of this session as a list of strings like
* VARIABLE=VALUE
*/
QStringList environment() const;
/**
* Sets the environment for this session.
* @p environment should be a list of strings like
* VARIABLE=VALUE
*/
void setEnvironment(const QStringList & environment);
/** Returns the unique ID for this session. */
int sessionId() const;
/**
* Return the session title set by the user (ie. the program running
* in the terminal), or an empty string if the user has not set a custom title
*/
QString userTitle() const;
/**
* This enum describes the contexts for which separate
* tab title formats may be specified.
*/
enum TabTitleContext {
/** Default tab title format */
LocalTabTitle,
/**
* Tab title format used session currently contains
* a connection to a remote computer (via SSH)
*/
RemoteTabTitle
};
/**
* Sets the format used by this session for tab titles.
*
* @param context The context whoose format should be set.
* @param format The tab title format. This may be a mixture
* of plain text and dynamic elements denoted by a '%' character
* followed by a letter. (eg. %d for directory). The dynamic
* elements available depend on the @p context
*/
void setTabTitleFormat(TabTitleContext context , const QString & format);
/** Returns the format used by this session for tab titles. */
QString tabTitleFormat(TabTitleContext context) const;
/** Returns the arguments passed to the shell process when run() is called. */
QStringList arguments() const;
/** Returns the program name of the shell process started when run() is called. */
QString program() const;
/**
* Sets the command line arguments which the session's program will be passed when
* run() is called.
*/
void setArguments(const QStringList & arguments);
/** Sets the program to be executed when run() is called. */
void setProgram(const QString & program);
/** Returns the session's current working directory. */
QString initialWorkingDirectory() {
return _initialWorkingDir;
}
/**
* Sets the initial working directory for the session when it is run
* This has no effect once the session has been started.
*/
void setInitialWorkingDirectory( const QString & dir );
/**
* Sets the type of history store used by this session.
* Lines of output produced by the terminal are added
* to the history store. The type of history store
* used affects the number of lines which can be
* remembered before they are lost and the storage
* (in memory, on-disk etc.) used.
*/
void setHistoryType(const HistoryType & type);
/**
* Returns the type of history store used by this session.
*/
const HistoryType & historyType() const;
/**
* Clears the history store used by this session.
*/
void clearHistory();
/**
* Enables monitoring for activity in the session.
* This will cause notifySessionState() to be emitted
* with the NOTIFYACTIVITY state flag when output is
* received from the terminal.
*/
void setMonitorActivity(bool);
/** Returns true if monitoring for activity is enabled. */
bool isMonitorActivity() const;
/**
* Enables monitoring for silence in the session.
* This will cause notifySessionState() to be emitted
* with the NOTIFYSILENCE state flag when output is not
* received from the terminal for a certain period of
* time, specified with setMonitorSilenceSeconds()
*/
void setMonitorSilence(bool);
/**
* Returns true if monitoring for inactivity (silence)
* in the session is enabled.
*/
bool isMonitorSilence() const;
/** See setMonitorSilence() */
void setMonitorSilenceSeconds(int seconds);
/**
* Sets the key bindings used by this session. The bindings
* specify how input key sequences are translated into
* the character stream which is sent to the terminal.
*
* @param id The name of the key bindings to use. The
* names of available key bindings can be determined using the
* KeyboardTranslatorManager class.
*/
void setKeyBindings(const QString & id);
/** Returns the name of the key bindings used by this session. */
QString keyBindings() const;
/**
* This enum describes the available title roles.
*/
enum TitleRole {
/** The name of the session. */
NameRole,
/** The title of the session which is displayed in tabs etc. */
DisplayedTitleRole
};
/** Sets the session's title for the specified @p role to @p title. */
void setTitle(TitleRole role , const QString & title);
/** Returns the session's title for the specified @p role. */
QString title(TitleRole role) const;
/** Convenience method used to read the name property. Returns title(Session::NameRole). */
QString nameTitle() const {
return title(Session::NameRole);
}
/** Sets the name of the icon associated with this session. */
void setIconName(const QString & iconName);
/** Returns the name of the icon associated with this session. */
QString iconName() const;
/** Sets the text of the icon associated with this session. */
void setIconText(const QString & iconText);
/** Returns the text of the icon associated with this session. */
QString iconText() const;
/** Specifies whether a utmp entry should be created for the pty used by this session. */
void setAddToUtmp(bool);
/** Sends the specified @p signal to the terminal process. */
bool sendSignal(int signal);
/**
* Specifies whether to close the session automatically when the terminal
* process terminates.
*/
void setAutoClose(bool b) {
_autoClose = b;
}
/**
* Sets whether flow control is enabled for this terminal
* session.
*/
void setFlowControlEnabled(bool enabled);
/** Returns whether flow control is enabled for this terminal session. */
bool flowControlEnabled() const;
/**
* Sends @p text to the current foreground terminal program.
*/
void sendText(const QString & text) const;
/**
* Returns the process id of the terminal process.
* This is the id used by the system API to refer to the process.
*/
int processId() const;
/**
* Returns the process id of the terminal's foreground process.
* This is initially the same as processId() but can change
* as the user starts other programs inside the terminal.
*/
int foregroundProcessId() const;
/** Returns the terminal session's window size in lines and columns. */
QSize size();
/**
* Emits a request to resize the session to accommodate
* the specified window size.
*
* @param size The size in lines and columns to request.
*/
void setSize(const QSize & size);
/** Sets the text codec used by this session's terminal emulation. */
void setCodec(QTextCodec * codec);
/**
* Sets whether the session has a dark background or not. The session
* uses this information to set the COLORFGBG variable in the process's
* environment, which allows the programs running in the terminal to determine
* whether the background is light or dark and use appropriate colors by default.
*
* This has no effect once the session is running.
*/
void setDarkBackground(bool darkBackground);
/**
* Returns true if the session has a dark background.
* See setDarkBackground()
*/
bool hasDarkBackground() const;
/**
* Attempts to get the shell program to redraw the current display area.
* This can be used after clearing the screen, for example, to get the
* shell to redraw the prompt line.
*/
void refresh();
// void startZModem(const QString &rz, const QString &dir, const QStringList &list);
// void cancelZModem();
// bool isZModemBusy() { return _zmodemBusy; }
public slots:
/**
* Starts the terminal session.
*
* This creates the terminal process and connects the teletype to it.
*/
void run();
/**
* Closes the terminal session. This sends a hangup signal
* (SIGHUP) to the terminal process and causes the done(Session*)
* signal to be emitted.
*/
void close();
/**
* Changes the session title or other customizable aspects of the terminal
* emulation display. For a list of what may be changed see the
* Emulation::titleChanged() signal.
*/
void setUserTitle( int, const QString & caption );
signals:
/** Emitted when the terminal process starts. */
void started();
/**
* Emitted when the terminal process exits.
*/
void finished();
/**
* Emitted when output is received from the terminal process.
*/
void receivedData( const QString & text );
/** Emitted when the session's title has changed. */
void titleChanged();
/** Emitted when the session's profile has changed. */
void profileChanged(const QString & profile);
/**
* Emitted when the activity state of this session changes.
*
* @param state The new state of the session. This may be one
* of NOTIFYNORMAL, NOTIFYSILENCE or NOTIFYACTIVITY
*/
void stateChanged(int state);
/** Emitted when a bell event occurs in the session. */
void bellRequest( const QString & message );
/**
* Requests that the color the text for any tabs associated with
* this session should be changed;
*
* TODO: Document what the parameter does
*/
void changeTabTextColorRequest(int);
/**
* Requests that the background color of views on this session
* should be changed.
*/
void changeBackgroundColorRequest(const QColor &);
/** TODO: Document me. */
void openUrlRequest(const QString & url);
/** TODO: Document me. */
// void zmodemDetected();
/**
* Emitted when the terminal process requests a change
* in the size of the terminal window.
*
* @param size The requested window size in terms of lines and columns.
*/
void resizeRequest(const QSize & size);
/**
* Emitted when a profile change command is received from the terminal.
*
* @param text The text of the command. This is a string of the form
* "PropertyName=Value;PropertyName=Value ..."
*/
void profileChangeCommandReceived(const QString & text);
/**
* Emitted when the flow control state changes.
*
* @param enabled True if flow control is enabled or false otherwise.
*/
void flowControlEnabledChanged(bool enabled);
void silence();
void activity();
private slots:
void done(int);
// void fireZModemDetected();
void onReceiveBlock( const char * buffer, int len );
void monitorTimerDone();
void onViewSizeChange(int height, int width);
void onEmulationSizeChange(int lines , int columns);
void activityStateSet(int);
//automatically detach views from sessions when view is destroyed
void viewDestroyed(QObject * view);
// void zmodemReadStatus();
// void zmodemReadAndSendBlock();
// void zmodemRcvBlock(const char *data, int len);
// void zmodemFinished();
private:
void updateTerminalSize();
WId windowId() const;
int _uniqueIdentifier;
Pty *_shellProcess;
Emulation * _emulation;
QList<TerminalDisplay *> _views;
bool _monitorActivity;
bool _monitorSilence;
bool _notifiedActivity;
bool _masterMode;
bool _autoClose;
bool _wantedClose;
QTimer * _monitorTimer;
int _silenceSeconds;
QString _nameTitle;
QString _displayTitle;
QString _userTitle;
QString _localTabTitleFormat;
QString _remoteTabTitleFormat;
QString _iconName;
QString _iconText; // as set by: echo -en '\033]1;IconText\007
bool _addToUtmp;
bool _flowControl;
bool _fullScripting;
QString _program;
QStringList _arguments;
QStringList _environment;
int _sessionId;
QString _initialWorkingDir;
// ZModem
// bool _zmodemBusy;
// KProcess* _zmodemProc;
// ZModemDialog* _zmodemProgress;
// Color/Font Changes by ESC Sequences
QColor _modifiedBackground; // as set by: echo -en '\033]11;Color\007
QString _profileKey;
bool _hasDarkBackground;
static int lastSessionId;
};
/**
* Provides a group of sessions which is divided into master and slave sessions.
* Activity in master sessions can be propagated to all sessions within the group.
* The type of activity which is propagated and method of propagation is controlled
* by the masterMode() flags.
*/
class SessionGroup : public QObject {
Q_OBJECT
public:
/** Constructs an empty session group. */
SessionGroup();
/** Destroys the session group and removes all connections between master and slave sessions. */
~SessionGroup();
/** Adds a session to the group. */
void addSession( Session * session );
/** Removes a session from the group. */
void removeSession( Session * session );
/** Returns the list of sessions currently in the group. */
QList<Session *> sessions() const;
/**
* Sets whether a particular session is a master within the group.
* Changes or activity in the group's master sessions may be propagated
* to all the sessions in the group, depending on the current masterMode()
*
* @param session The session whoose master status should be changed.
* @param master True to make this session a master or false otherwise
*/
void setMasterStatus( Session * session , bool master );
/** Returns the master status of a session. See setMasterStatus() */
bool masterStatus( Session * session ) const;
/**
* This enum describes the options for propagating certain activity or
* changes in the group's master sessions to all sessions in the group.
*/
enum MasterMode {
/**
* Any input key presses in the master sessions are sent to all
* sessions in the group.
*/
CopyInputToAll = 1
};
/**
* Specifies which activity in the group's master sessions is propagated
* to all sessions in the group.
*
* @param mode A bitwise OR of MasterMode flags.
*/
void setMasterMode( int mode );
/**
* Returns a bitwise OR of the active MasterMode flags for this group.
* See setMasterMode()
*/
int masterMode() const;
private:
void connectPair(Session * master , Session * other);
void disconnectPair(Session * master , Session * other);
void connectAll(bool connect);
QList<Session *> masters() const;
// maps sessions to their master status
QHash<Session *,bool> _sessions;
int _masterMode;
};
}
#endif

@ -0,0 +1,169 @@
/*
Copyright (C) 2007 by Robert Knight <robertknight@gmail.com>
Rewritten for QT4 by e_k <e_k at users.sourceforge.net>, Copyright (C)2008
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
(at your option) any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
02110-1301 USA.
*/
// Own
#include "ShellCommand.h"
//some versions of gcc(4.3) require explicit include
#include <cstdlib>
using namespace Konsole;
// expands environment variables in 'text'
// function copied from kdelibs/kio/kio/kurlcompletion.cpp
static bool expandEnv(QString & text);
ShellCommand::ShellCommand(const QString & fullCommand)
{
bool inQuotes = false;
QString builder;
for ( int i = 0 ; i < fullCommand.count() ; i++ ) {
QChar ch = fullCommand[i];
const bool isLastChar = ( i == fullCommand.count() - 1 );
const bool isQuote = ( ch == '\'' || ch == '\"' );
if ( !isLastChar && isQuote ) {
inQuotes = !inQuotes;
} else {
if ( (!ch.isSpace() || inQuotes) && !isQuote ) {
builder.append(ch);
}
if ( (ch.isSpace() && !inQuotes) || ( i == fullCommand.count()-1 ) ) {
_arguments << builder;
builder.clear();
}
}
}
}
ShellCommand::ShellCommand(const QString & command , const QStringList & arguments)
{
_arguments = arguments;
if ( !_arguments.isEmpty() ) {
_arguments[0] = command;
}
}
QString ShellCommand::fullCommand() const
{
return _arguments.join(QChar(' '));
}
QString ShellCommand::command() const
{
if ( !_arguments.isEmpty() ) {
return _arguments[0];
} else {
return QString();
}
}
QStringList ShellCommand::arguments() const
{
return _arguments;
}
bool ShellCommand::isRootCommand() const
{
Q_ASSERT(0); // not implemented yet
return false;
}
bool ShellCommand::isAvailable() const
{
Q_ASSERT(0); // not implemented yet
return false;
}
QStringList ShellCommand::expand(const QStringList & items)
{
QStringList result;
foreach( QString item , items )
result << expand(item);
return result;
}
QString ShellCommand::expand(const QString & text)
{
QString result = text;
expandEnv(result);
return result;
}
/*
* expandEnv
*
* Expand environment variables in text. Escaped '$' characters are ignored.
* Return true if any variables were expanded
*/
static bool expandEnv( QString & text )
{
// Find all environment variables beginning with '$'
//
int pos = 0;
bool expanded = false;
while ( (pos = text.indexOf(QLatin1Char('$'), pos)) != -1 ) {
// Skip escaped '$'
//
if ( pos > 0 && text.at(pos-1) == QLatin1Char('\\') ) {
pos++;
}
// Variable found => expand
//
else {
// Find the end of the variable = next '/' or ' '
//
int pos2 = text.indexOf( QLatin1Char(' '), pos+1 );
int pos_tmp = text.indexOf( QLatin1Char('/'), pos+1 );
if ( pos2 == -1 || (pos_tmp != -1 && pos_tmp < pos2) ) {
pos2 = pos_tmp;
}
if ( pos2 == -1 ) {
pos2 = text.length();
}
// Replace if the variable is terminated by '/' or ' '
// and defined
//
if ( pos2 >= 0 ) {
int len = pos2 - pos;
QString key = text.mid( pos+1, len-1);
QString value =
QString::fromLocal8Bit( ::getenv(key.toLocal8Bit()) );
if ( !value.isEmpty() ) {
expanded = true;
text.replace( pos, len, value );
pos = pos + value.length();
} else {
pos = pos2;
}
}
}
}
return expanded;
}

@ -0,0 +1,92 @@
/*
Copyright (C) 2007 by Robert Knight <robertknight@gmail.com>
Rewritten for QT4 by e_k <e_k at users.sourceforge.net>, Copyright (C)2008
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
(at your option) any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
02110-1301 USA.
*/
#ifndef SHELLCOMMAND_H
#define SHELLCOMMAND_H
// Qt
#include <QStringList>
namespace Konsole {
/**
* A class to parse and extract information about shell commands.
*
* ShellCommand can be used to:
*
* <ul>
* <li>Take a command-line (eg "/bin/sh -c /path/to/my/script") and split it
* into its component parts (eg. the command "/bin/sh" and the arguments
* "-c","/path/to/my/script")
* </li>
* <li>Take a command and a list of arguments and combine them to
* form a complete command line.
* </li>
* <li>Determine whether the binary specified by a command exists in the
* user's PATH.
* </li>
* <li>Determine whether a command-line specifies the execution of
* another command as the root user using su/sudo etc.
* </li>
* </ul>
*/
class ShellCommand {
public:
/**
* Constructs a ShellCommand from a command line.
*
* @param fullCommand The command line to parse.
*/
ShellCommand(const QString & fullCommand);
/**
* Constructs a ShellCommand with the specified @p command and @p arguments.
*/
ShellCommand(const QString & command , const QStringList & arguments);
/** Returns the command. */
QString command() const;
/** Returns the arguments. */
QStringList arguments() const;
/**
* Returns the full command line.
*/
QString fullCommand() const;
/** Returns true if this is a root command. */
bool isRootCommand() const;
/** Returns true if the program specified by @p command() exists. */
bool isAvailable() const;
/** Expands environment variables in @p text .*/
static QString expand(const QString & text);
/** Expands environment variables in each string in @p list. */
static QStringList expand(const QStringList & items);
private:
QStringList _arguments;
};
}
#endif // SHELLCOMMAND_H

@ -0,0 +1,251 @@
/*
This file is part of Konsole, an X terminal.
Copyright 2006-2008 by Robert Knight <robertknight@gmail.com>
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
(at your option) any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
02110-1301 USA.
*/
// Own
#include "TerminalCharacterDecoder.h"
// Qt
#include <QTextStream>
// KDE
//#include <kdebug.h>
// Konsole
#include "konsole_wcwidth.h"
using namespace Konsole;
PlainTextDecoder::PlainTextDecoder()
: _output(0)
, _includeTrailingWhitespace(true)
, _recordLinePositions(false)
{
}
void PlainTextDecoder::setTrailingWhitespace(bool enable)
{
_includeTrailingWhitespace = enable;
}
bool PlainTextDecoder::trailingWhitespace() const
{
return _includeTrailingWhitespace;
}
void PlainTextDecoder::begin(QTextStream* output)
{
_output = output;
if (!_linePositions.isEmpty())
_linePositions.clear();
}
void PlainTextDecoder::end()
{
_output = 0;
}
void PlainTextDecoder::setRecordLinePositions(bool record)
{
_recordLinePositions = record;
}
QList<int> PlainTextDecoder::linePositions() const
{
return _linePositions;
}
void PlainTextDecoder::decodeLine(const Character* const characters, int count, LineProperty /*properties*/
)
{
Q_ASSERT( _output );
if (_recordLinePositions && _output->string())
{
int pos = _output->string()->count();
_linePositions << pos;
}
//TODO should we ignore or respect the LINE_WRAPPED line property?
//note: we build up a QString and send it to the text stream rather writing into the text
//stream a character at a time because it is more efficient.
//(since QTextStream always deals with QStrings internally anyway)
QString plainText;
plainText.reserve(count);
int outputCount = count;
// if inclusion of trailing whitespace is disabled then find the end of the
// line
if ( !_includeTrailingWhitespace )
{
for (int i = count-1 ; i >= 0 ; i--)
{
if ( characters[i].character != ' ' )
break;
else
outputCount--;
}
}
for (int i=0;i<outputCount;)
{
plainText.append( QChar(characters[i].character) );
i += qMax(1,konsole_wcwidth(characters[i].character));
}
*_output << plainText;
}
HTMLDecoder::HTMLDecoder() :
_output(0)
,_colorTable(base_color_table)
,_innerSpanOpen(false)
,_lastRendition(DEFAULT_RENDITION)
{
}
void HTMLDecoder::begin(QTextStream* output)
{
_output = output;
QString text;
//open monospace span
openSpan(text,"font-family:monospace");
*output << text;
}
void HTMLDecoder::end()
{
Q_ASSERT( _output );
QString text;
closeSpan(text);
*_output << text;
_output = 0;
}
//TODO: Support for LineProperty (mainly double width , double height)
void HTMLDecoder::decodeLine(const Character* const characters, int count, LineProperty /*properties*/
)
{
Q_ASSERT( _output );
QString text;
int spaceCount = 0;
for (int i=0;i<count;i++)
{
QChar ch(characters[i].character);
//check if appearance of character is different from previous char
if ( characters[i].rendition != _lastRendition ||
characters[i].foregroundColor != _lastForeColor ||
characters[i].backgroundColor != _lastBackColor )
{
if ( _innerSpanOpen )
closeSpan(text);
_lastRendition = characters[i].rendition;
_lastForeColor = characters[i].foregroundColor;
_lastBackColor = characters[i].backgroundColor;
//build up style string
QString style;
bool useBold;
ColorEntry::FontWeight weight = characters[i].fontWeight(_colorTable);
if (weight == ColorEntry::UseCurrentFormat)
useBold = _lastRendition & RE_BOLD;
else
useBold = weight == ColorEntry::Bold;
if (useBold)
style.append("font-weight:bold;");
if ( _lastRendition & RE_UNDERLINE )
style.append("font-decoration:underline;");
//colours - a colour table must have been defined first
if ( _colorTable )
{
style.append( QString("color:%1;").arg(_lastForeColor.color(_colorTable).name() ) );
if (!characters[i].isTransparent(_colorTable))
{
style.append( QString("background-color:%1;").arg(_lastBackColor.color(_colorTable).name() ) );
}
}
//open the span with the current style
openSpan(text,style);
_innerSpanOpen = true;
}
//handle whitespace
if (ch.isSpace())
spaceCount++;
else
spaceCount = 0;
//output current character
if (spaceCount < 2)
{
//escape HTML tag characters and just display others as they are
if ( ch == '<' )
text.append("&lt;");
else if (ch == '>')
text.append("&gt;");
else
text.append(ch);
}
else
{
text.append("&nbsp;"); //HTML truncates multiple spaces, so use a space marker instead
}
}
//close any remaining open inner spans
if ( _innerSpanOpen )
closeSpan(text);
//start new line
text.append("<br>");
*_output << text;
}
void HTMLDecoder::openSpan(QString& text , const QString& style)
{
text.append( QString("<span style=\"%1\">").arg(style) );
}
void HTMLDecoder::closeSpan(QString& text)
{
text.append("</span>");
}
void HTMLDecoder::setColorTable(const ColorEntry* table)
{
_colorTable = table;
}

@ -0,0 +1,150 @@
/*
This file is part of Konsole, an X terminal.
Copyright 2006-2008 by Robert Knight <robertknight@gmail.com>
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
(at your option) any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
02110-1301 USA.
*/
#ifndef TERMINAL_CHARACTER_DECODER_H
#define TERMINAL_CHARACTER_DECODER_H
#include "Character.h"
#include <QList>
class QTextStream;
namespace Konsole
{
/**
* Base class for terminal character decoders
*
* The decoder converts lines of terminal characters which consist of a unicode character, foreground
* and background colours and other appearance-related properties into text strings.
*
* Derived classes may produce either plain text with no other colour or appearance information, or
* they may produce text which incorporates these additional properties.
*/
class TerminalCharacterDecoder
{
public:
virtual ~TerminalCharacterDecoder() {}
/** Begin decoding characters. The resulting text is appended to @p output. */
virtual void begin(QTextStream* output) = 0;
/** End decoding. */
virtual void end() = 0;
/**
* Converts a line of terminal characters with associated properties into a text string
* and writes the string into an output QTextStream.
*
* @param characters An array of characters of length @p count.
* @param count The number of characters
* @param properties Additional properties which affect all characters in the line
*/
virtual void decodeLine(const Character* const characters,
int count,
LineProperty properties) = 0;
};
/**
* A terminal character decoder which produces plain text, ignoring colours and other appearance-related
* properties of the original characters.
*/
class PlainTextDecoder : public TerminalCharacterDecoder
{
public:
PlainTextDecoder();
/**
* Set whether trailing whitespace at the end of lines should be included
* in the output.
* Defaults to true.
*/
void setTrailingWhitespace(bool enable);
/**
* Returns whether trailing whitespace at the end of lines is included
* in the output.
*/
bool trailingWhitespace() const;
/**
* Returns of character positions in the output stream
* at which new lines where added. Returns an empty if setTrackLinePositions() is false or if
* the output device is not a string.
*/
QList<int> linePositions() const;
/** Enables recording of character positions at which new lines are added. See linePositions() */
void setRecordLinePositions(bool record);
virtual void begin(QTextStream* output);
virtual void end();
virtual void decodeLine(const Character* const characters,
int count,
LineProperty properties);
private:
QTextStream* _output;
bool _includeTrailingWhitespace;
bool _recordLinePositions;
QList<int> _linePositions;
};
/**
* A terminal character decoder which produces pretty HTML markup
*/
class HTMLDecoder : public TerminalCharacterDecoder
{
public:
/**
* Constructs an HTML decoder using a default black-on-white color scheme.
*/
HTMLDecoder();
/**
* Sets the colour table which the decoder uses to produce the HTML colour codes in its
* output
*/
void setColorTable( const ColorEntry* table );
virtual void decodeLine(const Character* const characters,
int count,
LineProperty properties);
virtual void begin(QTextStream* output);
virtual void end();
private:
void openSpan(QString& text , const QString& style);
void closeSpan(QString& text);
QTextStream* _output;
const ColorEntry* _colorTable;
bool _innerSpanOpen;
quint8 _lastRendition;
CharacterColor _lastForeColor;
CharacterColor _lastBackColor;
};
}
#endif

File diff suppressed because it is too large Load Diff

@ -0,0 +1,857 @@
/*
Copyright 2007-2008 by Robert Knight <robertknight@gmail.com>
Copyright 1997,1998 by Lars Doelle <lars.doelle@on-line.de>
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
(at your option) any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
02110-1301 USA.
*/
#ifndef TERMINALDISPLAY_H
#define TERMINALDISPLAY_H
// Qt
#include <QColor>
#include <QPointer>
#include <QWidget>
// Konsole
#include "Filter.h"
#include "Character.h"
//#include "konsole_export.h"
#define KONSOLEPRIVATE_EXPORT
class QDrag;
class QDragEnterEvent;
class QDropEvent;
class QLabel;
class QTimer;
class QEvent;
class QGridLayout;
class QKeyEvent;
class QScrollBar;
class QShowEvent;
class QHideEvent;
class QTimerEvent;
class QWidget;
//class KMenu;
namespace Konsole
{
enum MotionAfterPasting
{
// No move screenwindow after pasting
NoMoveScreenWindow = 0,
// Move start of screenwindow after pasting
MoveStartScreenWindow = 1,
// Move end of screenwindow after pasting
MoveEndScreenWindow = 2
};
extern unsigned short vt100_graphics[32];
class ScreenWindow;
/**
* A widget which displays output from a terminal emulation and sends input keypresses and mouse activity
* to the terminal.
*
* When the terminal emulation receives new output from the program running in the terminal,
* it will update the display by calling updateImage().
*
* TODO More documentation
*/
class KONSOLEPRIVATE_EXPORT TerminalDisplay : public QWidget
{
Q_OBJECT
public:
/** Constructs a new terminal display widget with the specified parent. */
TerminalDisplay(QWidget *parent=0);
virtual ~TerminalDisplay();
/** Returns the terminal color palette used by the display. */
const ColorEntry* colorTable() const;
/** Sets the terminal color palette used by the display. */
void setColorTable(const ColorEntry table[]);
/**
* Sets the seed used to generate random colors for the display
* (in color schemes that support them).
*/
void setRandomSeed(uint seed);
/**
* Returns the seed used to generate random colors for the display
* (in color schemes that support them).
*/
uint randomSeed() const;
/** Sets the opacity of the terminal display. */
void setOpacity(qreal opacity);
/**
* This enum describes the location where the scroll bar is positioned in the display widget.
*/
enum ScrollBarPosition
{
/** Do not show the scroll bar. */
NoScrollBar=0,
/** Show the scroll bar on the left side of the display. */
ScrollBarLeft=1,
/** Show the scroll bar on the right side of the display. */
ScrollBarRight=2
};
/**
* Specifies whether the terminal display has a vertical scroll bar, and if so whether it
* is shown on the left or right side of the display.
*/
void setScrollBarPosition(ScrollBarPosition position);
/**
* Sets the current position and range of the display's scroll bar.
*
* @param cursor The position of the scroll bar's thumb.
* @param lines The maximum value of the scroll bar.
*/
void setScroll(int cursor, int lines);
/**
* Scroll to the bottom of the terminal (reset scrolling).
*/
void scrollToEnd();
/**
* Returns the display's filter chain. When the image for the display is updated,
* the text is passed through each filter in the chain. Each filter can define
* hotspots which correspond to certain strings (such as URLs or particular words).
* Depending on the type of the hotspots created by the filter ( returned by Filter::Hotspot::type() )
* the view will draw visual cues such as underlines on mouse-over for links or translucent
* rectangles for markers.
*
* To add a new filter to the view, call:
* viewWidget->filterChain()->addFilter( filterObject );
*/
FilterChain* filterChain() const;
/**
* Updates the filters in the display's filter chain. This will cause
* the hotspots to be updated to match the current image.
*
* WARNING: This function can be expensive depending on the
* image size and number of filters in the filterChain()
*
* TODO - This API does not really allow efficient usage. Revise it so
* that the processing can be done in a better way.
*
* eg:
* - Area of interest may be known ( eg. mouse cursor hovering
* over an area )
*/
void processFilters();
/**
* Returns a list of menu actions created by the filters for the content
* at the given @p position.
*/
QList<QAction*> filterActions(const QPoint& position);
/** Returns true if the cursor is set to blink or false otherwise. */
bool blinkingCursor() { return _hasBlinkingCursor; }
/** Specifies whether or not the cursor blinks. */
void setBlinkingCursor(bool blink);
/** Specifies whether or not text can blink. */
void setBlinkingTextEnabled(bool blink);
void setCtrlDrag(bool enable) { _ctrlDrag=enable; }
bool ctrlDrag() { return _ctrlDrag; }
/**
* This enum describes the methods for selecting text when
* the user triple-clicks within the display.
*/
enum TripleClickMode
{
/** Select the whole line underneath the cursor. */
SelectWholeLine,
/** Select from the current cursor position to the end of the line. */
SelectForwardsFromCursor
};
/** Sets how the text is selected when the user triple clicks within the display. */
void setTripleClickMode(TripleClickMode mode) { _tripleClickMode = mode; }
/** See setTripleClickSelectionMode() */
TripleClickMode tripleClickMode() { return _tripleClickMode; }
void setLineSpacing(uint);
uint lineSpacing() const;
void emitSelection(bool useXselection,bool appendReturn);
/**
* This enum describes the available shapes for the keyboard cursor.
* See setKeyboardCursorShape()
*/
enum KeyboardCursorShape
{
/** A rectangular block which covers the entire area of the cursor character. */
BlockCursor,
/**
* A single flat line which occupies the space at the bottom of the cursor
* character's area.
*/
UnderlineCursor,
/**
* An cursor shaped like the capital letter 'I', similar to the IBeam
* cursor used in Qt/KDE text editors.
*/
IBeamCursor
};
/**
* Sets the shape of the keyboard cursor. This is the cursor drawn
* at the position in the terminal where keyboard input will appear.
*
* In addition the terminal display widget also has a cursor for
* the mouse pointer, which can be set using the QWidget::setCursor()
* method.
*
* Defaults to BlockCursor
*/
void setKeyboardCursorShape(KeyboardCursorShape shape);
/**
* Returns the shape of the keyboard cursor. See setKeyboardCursorShape()
*/
KeyboardCursorShape keyboardCursorShape() const;
/**
* Sets the color used to draw the keyboard cursor.
*
* The keyboard cursor defaults to using the foreground color of the character
* underneath it.
*
* @param useForegroundColor If true, the cursor color will change to match
* the foreground color of the character underneath it as it is moved, in this
* case, the @p color parameter is ignored and the color of the character
* under the cursor is inverted to ensure that it is still readable.
* @param color The color to use to draw the cursor. This is only taken into
* account if @p useForegroundColor is false.
*/
void setKeyboardCursorColor(bool useForegroundColor , const QColor& color);
/**
* Returns the color of the keyboard cursor, or an invalid color if the keyboard
* cursor color is set to change according to the foreground color of the character
* underneath it.
*/
QColor keyboardCursorColor() const;
/**
* Returns the number of lines of text which can be displayed in the widget.
*
* This will depend upon the height of the widget and the current font.
* See fontHeight()
*/
int lines() { return _lines; }
/**
* Returns the number of characters of text which can be displayed on
* each line in the widget.
*
* This will depend upon the width of the widget and the current font.
* See fontWidth()
*/
int columns() { return _columns; }
/**
* Returns the height of the characters in the font used to draw the text in the display.
*/
int fontHeight() { return _fontHeight; }
/**
* Returns the width of the characters in the display.
* This assumes the use of a fixed-width font.
*/
int fontWidth() { return _fontWidth; }
void setSize(int cols, int lins);
void setFixedSize(int cols, int lins);
// reimplemented
QSize sizeHint() const;
/**
* Sets which characters, in addition to letters and numbers,
* are regarded as being part of a word for the purposes
* of selecting words in the display by double clicking on them.
*
* The word boundaries occur at the first and last characters which
* are either a letter, number, or a character in @p wc
*
* @param wc An array of characters which are to be considered parts
* of a word ( in addition to letters and numbers ).
*/
void setWordCharacters(const QString& wc);
/**
* Returns the characters which are considered part of a word for the
* purpose of selecting words in the display with the mouse.
*
* @see setWordCharacters()
*/
QString wordCharacters() { return _wordCharacters; }
/**
* Sets the type of effect used to alert the user when a 'bell' occurs in the
* terminal session.
*
* The terminal session can trigger the bell effect by calling bell() with
* the alert message.
*/
void setBellMode(int mode);
/**
* Returns the type of effect used to alert the user when a 'bell' occurs in
* the terminal session.
*
* See setBellMode()
*/
int bellMode() { return _bellMode; }
/**
* This enum describes the different types of sounds and visual effects which
* can be used to alert the user when a 'bell' occurs in the terminal
* session.
*/
enum BellMode
{
/** A system beep. */
SystemBeepBell=0,
/**
* KDE notification. This may play a sound, show a passive popup
* or perform some other action depending on the user's settings.
*/
NotifyBell=1,
/** A silent, visual bell (eg. inverting the display's colors briefly) */
VisualBell=2,
/** No bell effects */
NoBell=3
};
void setSelection(const QString &t);
/**
* Reimplemented. Has no effect. Use setVTFont() to change the font
* used to draw characters in the display.
*/
virtual void setFont(const QFont &);
/** Returns the font used to draw characters in the display */
QFont getVTFont() { return font(); }
/**
* Sets the font used to draw the display. Has no effect if @p font
* is larger than the size of the display itself.
*/
void setVTFont(const QFont& font);
/**
* Specified whether anti-aliasing of text in the terminal display
* is enabled or not. Defaults to enabled.
*/
static void setAntialias( bool antialias ) { _antialiasText = antialias; }
/**
* Returns true if anti-aliasing of text in the terminal is enabled.
*/
static bool antialias() { return _antialiasText; }
/**
* Specifies whether characters with intense colors should be rendered
* as bold. Defaults to true.
*/
void setBoldIntense(bool value) { _boldIntense = value; }
/**
* Returns true if characters with intense colors are rendered in bold.
*/
bool getBoldIntense() { return _boldIntense; }
/**
* Sets whether or not the current height and width of the
* terminal in lines and columns is displayed whilst the widget
* is being resized.
*/
void setTerminalSizeHint(bool on) { _terminalSizeHint=on; }
/**
* Returns whether or not the current height and width of
* the terminal in lines and columns is displayed whilst the widget
* is being resized.
*/
bool terminalSizeHint() { return _terminalSizeHint; }
/**
* Sets whether the terminal size display is shown briefly
* after the widget is first shown.
*
* See setTerminalSizeHint() , isTerminalSizeHint()
*/
void setTerminalSizeStartup(bool on) { _terminalSizeStartup=on; }
/**
* Sets the status of the BiDi rendering inside the terminal display.
* Defaults to disabled.
*/
void setBidiEnabled(bool set) { _bidiEnabled=set; }
/**
* Returns the status of the BiDi rendering in this widget.
*/
bool isBidiEnabled() { return _bidiEnabled; }
/**
* Sets the terminal screen section which is displayed in this widget.
* When updateImage() is called, the display fetches the latest character image from the
* the associated terminal screen window.
*
* In terms of the model-view paradigm, the ScreenWindow is the model which is rendered
* by the TerminalDisplay.
*/
void setScreenWindow( ScreenWindow* window );
/** Returns the terminal screen section which is displayed in this widget. See setScreenWindow() */
ScreenWindow* screenWindow() const;
static bool HAVE_TRANSPARENCY;
void setMotionAfterPasting(MotionAfterPasting action);
int motionAfterPasting();
// maps a point on the widget to the position ( ie. line and column )
// of the character at that point.
void getCharacterPosition(const QPoint& widgetPoint,int& line,int& column) const;
public slots:
/**
* Causes the terminal display to fetch the latest character image from the associated
* terminal screen ( see setScreenWindow() ) and redraw the display.
*/
void updateImage();
/** Essentially calles processFilters().
*/
void updateFilters();
/**
* Causes the terminal display to fetch the latest line status flags from the
* associated terminal screen ( see setScreenWindow() ).
*/
void updateLineProperties();
/** Copies the selected text to the clipboard. */
void copyClipboard();
/**
* Pastes the content of the clipboard into the
* display.
*/
void pasteClipboard();
/**
* Pastes the content of the selection into the
* display.
*/
void pasteSelection();
/**
* Changes whether the flow control warning box should be shown when the flow control
* stop key (Ctrl+S) are pressed.
*/
void setFlowControlWarningEnabled(bool enabled);
/**
* Returns true if the flow control warning box is enabled.
* See outputSuspended() and setFlowControlWarningEnabled()
*/
bool flowControlWarningEnabled() const
{ return _flowControlWarningEnabled; }
/**
* Causes the widget to display or hide a message informing the user that terminal
* output has been suspended (by using the flow control key combination Ctrl+S)
*
* @param suspended True if terminal output has been suspended and the warning message should
* be shown or false to indicate that terminal output has been resumed and that
* the warning message should disappear.
*/
void outputSuspended(bool suspended);
/**
* Sets whether the program whoose output is being displayed in the view
* is interested in mouse events.
*
* If this is set to true, mouse signals will be emitted by the view when the user clicks, drags
* or otherwise moves the mouse inside the view.
* The user interaction needed to create selections will also change, and the user will be required
* to hold down the shift key to create a selection or perform other mouse activities inside the
* view area - since the program running in the terminal is being allowed to handle normal mouse
* events itself.
*
* @param usesMouse Set to true if the program running in the terminal is interested in mouse events
* or false otherwise.
*/
void setUsesMouse(bool usesMouse);
/** See setUsesMouse() */
bool usesMouse() const;
/**
* Shows a notification that a bell event has occurred in the terminal.
* TODO: More documentation here
*/
void bell(const QString& message);
/**
* Sets the background of the display to the specified color.
* @see setColorTable(), setForegroundColor()
*/
void setBackgroundColor(const QColor& color);
/**
* Sets the text of the display to the specified color.
* @see setColorTable(), setBackgroundColor()
*/
void setForegroundColor(const QColor& color);
void selectionChanged();
signals:
/**
* Emitted when the user presses a key whilst the terminal widget has focus.
*/
void keyPressedSignal(QKeyEvent *e);
/**
* A mouse event occurred.
* @param button The mouse button (0 for left button, 1 for middle button, 2 for right button, 3 for release)
* @param column The character column where the event occurred
* @param line The character row where the event occurred
* @param eventType The type of event. 0 for a mouse press / release or 1 for mouse motion
*/
void mouseSignal(int button, int column, int line, int eventType);
void changedFontMetricSignal(int height, int width);
void changedContentSizeSignal(int height, int width);
/**
* Emitted when the user right clicks on the display, or right-clicks with the Shift
* key held down if usesMouse() is true.
*
* This can be used to display a context menu.
*/
void configureRequest(const QPoint& position);
/**
* When a shortcut which is also a valid terminal key sequence is pressed while
* the terminal widget has focus, this signal is emitted to allow the host to decide
* whether the shortcut should be overridden.
* When the shortcut is overridden, the key sequence will be sent to the terminal emulation instead
* and the action associated with the shortcut will not be triggered.
*
* @p override is set to false by default and the shortcut will be triggered as normal.
*/
void overrideShortcutCheck(QKeyEvent* keyEvent,bool& override);
void isBusySelecting(bool);
void sendStringToEmu(const char*);
// qtermwidget signals
void copyAvailable(bool);
void termGetFocus();
void termLostFocus();
void notifyBell(const QString&);
protected:
virtual bool event( QEvent * );
virtual void paintEvent( QPaintEvent * );
virtual void showEvent(QShowEvent*);
virtual void hideEvent(QHideEvent*);
virtual void resizeEvent(QResizeEvent*);
virtual void fontChange(const QFont &font);
virtual void focusInEvent(QFocusEvent* event);
virtual void focusOutEvent(QFocusEvent* event);
virtual void keyPressEvent(QKeyEvent* event);
virtual void mouseDoubleClickEvent(QMouseEvent* ev);
virtual void mousePressEvent( QMouseEvent* );
virtual void mouseReleaseEvent( QMouseEvent* );
virtual void mouseMoveEvent( QMouseEvent* );
virtual void extendSelection( const QPoint& pos );
virtual void wheelEvent( QWheelEvent* );
virtual bool focusNextPrevChild( bool next );
// drag and drop
virtual void dragEnterEvent(QDragEnterEvent* event);
virtual void dropEvent(QDropEvent* event);
void doDrag();
enum DragState { diNone, diPending, diDragging };
struct _dragInfo {
DragState state;
QPoint start;
QDrag *dragObject;
} dragInfo;
// classifies the 'ch' into one of three categories
// and returns a character to indicate which category it is in
//
// - A space (returns ' ')
// - Part of a word (returns 'a')
// - Other characters (returns the input character)
QChar charClass(QChar ch) const;
void clearImage();
void mouseTripleClickEvent(QMouseEvent* ev);
// reimplemented
virtual void inputMethodEvent ( QInputMethodEvent* event );
virtual QVariant inputMethodQuery( Qt::InputMethodQuery query ) const;
protected slots:
void scrollBarPositionChanged(int value);
void blinkEvent();
void blinkCursorEvent();
//Renables bell noises and visuals. Used to disable further bells for a short period of time
//after emitting the first in a sequence of bell events.
void enableBell();
private slots:
void swapColorTable();
void tripleClickTimeout(); // resets possibleTripleClick
private:
// -- Drawing helpers --
// divides the part of the display specified by 'rect' into
// fragments according to their colors and styles and calls
// drawTextFragment() to draw the fragments
void drawContents(QPainter &paint, const QRect &rect);
// draws a section of text, all the text in this section
// has a common color and style
void drawTextFragment(QPainter& painter, const QRect& rect,
const QString& text, const Character* style);
// draws the background for a text fragment
// if useOpacitySetting is true then the color's alpha value will be set to
// the display's transparency (set with setOpacity()), otherwise the background
// will be drawn fully opaque
void drawBackground(QPainter& painter, const QRect& rect, const QColor& color,
bool useOpacitySetting);
// draws the cursor character
void drawCursor(QPainter& painter, const QRect& rect , const QColor& foregroundColor,
const QColor& backgroundColor , bool& invertColors);
// draws the characters or line graphics in a text fragment
void drawCharacters(QPainter& painter, const QRect& rect, const QString& text,
const Character* style, bool invertCharacterColor);
// draws a string of line graphics
void drawLineCharString(QPainter& painter, int x, int y,
const QString& str, const Character* attributes);
// draws the preedit string for input methods
void drawInputMethodPreeditString(QPainter& painter , const QRect& rect);
// --
// maps an area in the character image to an area on the widget
QRect imageToWidget(const QRect& imageArea) const;
// the area where the preedit string for input methods will be draw
QRect preeditRect() const;
// shows a notification window in the middle of the widget indicating the terminal's
// current size in columns and lines
void showResizeNotification();
// scrolls the image by a number of lines.
// 'lines' may be positive ( to scroll the image down )
// or negative ( to scroll the image up )
// 'region' is the part of the image to scroll - currently only
// the top, bottom and height of 'region' are taken into account,
// the left and right are ignored.
void scrollImage(int lines , const QRect& region);
void calcGeometry();
void propagateSize();
void updateImageSize();
void makeImage();
void paintFilters(QPainter& painter);
// returns a region covering all of the areas of the widget which contain
// a hotspot
QRegion hotSpotRegion() const;
// returns the position of the cursor in columns and lines
QPoint cursorPosition() const;
// redraws the cursor
void updateCursor();
bool handleShortcutOverrideEvent(QKeyEvent* event);
// the window onto the terminal screen which this display
// is currently showing.
QPointer<ScreenWindow> _screenWindow;
bool _allowBell;
QGridLayout* _gridLayout;
bool _fixedFont; // has fixed pitch
int _fontHeight; // height
int _fontWidth; // width
int _fontAscent; // ascend
bool _boldIntense; // Whether intense colors should be rendered with bold font
int _leftMargin; // offset
int _topMargin; // offset
int _lines; // the number of lines that can be displayed in the widget
int _columns; // the number of columns that can be displayed in the widget
int _usedLines; // the number of lines that are actually being used, this will be less
// than 'lines' if the character image provided with setImage() is smaller
// than the maximum image size which can be displayed
int _usedColumns; // the number of columns that are actually being used, this will be less
// than 'columns' if the character image provided with setImage() is smaller
// than the maximum image size which can be displayed
int _contentHeight;
int _contentWidth;
Character* _image; // [lines][columns]
// only the area [usedLines][usedColumns] in the image contains valid data
int _imageSize;
QVector<LineProperty> _lineProperties;
ColorEntry _colorTable[TABLE_COLORS];
uint _randomSeed;
bool _resizing;
bool _terminalSizeHint;
bool _terminalSizeStartup;
bool _bidiEnabled;
bool _mouseMarks;
QPoint _iPntSel; // initial selection point
QPoint _pntSel; // current selection point
QPoint _tripleSelBegin; // help avoid flicker
int _actSel; // selection state
bool _wordSelectionMode;
bool _lineSelectionMode;
bool _preserveLineBreaks;
bool _columnSelectionMode;
QClipboard* _clipboard;
QScrollBar* _scrollBar;
ScrollBarPosition _scrollbarLocation;
QString _wordCharacters;
int _bellMode;
bool _blinking; // hide text in paintEvent
bool _hasBlinker; // has characters to blink
bool _cursorBlinking; // hide cursor in paintEvent
bool _hasBlinkingCursor; // has blinking cursor enabled
bool _allowBlinkingText; // allow text to blink
bool _ctrlDrag; // require Ctrl key for drag
TripleClickMode _tripleClickMode;
bool _isFixedSize; //Columns / lines are locked.
QTimer* _blinkTimer; // active when hasBlinker
QTimer* _blinkCursorTimer; // active when hasBlinkingCursor
//QMenu* _drop;
QString _dropText;
int _dndFileCount;
bool _possibleTripleClick; // is set in mouseDoubleClickEvent and deleted
// after QApplication::doubleClickInterval() delay
QLabel* _resizeWidget;
QTimer* _resizeTimer;
bool _flowControlWarningEnabled;
//widgets related to the warning message that appears when the user presses Ctrl+S to suspend
//terminal output - informing them what has happened and how to resume output
QLabel* _outputSuspendedLabel;
uint _lineSpacing;
bool _colorsInverted; // true during visual bell
QSize _size;
QRgb _blendColor;
// list of filters currently applied to the display. used for links and
// search highlight
TerminalImageFilterChain* _filterChain;
QRegion _mouseOverHotspotArea;
KeyboardCursorShape _cursorShape;
// custom cursor color. if this is invalid then the foreground
// color of the character under the cursor is used
QColor _cursorColor;
MotionAfterPasting mMotionAfterPasting;
struct InputMethodData
{
QString preeditString;
QRect previousPreeditRect;
};
InputMethodData _inputMethodData;
static bool _antialiasText; // do we antialias or not
//the delay in milliseconds between redrawing blinking text
static const int TEXT_BLINK_DELAY = 500;
static const int DEFAULT_LEFT_MARGIN = 1;
static const int DEFAULT_TOP_MARGIN = 1;
public:
static void setTransparencyEnabled(bool enable)
{
HAVE_TRANSPARENCY = enable;
}
};
class AutoScrollHandler : public QObject
{
Q_OBJECT
public:
AutoScrollHandler(QWidget* parent);
protected:
virtual void timerEvent(QTimerEvent* event);
virtual bool eventFilter(QObject* watched,QEvent* event);
private:
QWidget* widget() const { return static_cast<QWidget*>(parent()); }
int _timerId;
};
}
#endif // TERMINALDISPLAY_H

File diff suppressed because it is too large Load Diff

@ -0,0 +1,191 @@
/*
This file is part of Konsole, an X terminal.
Copyright 2007-2008 by Robert Knight <robertknight@gmail.com>
Copyright 1997,1998 by Lars Doelle <lars.doelle@on-line.de>
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
(at your option) any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
02110-1301 USA.
*/
#ifndef VT102EMULATION_H
#define VT102EMULATION_H
// Standard Library
#include <stdio.h>
// Qt
#include <QKeyEvent>
#include <QHash>
#include <QTimer>
// Konsole
#include "Emulation.h"
#include "Screen.h"
#define MODE_AppScreen (MODES_SCREEN+0) // Mode #1
#define MODE_AppCuKeys (MODES_SCREEN+1) // Application cursor keys (DECCKM)
#define MODE_AppKeyPad (MODES_SCREEN+2) //
#define MODE_Mouse1000 (MODES_SCREEN+3) // Send mouse X,Y position on press and release
#define MODE_Mouse1001 (MODES_SCREEN+4) // Use Hilight mouse tracking
#define MODE_Mouse1002 (MODES_SCREEN+5) // Use cell motion mouse tracking
#define MODE_Mouse1003 (MODES_SCREEN+6) // Use all motion mouse tracking
#define MODE_Ansi (MODES_SCREEN+7) // Use US Ascii for character sets G0-G3 (DECANM)
#define MODE_132Columns (MODES_SCREEN+8) // 80 <-> 132 column mode switch (DECCOLM)
#define MODE_Allow132Columns (MODES_SCREEN+9) // Allow DECCOLM mode
#define MODE_total (MODES_SCREEN+10)
namespace Konsole
{
struct CharCodes
{
// coding info
char charset[4]; //
int cu_cs; // actual charset.
bool graphic; // Some VT100 tricks
bool pound ; // Some VT100 tricks
bool sa_graphic; // saved graphic
bool sa_pound; // saved pound
};
/**
* Provides an xterm compatible terminal emulation based on the DEC VT102 terminal.
* A full description of this terminal can be found at http://vt100.net/docs/vt102-ug/
*
* In addition, various additional xterm escape sequences are supported to provide
* features such as mouse input handling.
* See http://rtfm.etla.org/xterm/ctlseq.html for a description of xterm's escape
* sequences.
*
*/
class Vt102Emulation : public Emulation
{
Q_OBJECT
public:
/** Constructs a new emulation */
Vt102Emulation();
~Vt102Emulation();
// reimplemented from Emulation
virtual void clearEntireScreen();
virtual void reset();
virtual char eraseChar() const;
public slots:
// reimplemented from Emulation
virtual void sendString(const char*,int length = -1);
virtual void sendText(const QString& text);
virtual void sendKeyEvent(QKeyEvent*);
virtual void sendMouseEvent(int buttons, int column, int line, int eventType);
protected:
// reimplemented from Emulation
virtual void setMode(int mode);
virtual void resetMode(int mode);
virtual void receiveChar(int cc);
private slots:
//causes changeTitle() to be emitted for each (int,QString) pair in pendingTitleUpdates
//used to buffer multiple title updates
void updateTitle();
private:
unsigned short applyCharset(unsigned short c);
void setCharset(int n, int cs);
void useCharset(int n);
void setAndUseCharset(int n, int cs);
void saveCursor();
void restoreCursor();
void resetCharset(int scrno);
void setMargins(int top, int bottom);
//set margins for all screens back to their defaults
void setDefaultMargins();
// returns true if 'mode' is set or false otherwise
bool getMode (int mode);
// saves the current boolean value of 'mode'
void saveMode (int mode);
// restores the boolean value of 'mode'
void restoreMode(int mode);
// resets all modes
// (except MODE_Allow132Columns)
void resetModes();
void resetTokenizer();
#define MAX_TOKEN_LENGTH 80
void addToCurrentToken(int cc);
int tokenBuffer[MAX_TOKEN_LENGTH]; //FIXME: overflow?
int tokenBufferPos;
#define MAXARGS 15
void addDigit(int dig);
void addArgument();
int argv[MAXARGS];
int argc;
void initTokenizer();
// Set of flags for each of the ASCII characters which indicates
// what category they fall into (printable character, control, digit etc.)
// for the purposes of decoding terminal output
int charClass[256];
void reportDecodingError();
void processToken(int code, int p, int q);
void processWindowAttributeChange();
void reportTerminalType();
void reportSecondaryAttributes();
void reportStatus();
void reportAnswerBack();
void reportCursorPosition();
void reportTerminalParms(int p);
void onScrollLock();
void scrollLock(const bool lock);
// clears the screen and resizes it to the specified
// number of columns
void clearScreenAndSetColumns(int columnCount);
CharCodes _charset[2];
class TerminalState
{
public:
// Initializes all modes to false
TerminalState()
{ memset(&mode,false,MODE_total * sizeof(bool)); }
bool mode[MODE_total];
};
TerminalState _currentModes;
TerminalState _savedModes;
//hash table and timer for buffering calls to the session instance
//to update the name of the session
//or window title.
//these calls occur when certain escape sequences are seen in the
//output from the terminal
QHash<int,QString> _pendingTitleUpdates;
QTimer* _titleUpdateTimer;
};
}
#endif // VT102EMULATION_H

@ -0,0 +1,42 @@
# example scheme for konsole
# the title is to appear in the menu.
title Black on Light Yellow
# foreground colors
# note that the default background color is flagged
# to become transparent when an image is present.
# slot transparent bold
# | | |
# V V--color--V V V
color 0 0 0 0 0 0 # regular foreground color (Black)
color 1 255 255 221 1 0 # regular background color (Light Yellow)
color 2 0 0 0 0 0 # regular color 0 Black
color 3 178 24 24 0 0 # regular color 1 Red
color 4 24 178 24 0 0 # regular color 2 Green
color 5 178 104 24 0 0 # regular color 3 Yellow
color 6 24 24 178 0 0 # regular color 4 Blue
color 7 178 24 178 0 0 # regular color 5 Magenta
color 8 24 178 178 0 0 # regular color 6 Cyan
color 9 178 178 178 0 0 # regular color 7 White
# intensive colors
# instead of changing the colors, we've flaged the text to become bold
color 10 0 0 0 0 1 # intensive foreground color
color 11 255 255 221 1 0 # intensive background color
color 12 104 104 104 0 0 # intensive color 0
color 13 255 84 84 0 0 # intensive color 1
color 14 84 255 84 0 0 # intensive color 2
color 15 255 255 84 0 0 # intensive color 3
color 16 84 84 255 0 0 # intensive color 4
color 17 255 84 255 0 0 # intensive color 5
color 18 84 255 255 0 0 # intensive color 6
color 19 255 255 255 0 0 # intensive color 7

@ -0,0 +1,104 @@
[Background]
Bold=false
Color=247,247,214
Transparency=true
MaxRandomHue=340
[BackgroundIntense]
Bold=false
Color=255,255,221
Transparency=true
[Color0]
Bold=false
Color=0,0,0
Transparency=false
[Color0Intense]
Bold=false
Color=104,104,104
Transparency=false
[Color1]
Bold=false
Color=178,24,24
Transparency=false
[Color1Intense]
Bold=false
Color=255,84,84
Transparency=false
[Color2]
Bold=false
Color=24,178,24
Transparency=false
[Color2Intense]
Bold=false
Color=84,255,84
Transparency=false
[Color3]
Bold=false
Color=178,104,24
Transparency=false
[Color3Intense]
Bold=false
Color=255,255,84
Transparency=false
[Color4]
Bold=false
Color=24,24,178
Transparency=false
[Color4Intense]
Bold=false
Color=84,84,255
Transparency=false
[Color5]
Bold=false
Color=178,24,178
Transparency=false
[Color5Intense]
Bold=false
Color=255,84,255
Transparency=false
[Color6]
Bold=false
Color=24,178,178
Transparency=false
[Color6Intense]
Bold=false
Color=84,255,255
Transparency=false
[Color7]
Bold=false
Color=178,178,178
Transparency=false
[Color7Intense]
Bold=false
Color=255,255,255
Transparency=false
[Foreground]
Bold=false
Color=0,0,0
Transparency=false
[ForegroundIntense]
Bold=true
Color=0,0,0
Transparency=false
[General]
Description=Black on Random Light
Opacity=1

@ -0,0 +1,42 @@
# example scheme for konsole
# the title is to appear in the menu.
title Black on White
# foreground colors
# note that the default background color is flagged
# to become transparent when an image is present.
# slot transparent bold
# | | |
# V V--color--V V V
color 0 0 0 0 0 0 # regular foreground color (Black)
color 1 255 255 255 1 0 # regular background color (White)
color 2 0 0 0 0 0 # regular color 0 Black
color 3 178 24 24 0 0 # regular color 1 Red
color 4 24 178 24 0 0 # regular color 2 Green
color 5 178 104 24 0 0 # regular color 3 Yellow
color 6 24 24 178 0 0 # regular color 4 Blue
color 7 178 24 178 0 0 # regular color 5 Magenta
color 8 24 178 178 0 0 # regular color 6 Cyan
color 9 178 178 178 0 0 # regular color 7 White
# intensive colors
# instead of changing the colors, we've flaged the text to become bold
color 10 0 0 0 0 1 # intensive foreground color
color 11 255 255 255 1 0 # intensive background color
color 12 104 104 104 0 0 # intensive color 0
color 13 255 84 84 0 0 # intensive color 1
color 14 84 255 84 0 0 # intensive color 2
color 15 255 255 84 0 0 # intensive color 3
color 16 84 84 255 0 0 # intensive color 4
color 17 255 84 255 0 0 # intensive color 5
color 18 84 255 255 0 0 # intensive color 6
color 19 255 255 255 0 0 # intensive color 7

@ -0,0 +1,103 @@
[Background]
Bold=false
Color=44,44,44
Transparency=false
[BackgroundIntense]
Bold=true
Color=44,44,44
Transparency=false
[Color0]
Bold=false
Color=63,63,63
Transparency=false
[Color0Intense]
Bold=true
Color=112,144,128
Transparency=false
[Color1]
Bold=false
Color=112,80,80
Transparency=false
[Color1Intense]
Bold=true
Color=220,163,163
Transparency=false
[Color2]
Bold=false
Color=96,180,138
Transparency=false
[Color2Intense]
Bold=true
Color=114,213,163
Transparency=false
[Color3]
Bold=false
Color=223,175,143
Transparency=false
[Color3Intense]
Bold=true
Color=240,223,175
Transparency=false
[Color4]
Bold=false
Color=154,184,215
Transparency=false
[Color4Intense]
Bold=true
Color=148,191,243
Transparency=false
[Color5]
Bold=false
Color=220,140,195
Transparency=false
[Color5Intense]
Bold=true
Color=236,147,211
Transparency=false
[Color6]
Bold=false
Color=140,208,211
Transparency=false
[Color6Intense]
Bold=true
Color=147,224,227
Transparency=false
[Color7]
Bold=false
Color=220,220,204
Transparency=false
[Color7Intense]
Bold=true
Color=255,255,255
Transparency=false
[Foreground]
Bold=false
Color=220,220,204
Transparency=false
[ForegroundIntense]
Bold=true
Color=220,220,204
Transparency=false
[General]
Description=Dark Pastels
Opacity=1

@ -0,0 +1,104 @@
[Background]
Bold=false
Color=0,0,0
Transparency=false
[BackgroundIntense]
Bold=false
Color=0,0,0
Transparency=false
[Color0]
Bold=false
Color=0,0,0
Transparency=false
[Color0Intense]
Bold=false
Color=104,104,104
Transparency=false
[Color1]
Bold=false
Color=250,75,75
Transparency=false
[Color1Intense]
Bold=false
Color=255,84,84
Transparency=false
[Color2]
Bold=false
Color=24,178,24
Transparency=false
[Color2Intense]
Bold=false
Color=84,255,84
Transparency=false
[Color3]
Bold=false
Color=178,104,24
Transparency=false
[Color3Intense]
Bold=false
Color=255,255,84
Transparency=false
[Color4]
Bold=false
Color=92,167,251
Transparency=false
[Color4Intense]
Bold=false
Color=84,84,255
Transparency=false
[Color5]
Bold=false
Color=225,30,225
Transparency=false
[Color5Intense]
Bold=false
Color=255,84,255
Transparency=false
[Color6]
Bold=false
Color=24,178,178
Transparency=false
[Color6Intense]
Bold=false
Color=84,255,255
Transparency=false
[Color7]
Bold=false
Color=178,178,178
Transparency=false
[Color7Intense]
Bold=false
Color=255,255,255
Transparency=false
[Foreground]
Bold=false
Color=24,240,24
Transparency=false
[ForegroundIntense]
Bold=true
Color=24,240,24
Transparency=false
[General]
Description=Green on Black
Opacity=1

@ -0,0 +1,100 @@
[Background]
Bold=false
Color=0,0,0
[BackgroundIntense]
Bold=false
Color=104,104,104
[Color0]
Bold=false
Color=0,0,0
[Color0Intense]
Bold=false
Color=104,104,104
[Color1]
Bold=false
Color=178,24,24
[Color1Intense]
Bold=false
Color=255,84,84
[Color2]
Bold=false
Color=24,178,24
[Color2Intense]
Bold=false
Color=84,255,84
[Color3]
Bold=false
Color=178,104,24
[Color3Intense]
Bold=false
Color=255,255,84
[Color4]
Bold=false
Color=24,24,178
[Color4Intense]
Bold=false
Color=84,84,255
[Color5]
Bold=false
Color=178,24,178
[Color5Intense]
Bold=false
Color=255,84,255
[Color6]
Bold=false
Color=24,178,178
[Color6Intense]
Bold=false
Color=84,255,255
[Color7]
Bold=false
Color=178,178,178
[Color7Intense]
Bold=false
Color=255,255,255
[Foreground]
Bold=false
Color=178,178,178
[ForegroundIntense]
Bold=false
Color=255,255,255
[General]
Description=Linux Colors

@ -0,0 +1,42 @@
# example scheme for konsole
# the title is to appear in the menu.
title White on Black
# foreground colors
# note that the default background color is flagged
# to become transparent when an image is present.
# slot transparent bold
# | | |
# V V--color--V V V
color 0 255 255 255 0 0 # regular foreground color (White)
color 1 0 0 0 1 0 # regular background color (Black)
color 2 0 0 0 0 0 # regular color 0 Black
color 3 178 24 24 0 0 # regular color 1 Red
color 4 24 178 24 0 0 # regular color 2 Green
color 5 178 104 24 0 0 # regular color 3 Yellow
color 6 24 24 178 0 0 # regular color 4 Blue
color 7 178 24 178 0 0 # regular color 5 Magenta
color 8 24 178 178 0 0 # regular color 6 Cyan
color 9 178 178 178 0 0 # regular color 7 White
# intensive colors
# instead of changing the colors, we've flaged the text to become bold
color 10 255 255 255 0 1 # intensive foreground color
color 11 0 0 0 1 0 # intensive background color
color 12 104 104 104 0 0 # intensive color 0
color 13 255 84 84 0 0 # intensive color 1
color 14 84 255 84 0 0 # intensive color 2
color 15 255 255 84 0 0 # intensive color 3
color 16 84 84 255 0 0 # intensive color 4
color 17 255 84 255 0 0 # intensive color 5
color 18 84 255 255 0 0 # intensive color 6
color 19 255 255 255 0 0 # intensive color 7

@ -0,0 +1,24 @@
<!DOCTYPE RCC>
<RCC version="1.0">
<qresource><file>BlackOnLightYellow.schema</file></qresource>
<qresource><file>BlackOnRandomLight.colorscheme</file></qresource>
<qresource><file>Linux.colorscheme</file></qresource>
<qresource><file>BlackOnWhite.schema</file></qresource>
<qresource><file>DarkPastels.colorscheme</file></qresource>
<qresource><file>GreenOnBlack.colorscheme</file></qresource>
<qresource><file>WhiteOnBlack.schema</file></qresource>
<qresource><file>historic/vim.schema</file></qresource>
<qresource><file>historic/Transparent.schema</file></qresource>
<qresource><file>historic/Transparent_MC.schema</file></qresource>
<qresource><file>historic/Linux.schema</file></qresource>
<qresource><file>historic/Transparent_darkbg.schema</file></qresource>
<qresource><file>historic/GreenTint.schema</file></qresource>
<qresource><file>historic/Transparent_lightbg.schema</file></qresource>
<qresource><file>historic/LightPicture.schema</file></qresource>
<qresource><file>historic/DarkPicture.schema</file></qresource>
<qresource><file>historic/syscolor.schema</file></qresource>
<qresource><file>historic/XTerm.schema</file></qresource>
<qresource><file>historic/BlackOnLightColor.schema</file></qresource>
<qresource><file>historic/GreenTint_MC.schema</file></qresource>
<qresource><file>historic/GreenOnBlack.schema</file></qresource>
</RCC>

@ -0,0 +1,42 @@
# example scheme for konsole
# the title is to appear in the menu.
title Black on Light Color
# foreground colors
# note that the default background color is flagged
# to become transparent when an image is present.
# slot transparent bold
# | | |
# V V--color--V V V
color 0 0 0 0 0 0 # regular foreground color (Black)
rcolor 1 30 255 1 0 # regular background color (Light Color)
color 2 0 0 0 0 0 # regular color 0 Black
color 3 178 24 24 0 0 # regular color 1 Red
color 4 24 178 24 0 0 # regular color 2 Green
color 5 178 104 24 0 0 # regular color 3 Yellow
color 6 24 24 178 0 0 # regular color 4 Blue
color 7 178 24 178 0 0 # regular color 5 Magenta
color 8 24 178 178 0 0 # regular color 6 Cyan
color 9 178 178 178 0 0 # regular color 7 White
# intensive colors
# instead of changing the colors, we've flaged the text to become bold
color 10 0 0 0 0 1 # intensive foreground color
color 11 255 255 221 1 0 # intensive background color
color 12 104 104 104 0 0 # intensive color 0
color 13 255 84 84 0 0 # intensive color 1
color 14 84 255 84 0 0 # intensive color 2
color 15 255 255 84 0 0 # intensive color 3
color 16 84 84 255 0 0 # intensive color 4
color 17 255 84 255 0 0 # intensive color 5
color 18 84 255 255 0 0 # intensive color 6
color 19 255 255 255 0 0 # intensive color 7

@ -0,0 +1,44 @@
# example scheme for konsole
# the title is to appear in the menu.
title Marble
image tile Blkmarble.jpg
# foreground colors
# note that the default background color is flagged
# to become transparent when an image is present.
# slot transparent bold
# | | |
# V V--color--V V V
color 0 255 255 255 0 0 # regular foreground color (White)
color 1 0 0 0 1 0 # regular background color (Black)
color 2 0 0 0 0 0 # regular color 0 Black
color 3 178 24 24 0 0 # regular color 1 Red
color 4 24 178 24 0 0 # regular color 2 Green
color 5 178 104 24 0 0 # regular color 3 Yellow
color 6 24 24 178 0 0 # regular color 4 Blue
color 7 178 24 178 0 0 # regular color 5 Magenta
color 8 24 178 178 0 0 # regular color 6 Cyan
color 9 178 178 178 0 0 # regular color 7 White
# intensive colors
# instead of changing the colors, we've flaged the text to become bold
color 10 255 255 255 0 1 # intensive foreground color
color 11 0 0 0 1 0 # intensive background color
color 12 104 104 104 0 0 # intensive color 0
color 13 255 84 84 0 0 # intensive color 1
color 14 84 255 84 0 0 # intensive color 2
color 15 255 255 84 0 0 # intensive color 3
color 16 84 84 255 0 0 # intensive color 4
color 17 255 84 255 0 0 # intensive color 5
color 18 84 255 255 0 0 # intensive color 6
color 19 255 255 255 0 0 # intensive color 7

@ -0,0 +1,47 @@
# example scheme for konsole
# the title is to appear in the menu.
title Ugly 1
# add a wallpaper, if you like. Second word one of { tile,center,full }
image tile /opt/kde/share/wallpapers/dancy_pants.jpg
# foreground colors
# note that the default background color is flagged
# to become transparent when an image is present.
# slot transparent bold
# | | |
# V V--color--V V V
color 0 0 0 0 0 0 # regular foreground color (Black)
color 1 255 255 255 1 0 # regular background color (White)
color 2 0 0 0 0 0 # regular color 0 Black
color 3 255 0 0 0 0 # regular color 1 Red
color 4 0 255 0 0 0 # regular color 2 Green
color 5 255 255 0 0 0 # regular color 3 Yellow
color 6 0 0 255 0 0 # regular color 4 Blue
color 7 255 0 255 0 0 # regular color 5 Magenta
color 8 0 255 255 0 0 # regular color 6 Cyan
color 9 255 255 255 0 0 # regular color 7 White
# intensive colors
# instead of changing the colors, we've flaged the text to become bold
color 10 0 0 0 0 1 # intensive foreground color
color 11 255 255 255 1 1 # intensive background color
color 12 0 0 0 0 1 # intensive color 0
color 13 255 0 0 0 1 # intensive color 1
color 14 0 255 0 0 1 # intensive color 2
color 15 255 255 0 0 1 # intensive color 3
color 16 0 0 255 0 1 # intensive color 4
color 17 255 0 255 0 1 # intensive color 5
color 18 0 255 255 0 1 # intensive color 6
color 19 255 255 255 0 1 # intensive color 7

@ -0,0 +1,42 @@
# example scheme for konsole
# the title is to appear in the menu.
title Green on Black
# foreground colors
# note that the default background color is flagged
# to become transparent when an image is present.
# slot transparent bold
# | | |
# V V--color--V V V
color 0 24 240 24 0 0 # regular foreground color (Green)
color 1 0 0 0 1 0 # regular background color (Black)
color 2 0 0 0 0 0 # regular color 0 Black
color 3 178 24 24 0 0 # regular color 1 Red
color 4 24 178 24 0 0 # regular color 2 Green
color 5 178 104 24 0 0 # regular color 3 Yellow
color 6 24 24 178 0 0 # regular color 4 Blue
color 7 178 24 178 0 0 # regular color 5 Magenta
color 8 24 178 178 0 0 # regular color 6 Cyan
color 9 178 178 178 0 0 # regular color 7 White
# intensive colors
# instead of changing the colors, we've flaged the text to become bold
color 10 24 240 24 0 1 # intensive foreground color
color 11 0 0 0 1 0 # intensive background color
color 12 104 104 104 0 0 # intensive color 0
color 13 255 84 84 0 0 # intensive color 1
color 14 84 255 84 0 0 # intensive color 2
color 15 255 255 84 0 0 # intensive color 3
color 16 84 84 255 0 0 # intensive color 4
color 17 255 84 255 0 0 # intensive color 5
color 18 84 255 255 0 0 # intensive color 6
color 19 255 255 255 0 0 # intensive color 7

@ -0,0 +1,49 @@
# linux color schema for konsole
title Green Tint
transparency 0.3 0 150 0
# FIXME
#
# The flaw in this schema is that "blick" comes out on the
# Linux console as intensive background, really.
# Since this is not used in clients you'll hardly notice
# it in practice.
# foreground colors
# note that the default background color is flagged
# to become transparent when an image is present.
# slot transparent bold
# | red grn blu | |
# V V--color--V V V
color 0 178 178 178 0 0 # regular foreground color (White)
color 1 0 0 0 1 0 # regular background color (Black)
color 2 0 0 0 0 0 # regular color 0 Black
color 3 178 24 24 0 0 # regular color 1 Red
color 4 24 178 24 0 0 # regular color 2 Green
color 5 178 104 24 0 0 # regular color 3 Yellow
color 6 24 24 178 0 0 # regular color 4 Blue
color 7 178 24 178 0 0 # regular color 5 Magenta
color 8 24 178 178 0 0 # regular color 6 Cyan
color 9 178 178 178 0 0 # regular color 7 White
# intensive colors
# instead of changing the colors, we've flaged the text to become bold
color 10 255 255 255 0 0 # intensive foreground color
color 11 104 104 104 1 0 # intensive background color
color 12 104 104 104 0 0 # intensive color 0
color 13 255 84 84 0 0 # intensive color 1
color 14 84 255 84 0 0 # intensive color 2
color 15 255 255 84 0 0 # intensive color 3
color 16 84 84 255 0 0 # intensive color 4
color 17 255 84 255 0 0 # intensive color 5
color 18 84 255 255 0 0 # intensive color 6
color 19 255 255 255 0 0 # intensive color 7

@ -0,0 +1,49 @@
# linux color schema for konsole
title Green Tint with Transparent MC
transparency 0.3 0 150 0
# FIXME
#
# The flaw in this schema is that "blick" comes out on the
# Linux console as intensive background, really.
# Since this is not used in clients you'll hardly notice
# it in practice.
# foreground colors
# note that the default background color is flagged
# to become transparent when an image is present.
# slot transparent bold
# | red grn blu | |
# V V--color--V V V
color 0 178 178 178 0 0 # regular foreground color (White)
color 1 0 0 0 1 0 # regular background color (Black)
color 2 0 0 0 0 0 # regular color 0 Black
color 3 178 24 24 0 0 # regular color 1 Red
color 4 24 178 24 0 0 # regular color 2 Green
color 5 178 104 24 0 0 # regular color 3 Yellow
color 6 0 0 0 1 0 # regular color 4 Blue
color 7 178 24 178 0 0 # regular color 5 Magenta
color 8 24 178 178 0 0 # regular color 6 Cyan
color 9 178 178 178 0 0 # regular color 7 White
# intensive colors
# instead of changing the colors, we've flaged the text to become bold
color 10 255 255 255 0 0 # intensive foreground color
color 11 104 104 104 1 0 # intensive background color
color 12 104 104 104 0 0 # intensive color 0
color 13 255 84 84 0 0 # intensive color 1
color 14 84 255 84 0 0 # intensive color 2
color 15 255 255 84 0 0 # intensive color 3
color 16 84 84 255 0 0 # intensive color 4
color 17 255 84 255 0 0 # intensive color 5
color 18 84 255 255 0 0 # intensive color 6
color 19 255 255 255 0 0 # intensive color 7

@ -0,0 +1,44 @@
# example scheme for konsole
# the title is to appear in the menu.
title Paper
image tile Paper01.jpg
# foreground colors
# note that the default background color is flagged
# to become transparent when an image is present.
# slot transparent bold
# | | |
# V V--color--V V V
color 0 0 0 0 0 0 # regular foreground color (Black)
color 1 255 255 255 1 0 # regular background color (White)
color 2 0 0 0 0 0 # regular color 0 Black
color 3 178 24 24 0 0 # regular color 1 Red
color 4 24 178 24 0 0 # regular color 2 Green
color 5 178 104 24 0 0 # regular color 3 Yellow
color 6 24 24 178 0 0 # regular color 4 Blue
color 7 178 24 178 0 0 # regular color 5 Magenta
color 8 24 178 178 0 0 # regular color 6 Cyan
color 9 178 178 178 0 0 # regular color 7 White
# intensive colors
# instead of changing the colors, we've flaged the text to become bold
color 10 0 0 0 0 1 # intensive foreground color
color 11 255 255 255 1 0 # intensive background color
color 12 104 104 104 0 0 # intensive color 0
color 13 255 84 84 0 0 # intensive color 1
color 14 84 255 84 0 0 # intensive color 2
color 15 255 255 84 0 0 # intensive color 3
color 16 84 84 255 0 0 # intensive color 4
color 17 255 84 255 0 0 # intensive color 5
color 18 84 255 255 0 0 # intensive color 6
color 19 255 255 255 0 0 # intensive color 7

@ -0,0 +1,47 @@
# linux color schema for konsole
title Linux Colors
# FIXME
#
# The flaw in this schema is that "blick" comes out on the
# Linux console as intensive background, really.
# Since this is not used in clients you'll hardly notice
# it in practice.
# foreground colors
# note that the default background color is flagged
# to become transparent when an image is present.
# slot transparent bold
# | red grn blu | |
# V V--color--V V V
color 0 178 178 178 0 0 # regular foreground color (White)
color 1 0 0 0 1 0 # regular background color (Black)
color 2 0 0 0 0 0 # regular color 0 Black
color 3 178 24 24 0 0 # regular color 1 Red
color 4 24 178 24 0 0 # regular color 2 Green
color 5 178 104 24 0 0 # regular color 3 Yellow
color 6 24 24 178 0 0 # regular color 4 Blue
color 7 178 24 178 0 0 # regular color 5 Magenta
color 8 24 178 178 0 0 # regular color 6 Cyan
color 9 178 178 178 0 0 # regular color 7 White
# intensive colors
# instead of changing the colors, we've flaged the text to become bold
color 10 255 255 255 0 0 # intensive foreground color
color 11 104 104 104 1 0 # intensive background color
color 12 104 104 104 0 0 # intensive color 0
color 13 255 84 84 0 0 # intensive color 1
color 14 84 255 84 0 0 # intensive color 2
color 15 255 255 84 0 0 # intensive color 3
color 16 84 84 255 0 0 # intensive color 4
color 17 255 84 255 0 0 # intensive color 5
color 18 84 255 255 0 0 # intensive color 6
color 19 255 255 255 0 0 # intensive color 7

@ -0,0 +1,132 @@
[README.Schema]
The schemata offered in the Options/Schema menu are
taken from from configurations files with a *.schema
pattern either located in $KDEDIR/share/apps/konsole
or ~/.kde/share/apps/konsole.
Schemata allow to configure the color set that konsole
uses, together with some more information on rendition
processing.
Syntax
File
:: { [Line] ['#' Comment] '\n' }
Line
:: "title" Title
:: "image" Usage PathToPictureFile
:: "transparency" Fade Red Green Blue
:: "color" Slot Red Green Blue Transparent Bold
:: "rcolor" Slot Saturation Value Transparent Bold
:: "sysfg" Slot Transparent Bold
:: "sysbg" Slot Transparent Bold
Meaning
- Title is the text to appear in the Option/Schema menu.
It should be unique among all other schemata therefore.
- The "image" clause allows to place an image on the
konsole's background.
- Usage can be either
- "tile" - the image is tilewise replicated.
- "center" - the image is centered.
- "full" - the image is stretched to fit the window size.
- The Path of the picture can both be relative
(to kde wallpapers) or absolute.
When a schema uses a background image (or transparency)
one has to make at least one color slot transparent to
achive any visible effect. Please read below about the
"Transparent" field in color,sysbg,sysfg.
- The "transparency" clause picks and uses the background
of the desktop as if it where an image together with
a fade effect. This effect will fade the background
to the specified color.
The "Fade" is a real value between 0 and 1, indicating
the strength of the fade. A value of 0 will not change
the image, a value of 1 will make it the fade color
everywhere, and in between. This will make the "glas"
of the window be of the color given in the clause and
being more(1) or less(0) intransparent.
- The remaining clauses (color,sysbg,sysfg) are used
to setup konsoles rendition system.
To this end, konsole offers 20 color slots.
Slot Meaning
----- --------------------------
0 regular foreground color
1 regular background color
2-9 regular bgr color 0-7
10 intensive foreground color
11 intensive background color
12-19 intensive bgr color 0-7
The traditional meaning of the "bgr" color codes
has a bitwise interpretation of an additive three
primary color scheme inherited from early EGA
color terminals.
Color Bits Colors
----- ---- -------
0 000 Black
1 001 Red
2 010 Green
3 011 Yellow
4 100 Blue
5 101 Magenta
6 110 Cyan
7 111 White
One may or may not stick to this tradition.
Konsole allows to assign colors freely to slots.
The slots fall apart into two groups, regular
and intensive colors. The later are used when
BOLD rendition is used by the client.
Each of the groups have a default fore- and
background color and the said bgr colors.
Normal terminal processing will simply use
the default colors.
The color desired for a slot is indicated
in the Red Green Blue fields of the color
clause. Use the sysfg or the sysbg clause
to indicate the default fore and background
colors of the desktop.
To specify randomized color for a slot use
the clause rcolor. The two parameters to it
being Saturation - the amount of colour,
and Value, the darkness of the colour.
To use transparency/images and to simulate
the behavior of the xterm, one can supply
two additional tags to each slot:
- Transparent (0/1) meaning to show the
background picture, if any.
- Bold (0/1) to render characters bold.
If you know about the escape codes, you might have
noticed that intensive and bold rendition are sort
of confused. This is inherited by the xterm which
konsole is simulating.
One can use the colortest.sh script supplied
with the konsole source distribution to test
a schema.
The schema installed with konsole are more or
less demonstrations and not really beauty,
beside the Linux.schema, perhaps, which is
made after the VGA colors.

@ -0,0 +1,44 @@
# default scheme for konsole (only here for documentation purposes)
# the title is to appear in the menu.
title Konsole Defaults
# image tile /opt/kde/share/wallpapers/gray2.jpg
# foreground colors
# note that the default background color is flagged
# to become transparent when an image is present.
# slot transparent bold
# | | |
# V V--color--V V V
color 0 0 0 0 0 0 # regular foreground color (Black)
color 1 255 255 255 1 0 # regular background color (White)
color 2 0 0 0 0 0 # regular color 0 Black
color 3 178 24 24 0 0 # regular color 1 Red
color 4 24 178 24 0 0 # regular color 2 Green
color 5 178 104 24 0 0 # regular color 3 Yellow
color 6 24 24 178 0 0 # regular color 4 Blue
color 7 178 24 178 0 0 # regular color 5 Magenta
color 8 24 178 178 0 0 # regular color 6 Cyan
color 9 178 178 178 0 0 # regular color 7 White
# intensive colors
# instead of changing the colors, we've flaged the text to become bold
color 10 0 0 0 0 1 # intensive foreground color
color 11 255 255 255 1 0 # intensive background color
color 12 104 104 104 0 0 # intensive color 0
color 13 255 84 84 0 0 # intensive color 1
color 14 84 255 84 0 0 # intensive color 2
color 15 255 255 84 0 0 # intensive color 3
color 16 84 84 255 0 0 # intensive color 4
color 17 255 84 255 0 0 # intensive color 5
color 18 84 255 255 0 0 # intensive color 6
color 19 255 255 255 0 0 # intensive color 7

@ -0,0 +1,49 @@
# linux color schema for konsole
title Transparent Konsole
transparency 0.35 0 0 0
# FIXME
#
# The flaw in this schema is that "blick" comes out on the
# Linux console as intensive background, really.
# Since this is not used in clients you'll hardly notice
# it in practice.
# foreground colors
# note that the default background color is flagged
# to become transparent when an image is present.
# slot transparent bold
# | red grn blu | |
# V V--color--V V V
color 0 178 178 178 0 0 # regular foreground color (White)
color 1 0 0 0 1 0 # regular background color (Black)
color 2 0 0 0 0 0 # regular color 0 Black
color 3 178 24 24 0 0 # regular color 1 Red
color 4 24 178 24 0 0 # regular color 2 Green
color 5 178 104 24 0 0 # regular color 3 Yellow
color 6 24 24 178 0 0 # regular color 4 Blue
color 7 178 24 178 0 0 # regular color 5 Magenta
color 8 24 178 178 0 0 # regular color 6 Cyan
color 9 178 178 178 0 0 # regular color 7 White
# intensive colors
# instead of changing the colors, we've flaged the text to become bold
color 10 255 255 255 0 0 # intensive foreground color
color 11 104 104 104 1 0 # intensive background color
color 12 104 104 104 0 0 # intensive color 0
color 13 255 84 84 0 0 # intensive color 1
color 14 84 255 84 0 0 # intensive color 2
color 15 255 255 84 0 0 # intensive color 3
color 16 84 84 255 0 0 # intensive color 4
color 17 255 84 255 0 0 # intensive color 5
color 18 84 255 255 0 0 # intensive color 6
color 19 255 255 255 0 0 # intensive color 7

@ -0,0 +1,51 @@
# linux color schema for konsole
title Transparent for MC
transparency 0.35 0 0 0
# FIXME
#
# The flaw in this schema is that "blick" comes out on the
# Linux console as intensive background, really.
# Since this is not used in clients you'll hardly notice
# it in practice.
# foreground colors
# note that the default background color is flagged
# to become transparent when an image is present.
# slot transparent bold
# | red grn blu | |
# V V--color--V V V
color 0 178 178 178 0 0 # regular foreground color (White)
color 1 0 0 0 1 0 # regular background color (Black)
color 2 0 0 0 0 0 # regular color 0 Black
color 3 178 24 24 0 0 # regular color 1 Red
color 4 24 178 24 0 0 # regular color 2 Green
color 5 178 104 24 0 0 # regular color 3 Yellow
#color 6 24 24 178 0 0 # regular color 4 Blue
color 6 0 0 0 1 0 # regular color 4 Blue
color 7 178 24 178 0 0 # regular color 5 Magenta
color 8 24 178 178 0 0 # regular color 6 Cyan
color 9 178 178 178 0 0 # regular color 7 White
# intensive colors
# instead of changing the colors, we've flaged the text to become bold
color 10 255 255 255 0 0 # intensive foreground color
color 11 104 104 104 1 0 # intensive background color
color 12 104 104 104 0 0 # intensive color 0
color 13 255 84 84 0 0 # intensive color 1
color 14 84 255 84 0 0 # intensive color 2
color 15 255 255 84 0 0 # intensive color 3
color 16 84 84 255 0 0 # intensive color 4
color 17 255 84 255 0 0 # intensive color 5
color 18 84 255 255 0 0 # intensive color 6
color 19 255 255 255 0 0 # intensive color 7

@ -0,0 +1,42 @@
# linux color schema for konsole
title Transparent, Dark Background
transparency 0.75 0 0 0
# foreground colors
# note that the default background color is flagged
# to become transparent when an image is present.
# slot transparent bold
# | red grn blu | |
# V V--color--V V V
color 0 255 255 255 0 0 # regular foreground color (White)
color 1 0 0 0 1 0 # regular background color (Black)
color 2 0 0 0 0 0 # regular color 0 Black
color 3 178 24 24 0 0 # regular color 1 Red
color 4 24 178 24 0 0 # regular color 2 Green
color 5 178 104 24 0 0 # regular color 3 Yellow
color 6 24 24 178 0 0 # regular color 4 Blue
color 7 178 24 178 0 0 # regular color 5 Magenta
color 8 24 178 178 0 0 # regular color 6 Cyan
color 9 178 178 178 0 0 # regular color 7 White
# intensive colors
# instead of changing the colors, we've flaged the text to become bold
color 10 255 255 255 0 0 # intensive foreground color
color 11 104 104 104 1 0 # intensive background color
color 12 104 104 104 0 0 # intensive color 0
color 13 255 84 84 0 0 # intensive color 1
color 14 84 255 84 0 0 # intensive color 2
color 15 255 255 84 0 0 # intensive color 3
color 16 84 84 255 0 0 # intensive color 4
color 17 255 84 255 0 0 # intensive color 5
color 18 84 255 255 0 0 # intensive color 6
color 19 255 255 255 0 0 # intensive color 7

@ -0,0 +1,51 @@
# linux color schema for konsole
title Transparent, Light Background
transparency 0.1 0 0 0
# This is a schema for very light backgrounds. It makes some
# hacks about the colors to make Midnight Commander transparent
# and with suitable colors.
# foreground colors
# note that the default background color is flagged
# to become transparent when an image is present.
# slot transparent bold
# | red grn blu | |
# V V--color--V V V
color 0 50 50 50 0 0 # regular foreground color (DarkGray)
color 1 200 200 200 1 0 # regular background color (White)
# color 2 0 0 0 0 0 # regular color 0 Black
color 2 200 200 200 1 0 # regular background color (White)
color 3 178 24 24 0 0 # regular color 1 Red
color 4 24 178 24 0 0 # regular color 2 Green
color 5 178 104 24 0 0 # regular color 3 Yellow
#color 6 24 24 178 0 0 # regular color 4 Blue
color 6 0 0 0 1 0 # regular color 4 Blue
# Blue is transparent, to make MC transparent
color 7 178 24 178 0 0 # regular color 5 Magenta
color 8 24 178 178 0 0 # regular color 6 Cyan
# color 9 178 178 178 0 0 # regular color 7 White
color 9 50 50 50 0 0 # regular foreground color (DarkGray)
# intensive colors
# instead of changing the colors, we've flaged the text to become bold
color 10 0 0 0 0 0 # intensive foreground color
color 11 255 255 255 1 0 # intensive background color
color 12 104 104 104 0 0 # intensive color 0
color 13 255 84 84 0 0 # intensive color 1
color 14 84 255 84 0 0 # intensive color 2
color 15 255 255 84 0 0 # intensive color 3
color 16 84 84 255 0 0 # intensive color 4
color 17 255 84 255 0 0 # intensive color 5
color 18 84 255 255 0 0 # intensive color 6
color 19 255 255 255 0 0 # intensive color 7

@ -0,0 +1,46 @@
# xterm color schema for konsole
# xterm colors can be configured (almost) like
# konsole colors can. This is the uncustomized
# xterm schema.
# Please refere to your local xterm setup files
# if this schema differs.
title XTerm Colors
# foreground colors -------------------------------
# note that the default background color is flagged
# to become transparent when an image is present.
# slot transparent bold
# | red grn blu | |
# V V--color--V V V
color 0 0 0 0 0 0 # regular foreground color (Black)
color 1 255 255 255 1 0 # regular background color (White)
color 2 0 0 0 0 0 # regular color 0 Black
color 3 205 0 0 0 0 # regular color 1 Red
color 4 0 205 0 0 0 # regular color 2 Green
color 5 205 205 0 0 0 # regular color 3 Yellow
color 6 0 0 205 0 0 # regular color 4 Blue
color 7 205 0 205 0 0 # regular color 5 Magenta
color 8 0 205 205 0 0 # regular color 6 Cyan
color 9 229 229 229 0 0 # regular color 7 White
# intensive colors -------------------------------------------
# for some strange reason, intensive colors are bold, also.
color 10 77 77 77 0 1 # intensive foreground color
color 11 255 255 255 1 1 # intensive background color
color 12 77 77 77 0 1 # intensive color 0
color 13 255 0 0 0 1 # intensive color 1
color 14 0 255 0 0 1 # intensive color 2
color 15 255 255 0 0 1 # intensive color 3
color 16 0 0 255 0 1 # intensive color 4
color 17 255 0 255 0 1 # intensive color 5
color 18 0 255 255 0 1 # intensive color 6
color 19 255 255 255 0 1 # intensive color 7

@ -0,0 +1,44 @@
# schema that uses system colors
# the title is to appear in the menu.
title System Colors
# image none
# foreground colors
# note that the default background color is flagged
# to become transparent when an image is present.
# slot transparent bold
# | | |
# V V--color--V V V
sysfg 0 0 0 # regular foreground color (system)
sysbg 1 1 0 # regular background color (system)
color 2 0 0 0 0 0 # regular color 0 Black
color 3 178 24 24 0 0 # regular color 1 Red
color 4 24 178 24 0 0 # regular color 2 Green
color 5 178 104 24 0 0 # regular color 3 Yellow
color 6 24 24 178 0 0 # regular color 4 Blue
color 7 178 24 178 0 0 # regular color 5 Magenta
color 8 24 178 178 0 0 # regular color 6 Cyan
color 9 178 178 178 0 0 # regular color 7 White
# intensive colors
# instead of changing the colors, we've flaged the text to become bold
color 10 0 0 0 0 1 # intensive foreground color
color 11 255 255 255 1 0 # intensive background color
color 12 104 104 104 0 0 # intensive color 0
color 13 255 84 84 0 0 # intensive color 1
color 14 84 255 84 0 0 # intensive color 2
color 15 255 255 84 0 0 # intensive color 3
color 16 84 84 255 0 0 # intensive color 4
color 17 255 84 255 0 0 # intensive color 5
color 18 84 255 255 0 0 # intensive color 6
color 19 255 255 255 0 0 # intensive color 7

@ -0,0 +1,40 @@
# VIM-recommended color schema for konsole
# VIM (VI improved) in "help xiterm" recommends these colors for xterm.
title VIM Colors
# foreground colors -------------------------------
# note that the default background color is flagged
# to become transparent when an image is present.
# slot transparent bold
# | red grn blu | |
# V V--color--V V V
color 0 0 0 0 0 0 # regular foreground color (Black)
color 1 255 255 255 1 0 # regular background color (White)
color 2 0 0 0 0 0 # regular color 0 Black
color 3 192 0 0 0 0 # regular color 1 Red
color 4 0 128 0 0 0 # regular color 2 Green
color 5 128 128 0 0 0 # regular color 3 Yellow
color 6 0 0 192 0 0 # regular color 4 Blue
color 7 192 0 192 0 0 # regular color 5 Magenta
color 8 0 128 128 0 0 # regular color 6 Cyan
color 9 192 192 192 0 0 # regular color 7 White
# intensive colors -------------------------------------------
color 10 77 77 77 0 1 # intensive foreground color
color 11 255 255 255 1 1 # intensive background color
color 12 128 128 128 0 0 # intensive color 0
color 13 255 96 96 0 0 # intensive color 1
color 14 0 255 0 0 0 # intensive color 2
color 15 255 255 0 0 0 # intensive color 3
color 16 128 128 255 0 0 # intensive color 4
color 17 255 64 255 0 0 # intensive color 5
color 18 0 255 255 0 0 # intensive color 6
color 19 255 255 255 0 0 # intensive color 7

@ -0,0 +1,128 @@
# [README.default.Keytab] Buildin Keyboard Table
#
# To customize your keyboard, copy this file to something
# ending with .keytab and change it to meet you needs.
# Please read the README.KeyTab and the README.keyboard
# in this case.
#
# --------------------------------------------------------------
keyboard "Default (XFree 4)"
# --------------------------------------------------------------
#
# Note that this particular table is a "risc" version made to
# ease customization without bothering with obsolete details.
# See VT100.keytab for the more hairy stuff.
#
# --------------------------------------------------------------
# common keys
key Escape : "\E"
key Tab -Shift : "\t"
key Tab +Shift+Ansi : "\E[Z"
key Tab +Shift-Ansi : "\t"
key Backtab +Ansi : "\E[Z"
key Backtab -Ansi : "\t"
key Return-Shift-NewLine : "\r"
key Return-Shift+NewLine : "\r\n"
key Return+Shift : "\EOM"
# Backspace and Delete codes are preserving CTRL-H.
key Backspace : "\x7f"
# Arrow keys in VT52 mode
# shift up/down are reserved for scrolling.
# shift left/right are reserved for switching between tabs (this is hardcoded).
key Up -Shift-Ansi : "\EA"
key Down -Shift-Ansi : "\EB"
key Right-Shift-Ansi : "\EC"
key Left -Shift-Ansi : "\ED"
# Arrow keys in ANSI mode with Application - and Normal Cursor Mode)
key Up -Shift-AnyMod+Ansi+AppCuKeys : "\EOA"
key Down -Shift-AnyMod+Ansi+AppCuKeys : "\EOB"
key Right -Shift-AnyMod+Ansi+AppCuKeys : "\EOC"
key Left -Shift-AnyMod+Ansi+AppCuKeys : "\EOD"
key Up -Shift-AnyMod+Ansi-AppCuKeys : "\E[A"
key Down -Shift-AnyMod+Ansi-AppCuKeys : "\E[B"
key Right -Shift-AnyMod+Ansi-AppCuKeys : "\E[C"
key Left -Shift-AnyMod+Ansi-AppCuKeys : "\E[D"
key Up -Shift+AnyMod+Ansi : "\E[1;*A"
key Down -Shift+AnyMod+Ansi : "\E[1;*B"
key Right -Shift+AnyMod+Ansi : "\E[1;*C"
key Left -Shift+AnyMod+Ansi : "\E[1;*D"
# other grey PC keys
key Enter+NewLine : "\r\n"
key Enter-NewLine : "\r"
key Home -AnyMod -AppCuKeys : "\E[H"
key End -AnyMod -AppCuKeys : "\E[F"
key Home -AnyMod +AppCuKeys : "\EOH"
key End -AnyMod +AppCuKeys : "\EOF"
key Home +AnyMod : "\E[1;*H"
key End +AnyMod : "\E[1;*F"
key Insert -AnyMod : "\E[2~"
key Delete -AnyMod : "\E[3~"
key Insert +AnyMod : "\E[2;*~"
key Delete +AnyMod : "\E[3;*~"
key Prior -Shift-AnyMod : "\E[5~"
key Next -Shift-AnyMod : "\E[6~"
key Prior -Shift+AnyMod : "\E[5;*~"
key Next -Shift+AnyMod : "\E[6;*~"
# Function keys
key F1 -AnyMod : "\EOP"
key F2 -AnyMod : "\EOQ"
key F3 -AnyMod : "\EOR"
key F4 -AnyMod : "\EOS"
key F5 -AnyMod : "\E[15~"
key F6 -AnyMod : "\E[17~"
key F7 -AnyMod : "\E[18~"
key F8 -AnyMod : "\E[19~"
key F9 -AnyMod : "\E[20~"
key F10 -AnyMod : "\E[21~"
key F11 -AnyMod : "\E[23~"
key F12 -AnyMod : "\E[24~"
key F1 +AnyMod : "\EO*P"
key F2 +AnyMod : "\EO*Q"
key F3 +AnyMod : "\EO*R"
key F4 +AnyMod : "\EO*S"
key F5 +AnyMod : "\E[15;*~"
key F6 +AnyMod : "\E[17;*~"
key F7 +AnyMod : "\E[18;*~"
key F8 +AnyMod : "\E[19;*~"
key F9 +AnyMod : "\E[20;*~"
key F10 +AnyMod : "\E[21;*~"
key F11 +AnyMod : "\E[23;*~"
key F12 +AnyMod : "\E[24;*~"
# Work around dead keys
key Space +Control : "\x00"
# Some keys are used by konsole to cause operations.
# The scroll* operations refer to the history buffer.
key Up +Shift-AppScreen : scrollLineUp
key Prior +Shift-AppScreen : scrollPageUp
key Down +Shift-AppScreen : scrollLineDown
key Next +Shift-AppScreen : scrollPageDown
key ScrollLock : scrollLock
# keypad characters are not offered differently by Qt.

Binary file not shown.

After

Width:  |  Height:  |  Size: 2.2 KiB

@ -0,0 +1,102 @@
#include "qtermwidgetplugin.h"
#include <QtPlugin>
#include "qtermwidget.h"
QTermWidgetPlugin::QTermWidgetPlugin(QObject *parent)
: QObject(parent), initialized(false)
{
Q_INIT_RESOURCE(qtermwidgetplugin);
}
QTermWidgetPlugin::~QTermWidgetPlugin()
{
}
void QTermWidgetPlugin::initialize(QDesignerFormEditorInterface * /* core */)
{
initialized = true;
}
bool QTermWidgetPlugin::isInitialized() const
{
return initialized;
}
QWidget *QTermWidgetPlugin::createWidget(QWidget *parent)
{
return new QTermWidget(0, parent);
}
QString QTermWidgetPlugin::name() const
{
return "QTermWidget";
}
QString QTermWidgetPlugin::group() const
{
return "Input Widgets";
}
QIcon QTermWidgetPlugin::icon() const
{
return QIcon(":qtermwidget.png");
}
QString QTermWidgetPlugin::toolTip() const
{
return "QTermWidget component/widget";
}
QString QTermWidgetPlugin::whatsThis() const
{
return "Qt based terminal emulator";
}
bool QTermWidgetPlugin::isContainer() const
{
return false;
}
QString QTermWidgetPlugin::domXml() const
{
return "<widget class=\"QTermWidget\" name=\"termWidget\">\n"
" <property name=\"geometry\">\n"
" <rect>\n"
" <x>0</x>\n"
" <y>0</y>\n"
" <width>400</width>\n"
" <height>200</height>\n"
" </rect>\n"
" </property>\n"
" <property name=\"toolTip\" >\n"
" <string></string>\n"
" </property>\n"
" <property name=\"whatsThis\" >\n"
" <string></string>\n"
" </property>\n"
"</widget>\n";
}
QString QTermWidgetPlugin::includeFile() const
{
return "qtermwidget.h";
}
Q_EXPORT_PLUGIN2(QTermWidgetPlugin, QTermWidgetPlugin)

@ -0,0 +1,33 @@
#ifndef QTERMWIDGETPLUGIN_H
#define QTERMWIDGETPLUGIN_H
#include <QDesignerCustomWidgetInterface>
class QTermWidgetPlugin : public QObject, public QDesignerCustomWidgetInterface
{
Q_OBJECT
Q_INTERFACES(QDesignerCustomWidgetInterface)
public:
QTermWidgetPlugin(QObject *parent = 0);
virtual ~QTermWidgetPlugin();
bool isContainer() const;
bool isInitialized() const;
QIcon icon() const;
QString domXml() const;
QString group() const;
QString includeFile() const;
QString name() const;
QString toolTip() const;
QString whatsThis() const;
QWidget *createWidget(QWidget *parent);
void initialize(QDesignerFormEditorInterface *core);
private:
bool initialized;
};
#endif

@ -0,0 +1,6 @@
<!DOCTYPE RCC>
<RCC version="1.0">
<qresource>
<file>qtermwidget.png</file>
</qresource>
</RCC>

@ -0,0 +1,72 @@
[README.KeyTab]
The keytabs offered in the Options/Keyboard menu are
taken from from configurations files with a *.keytab
pattern either located in $KDEDIR/share/apps/konsole
or ~/.kde/share/apps/konsole.
Keytabs allow to configure the behavior of konsole
on keyboard events, especially for functions keys.
Please have a look into the README.keyboard file, too.
The syntax is that each entry has the form :
"key" Keyname { ("+"|"-") Modename } ":" (String|Operation)
Keynames are those defined in <qnamespace.h> with the
"Qt::Key_" prefix removed.
Mode names are:
- Shift : Shift Key pressed
- Alt : Alt Key pressed
- Control : Control Key pressed
( The VT100 emulation has modes that can affect the
sequences emitted by certain keys. These modes are
under control of the client program.
- Newline : effects Return and Enter key.
- Application : effects Up and Down key.
- Ansi : effects Up and Down key (This is for VT52, really).
Since sending a state to a program that has set the state
itself is positivly wrong and obsolete design, better forget
about this nasty detail. I may well remove this "feature"
in a future clean up round. )
A "+" preceeding a Modename means the Key is pressed.
A "-" preceeding a Modename means the Key is not pressed.
If no mode is given it means don't care.
Note that the combination of Key and Modes (set/reset)
has to be unique. This means, that
key A + Shift : "A"
key A : "a"
will not accept the small letter "a" rule as expected,
one has to add a "- Shift" to the last clause. Use
the stdout/stderr dianostics of konsole when modifying
keytabs to find problems like this.
Operations are
- scrollUpLine : scroll up one line in the history log
- scrollUpPage : scroll up one page in the history log
- scrollDownLine : scroll down one line in the history log
- scrollDownPage : scroll down one page in the history log
- emitClipboard : "paste" the current clipboard
- emitSelection : "paste" the current selection
Strings have the syntax of C strings,
one may use the following escapes:
- \E - escape
- \\ - backslash
- \" - double quote
- \t - tab
- \r - return
- \n - newline
- \b - backspace
- \xHH - where HH are two hex digits

@ -0,0 +1,169 @@
# [README.default.Keytab] Default Keyboard Table
#
# To customize your keyboard, copy this file to something
# ending with .keytab and change it to meet you needs.
# Please read the README.KeyTab and the README.keyboard
# in this case.
#
# --------------------------------------------------------------
keyboard "Default (XFree 4)"
# --------------------------------------------------------------
#
# Note that this particular table is a "risc" version made to
# ease customization without bothering with obsolete details.
# See VT100.keytab for the more hairy stuff.
#
# --------------------------------------------------------------
# common keys
key Escape : "\E"
key Tab -Shift : "\t"
key Tab +Shift+Ansi : "\E[Z"
key Tab +Shift-Ansi : "\t"
key Backtab +Ansi : "\E[Z"
key Backtab -Ansi : "\t"
key Return-Shift-NewLine : "\r"
key Return-Shift+NewLine : "\r\n"
key Return+Shift : "\EOM"
# Backspace and Delete codes are preserving CTRL-H.
key Backspace : "\x7f"
# Arrow keys in VT52 mode
# shift up/down are reserved for scrolling.
# shift left/right are reserved for switching between tabs (this is hardcoded).
key Up -Shift-Ansi : "\EA"
key Down -Shift-Ansi : "\EB"
key Right-Shift-Ansi : "\EC"
key Left -Shift-Ansi : "\ED"
# Arrow keys in ANSI mode with Application - and Normal Cursor Mode)
key Up -Shift-AnyMod+Ansi+AppCuKeys : "\EOA"
key Down -Shift-AnyMod+Ansi+AppCuKeys : "\EOB"
key Right -Shift-AnyMod+Ansi+AppCuKeys : "\EOC"
key Left -Shift-AnyMod+Ansi+AppCuKeys : "\EOD"
key Up -Shift-AnyMod+Ansi-AppCuKeys : "\E[A"
key Down -Shift-AnyMod+Ansi-AppCuKeys : "\E[B"
key Right -Shift-AnyMod+Ansi-AppCuKeys : "\E[C"
key Left -Shift-AnyMod+Ansi-AppCuKeys : "\E[D"
key Up -Shift+AnyMod+Ansi : "\E[1;*A"
key Down -Shift+AnyMod+Ansi : "\E[1;*B"
key Right -Shift+AnyMod+Ansi : "\E[1;*C"
key Left -Shift+AnyMod+Ansi : "\E[1;*D"
# Keypad keys with NumLock ON
# (see "Numeric Keypad" section at http://www.nw.com/nw/WWW/products/wizcon/vt100.html )
#
# Not enabled for now because it breaks the keypad in Vim.
#
#key 0 +KeyPad+AppKeyPad : "\EOp"
#key 1 +KeyPad+AppKeyPad : "\EOq"
#key 2 +KeyPad+AppKeyPad : "\EOr"
#key 3 +KeyPad+AppKeyPad : "\EOs"
#key 4 +KeyPad+AppKeyPad : "\EOt"
#key 5 +KeyPad+AppKeyPad : "\EOu"
#key 6 +KeyPad+AppKeyPad : "\EOv"
#key 7 +KeyPad+AppKeyPad : "\EOw"
#key 8 +KeyPad+AppKeyPad : "\EOx"
#key 9 +KeyPad+AppKeyPad : "\EOy"
#key + +KeyPad+AppKeyPad : "\EOl"
#key - +KeyPad+AppKeyPad : "\EOm"
#key . +KeyPad+AppKeyPad : "\EOn"
#key * +KeyPad+AppKeyPad : "\EOM"
#key Enter +KeyPad+AppKeyPad : "\r"
# Keypad keys with NumLock Off
key Up -Shift+Ansi+AppCuKeys+KeyPad : "\EOA"
key Down -Shift+Ansi+AppCuKeys+KeyPad : "\EOB"
key Right -Shift+Ansi+AppCuKeys+KeyPad : "\EOC"
key Left -Shift+Ansi+AppCuKeys+KeyPad : "\EOD"
key Up -Shift+Ansi-AppCuKeys+KeyPad : "\E[A"
key Down -Shift+Ansi-AppCuKeys+KeyPad : "\E[B"
key Right -Shift+Ansi-AppCuKeys+KeyPad : "\E[C"
key Left -Shift+Ansi-AppCuKeys+KeyPad : "\E[D"
key Home +AppCuKeys+KeyPad : "\EOH"
key End +AppCuKeys+KeyPad : "\EOF"
key Home -AppCuKeys+KeyPad : "\E[H"
key End -AppCuKeys+KeyPad : "\E[F"
key Insert +KeyPad : "\E[2~"
key Delete +KeyPad : "\E[3~"
key Prior -Shift+KeyPad : "\E[5~"
key Next -Shift+KeyPad : "\E[6~"
# other grey PC keys
key Enter+NewLine : "\r\n"
key Enter-NewLine : "\r"
key Home -AnyMod-AppCuKeys : "\E[H"
key End -AnyMod-AppCuKeys : "\E[F"
key Home -AnyMod+AppCuKeys : "\EOH"
key End -AnyMod+AppCuKeys : "\EOF"
key Home +AnyMod : "\E[1;*H"
key End +AnyMod : "\E[1;*F"
key Insert -AnyMod : "\E[2~"
key Delete -AnyMod : "\E[3~"
key Insert +AnyMod : "\E[2;*~"
key Delete +AnyMod : "\E[3;*~"
key Prior -Shift-AnyMod : "\E[5~"
key Next -Shift-AnyMod : "\E[6~"
key Prior -Shift+AnyMod : "\E[5;*~"
key Next -Shift+AnyMod : "\E[6;*~"
# Function keys
key F1 -AnyMod : "\EOP"
key F2 -AnyMod : "\EOQ"
key F3 -AnyMod : "\EOR"
key F4 -AnyMod : "\EOS"
key F5 -AnyMod : "\E[15~"
key F6 -AnyMod : "\E[17~"
key F7 -AnyMod : "\E[18~"
key F8 -AnyMod : "\E[19~"
key F9 -AnyMod : "\E[20~"
key F10 -AnyMod : "\E[21~"
key F11 -AnyMod : "\E[23~"
key F12 -AnyMod : "\E[24~"
key F1 +AnyMod : "\EO*P"
key F2 +AnyMod : "\EO*Q"
key F3 +AnyMod : "\EO*R"
key F4 +AnyMod : "\EO*S"
key F5 +AnyMod : "\E[15;*~"
key F6 +AnyMod : "\E[17;*~"
key F7 +AnyMod : "\E[18;*~"
key F8 +AnyMod : "\E[19;*~"
key F9 +AnyMod : "\E[20;*~"
key F10 +AnyMod : "\E[21;*~"
key F11 +AnyMod : "\E[23;*~"
key F12 +AnyMod : "\E[24;*~"
# Work around dead keys
key Space +Control : "\x00"
# Some keys are used by konsole to cause operations.
# The scroll* operations refer to the history buffer.
key Up +Shift-AppScreen : scrollLineUp
key Prior +Shift-AppScreen : scrollPageUp
key Down +Shift-AppScreen : scrollLineDown
key Next +Shift-AppScreen : scrollPageDown
key ScrollLock : scrollLock

@ -0,0 +1,133 @@
# [vt100.keytab] Konsole Keyboard Table (VT100 keys)
#
# --------------------------------------------------------------
keyboard "vt100 (historical)"
# --------------------------------------------------------------
#
# This configuration table allows to customize the
# meaning of the keys.
#
# The syntax is that each entry has the form :
#
# "key" Keyname { ("+"|"-") Modename } ":" (String|Operation)
#
# Keynames are those defined in <qnamespace.h> with the
# "Qt::Key_" removed. (We'd better insert the list here)
#
# Mode names are :
#
# - Shift
# - Alt
# - Control
#
# The VT100 emulation has two modes that can affect the
# sequences emitted by certain keys. These modes are
# under control of the client program.
#
# - Newline : effects Return and Enter key.
# - Application : effects Up and Down key.
#
# - Ansi : effects Up and Down key (This is for VT52, really).
#
# Operations are
#
# - scrollUpLine
# - scrollUpPage
# - scrollDownLine
# - scrollDownPage
#
# - emitSelection
#
# If the key is not found here, the text of the
# key event as provided by QT is emitted, possibly
# preceeded by ESC if the Alt key is pressed.
#
# --------------------------------------------------------------
key Escape : "\E"
key Tab : "\t"
# VT100 can add an extra \n after return.
# The NewLine mode is set by an escape sequence.
key Return-NewLine : "\r"
key Return+NewLine : "\r\n"
# Some desperately try to save the ^H.
key Backspace : "\x7f"
key Delete : "\E[3~"
# These codes are for the VT52 mode of VT100
# The Ansi mode (i.e. VT100 mode) is set by
# an escape sequence
key Up -Shift-Ansi : "\EA"
key Down -Shift-Ansi : "\EB"
key Right-Shift-Ansi : "\EC"
key Left -Shift-Ansi : "\ED"
# VT100 emits a mode bit together
# with the arrow keys.The AppCuKeys
# mode is set by an escape sequence.
key Up -Shift+Ansi+AppCuKeys : "\EOA"
key Down -Shift+Ansi+AppCuKeys : "\EOB"
key Right-Shift+Ansi+AppCuKeys : "\EOC"
key Left -Shift+Ansi+AppCuKeys : "\EOD"
key Up -Shift+Ansi-AppCuKeys : "\E[A"
key Down -Shift+Ansi-AppCuKeys : "\E[B"
key Right-Shift+Ansi-AppCuKeys : "\E[C"
key Left -Shift+Ansi-AppCuKeys : "\E[D"
# function keys (FIXME: make pf1-pf4)
key F1 : "\E[11~"
key F2 : "\E[12~"
key F3 : "\E[13~"
key F4 : "\E[14~"
key F5 : "\E[15~"
key F6 : "\E[17~"
key F7 : "\E[18~"
key F8 : "\E[19~"
key F9 : "\E[20~"
key F10 : "\E[21~"
key F11 : "\E[23~"
key F12 : "\E[24~"
key Home : "\E[H"
key End : "\E[F"
key Prior -Shift : "\E[5~"
key Next -Shift : "\E[6~"
key Insert-Shift : "\E[2~"
# Keypad-Enter. See comment on Return above.
key Enter+NewLine : "\r\n"
key Enter-NewLine : "\r"
key Space +Control : "\x00"
# some of keys are used by konsole.
key Up +Shift : scrollLineUp
key Prior +Shift : scrollPageUp
key Down +Shift : scrollLineDown
key Next +Shift : scrollPageDown
key ScrollLock : scrollLock
#----------------------------------------------------------
# keypad characters as offered by Qt
# cannot be recognized as such.
#----------------------------------------------------------
# Following other strings as emitted by konsole.

@ -0,0 +1,71 @@
# [x11r5.Keytab] Keyboard Table for X11 R5
keyboard "XTerm (XFree 3.x.x)"
# --------------------------------------------------------------
#
# Note that this particular table is a "risc" version made to
# ease customization without bothering with obsolete details.
# See VT100.keytab for the more hairy stuff.
#
# --------------------------------------------------------------
# common keys
key Escape : "\E"
key Tab : "\t"
key Return : "\r"
# Backspace and Delete codes are preserving CTRL-H.
key Backspace : "\x7f"
# cursor keys
key Up -Shift : "\EOA"
key Down -Shift : "\EOB"
key Right -Shift : "\EOC"
key Left -Shift : "\EOD"
# other grey PC keys
key Enter : "\r"
key Home : "\E[1~"
key Insert-Shift : "\E[2~"
key Delete : "\E[3~"
key End : "\E[4~"
key Prior -Shift : "\E[5~"
key Next -Shift : "\E[6~"
# function keys
key F1 : "\E[11~"
key F2 : "\E[12~"
key F3 : "\E[13~"
key F4 : "\E[14~"
key F5 : "\E[15~"
key F6 : "\E[17~"
key F7 : "\E[18~"
key F8 : "\E[19~"
key F9 : "\E[20~"
key F10 : "\E[21~"
key F11 : "\E[23~"
key F12 : "\E[24~"
# Work around dead keys
key Space +Control : "\x00"
# Some keys are used by konsole to cause operations.
# The scroll* operations refer to the history buffer.
key Up +Shift : scrollLineUp
key Prior +Shift : scrollPageUp
key Down +Shift : scrollLineDown
key Next +Shift : scrollPageDown
key ScrollLock : scrollLock
# keypad characters are not offered differently by Qt.

@ -0,0 +1,10 @@
<!DOCTYPE RCC>
<RCC version="1.0">
<qresource><file>linux.keytab</file></qresource>
<qresource><file>solaris.keytab</file></qresource>
<qresource><file>macbook.keytab</file></qresource>
<qresource><file>default.keytab</file></qresource>
<qresource><file>vt420pc.keytab</file></qresource>
<qresource><file>historic/x11r5.keytab</file></qresource>
<qresource><file>historic/vt100.keytab</file></qresource>
</RCC>

@ -0,0 +1,138 @@
# [linux.keytab] Konsole Keyboard Table (Linux console keys)
#
# --------------------------------------------------------------
# NOT TESTED, MAY NEED SOME CLEANUPS
keyboard "Linux console"
# --------------------------------------------------------------
#
# This configuration table allows to customize the
# meaning of the keys.
#
# The syntax is that each entry has the form :
#
# "key" Keyname { ("+"|"-") Modename } ":" (String|Operation)
#
# Keynames are those defined in <qnamespace.h> with the
# "Qt::Key_" removed. (We'd better insert the list here)
#
# Mode names are :
#
# - Shift
# - Alt
# - Control
#
# The VT100 emulation has two modes that can affect the
# sequences emitted by certain keys. These modes are
# under control of the client program.
#
# - Newline : effects Return and Enter key.
# - Application : effects Up and Down key.
#
# - Ansi : effects Up and Down key (This is for VT52, really).
#
# Operations are
#
# - scrollUpLine
# - scrollUpPage
# - scrollDownLine
# - scrollDownPage
#
# - emitSelection
#
# If the key is not found here, the text of the
# key event as provided by QT is emitted, possibly
# preceeded by ESC if the Alt key is pressed.
#
# --------------------------------------------------------------
key Escape : "\E"
key Tab : "\t"
# VT100 can add an extra \n after return.
# The NewLine mode is set by an escape sequence.
key Return-NewLine : "\r"
key Return+NewLine : "\r\n"
# Some desperately try to save the ^H.
key Backspace : "\x7f"
key Delete : "\E[3~"
# These codes are for the VT52 mode of VT100
# The Ansi mode (i.e. VT100 mode) is set by
# an escape sequence
key Up -Shift-Ansi : "\EA"
key Down -Shift-Ansi : "\EB"
key Right-Shift-Ansi : "\EC"
key Left -Shift-Ansi : "\ED"
# VT100 emits a mode bit together
# with the arrow keys.The AppCuKeys
# mode is set by an escape sequence.
key Up -Shift+Ansi+AppCuKeys : "\EOA"
key Down -Shift+Ansi+AppCuKeys : "\EOB"
key Right-Shift+Ansi+AppCuKeys : "\EOC"
key Left -Shift+Ansi+AppCuKeys : "\EOD"
key Up -Shift+Ansi-AppCuKeys : "\E[A"
key Down -Shift+Ansi-AppCuKeys : "\E[B"
key Right-Shift+Ansi-AppCuKeys : "\E[C"
key Left -Shift+Ansi-AppCuKeys : "\E[D"
key Up -Shift+AnyMod+Ansi : "\E[1;*A"
key Down -Shift+AnyMod+Ansi : "\E[1;*B"
key Right -Shift+AnyMod+Ansi : "\E[1;*C"
key Left -Shift+AnyMod+Ansi : "\E[1;*D"
# linux functions keys F1-F5 differ from xterm
key F1 : "\E[[A"
key F2 : "\E[[B"
key F3 : "\E[[C"
key F4 : "\E[[D"
key F5 : "\E[[E"
key F6 : "\E[17~"
key F7 : "\E[18~"
key F8 : "\E[19~"
key F9 : "\E[20~"
key F10 : "\E[21~"
key F11 : "\E[23~"
key F12 : "\E[24~"
key Home : "\E[1~"
key End : "\E[4~"
key Prior -Shift : "\E[5~"
key Next -Shift : "\E[6~"
key Insert-Shift : "\E[2~"
# Keypad-Enter. See comment on Return above.
key Enter+NewLine : "\r\n"
key Enter-NewLine : "\r"
key Space +Control : "\x00"
# some of keys are used by konsole.
key Up +Shift : scrollLineUp
key Prior +Shift : scrollPageUp
key Down +Shift : scrollLineDown
key Next +Shift : scrollPageDown
key ScrollLock : scrollLock
#----------------------------------------------------------
# keypad characters as offered by Qt
# cannot be recognized as such.
#----------------------------------------------------------
# Following other strings as emitted by konsole.

@ -0,0 +1,175 @@
# [README.default.Keytab] Buildin Keyboard Table
#
# To customize your keyboard, copy this file to something
# ending with .keytab and change it to meet you needs.
# Please read the README.KeyTab and the README.keyboard
# in this case.
#
# --------------------------------------------------------------
keyboard "Default (XFree 4)"
# --------------------------------------------------------------
#
# Note that this particular table is a "risc" version made to
# ease customization without bothering with obsolete details.
# See VT100.keytab for the more hairy stuff.
#
# --------------------------------------------------------------
# common keys
key Escape : "\x1b"
#key Control : "^"
key Tab -Shift : "\t"
key Tab +Shift+Ansi : "\E[Z"
key Tab +Shift-Ansi : "\t"
key Backtab +Ansi : "\E[Z"
key Backtab -Ansi : "\t"
key Return-Shift-NewLine : "\r"
key Return-Shift+NewLine : "\r\n"
key Return+Shift : "\EOM"
# Backspace and Delete codes are preserving CTRL-H.
key Backspace : "\x7f"
# Arrow keys in VT52 mode
# shift up/down are reserved for scrolling.
# shift left/right are reserved for switching between tabs (this is hardcoded).
# Command + C
# on mac - Control=Command, Meta=Ctrl
# do not use Control+C for interrupt signal - it's used for "Copy to clipboard"
#key Control +C : "\x03"
key Meta +C: "\x03"
# Arrow keys in ANSI mode with Application - and Normal Cursor Mode)
key Up -Shift+Ansi-AppCuKeys : "\E[A"
key Down -Shift+Ansi-AppCuKeys : "\E[B"
key Right-Shift+Ansi-AppCuKeys : "\E[C"
key Left -Shift+Ansi-AppCuKeys : "\E[D"
key Up -Ansi : "\E[1;*A"
key Down -Ansi : "\E[1;*B"
key Right -Ansi : "\E[1;*C"
key Left -Ansi : "\E[1;*D"
#key Up -Shift-Ansi : "\EA"
#key Down -Shift-Ansi : "\EB"
#key Right-Shift-Ansi : "\EC"
#key Left -Shift-Ansi : "\ED"
#key Up -Shift-AnyMod+Ansi-AppCuKeys : "\E[A"
#key Down -Shift-AnyMod+Ansi-AppCuKeys : "\E[B"
#key Right -Shift-AnyMod+Ansi-AppCuKeys : "\E[C"
#key Left -Shift-AnyMod+Ansi-AppCuKeys : "\E[D"
#key Up -Shift-AnyMod+Ansi-AppCuKeys : "\EOA"
#key Down -Shift-AnyMod+Ansi-AppCuKeys : "\EOB"
#key Right -Shift-AnyMod+Ansi-AppCuKeys : "\EOC"
#key Left -Shift-AnyMod+Ansi-AppCuKeys : "\EOD"
#key Up -Shift-AnyMod+Ansi : "\E[1;*A"
#key Down -Shift-AnyMod+Ansi : "\E[1;*B"
#key Right -Shift-AnyMod+Ansi : "\E[1;*C"
#key Left -Shift-AnyMod+Ansi : "\E[1;*D"
# other grey PC keys
key Enter+NewLine : "\r\n"
key Enter-NewLine : "\r"
key Home -AnyMod -AppCuKeys : "\E[H"
key End -AnyMod -AppCuKeys : "\E[F"
key Home -AnyMod +AppCuKeys : "\EOH"
key End -AnyMod +AppCuKeys : "\EOF"
key Home +AnyMod : "\E[1;*H"
key End +AnyMod : "\E[1;*F"
key Insert -AnyMod : "\E[2~"
key Delete -AnyMod : "\E[3~"
key Insert +AnyMod : "\E[2;*~"
key Delete +AnyMod : "\E[3;*~"
key Prior -Shift-AnyMod : "\E[5~"
key Next -Shift-AnyMod : "\E[6~"
key Prior -Shift+AnyMod : "\E[5;*~"
key Next -Shift+AnyMod : "\E[6;*~"
# Function keys
#key F1 -AnyMod : "\EOP"
#key F2 -AnyMod : "\EOQ"
#key F3 -AnyMod : "\EOR"
#key F4 -AnyMod : "\EOS"
#define ALT_KP_0 "\033Op"
#define ALT_KP_1 "\033Oq"
#define ALT_KP_2 "\033Or"
#define ALT_KP_3 "\033Os"
#define ALT_KP_4 "\033Ot"
#define ALT_KP_5 "\033Ou"
#define ALT_KP_6 "\033Ov"
#define ALT_KP_7 "\033Ow"
#define ALT_KP_8 "\033Ox"
#define ALT_KP_9 "\033Oy"
key F1 -AnyMod : "\EOP"
key F2 -AnyMod : "\EOQ"
key F3 -AnyMod : "\EOR"
key F4 -AnyMod : "\EOS"
key F5 -AnyMod : "\EOT"
key F6 -AnyMod : "\EOU"
key F7 -AnyMod : "\EOV"
key F8 -AnyMod : "\EOW"
key F9 -AnyMod : "\EOX"
key F10 -AnyMod : "\EOY"
#key F5 -AnyMod : "\E[15~"
#key F6 -AnyMod : "\E[17~"
#key F7 -AnyMod : "\E[18~"
#key F8 -AnyMod : "\E[19~"
#key F9 -AnyMod : "\E[20~"
#key F10 -AnyMod : "\E[21~"
#key F11 -AnyMod : "\E[23~"
#key F12 -AnyMod : "\E[24~"
#key F1 +AnyMod : "\EO*P"
#key F2 +AnyMod : "\EO*Q"
#key F3 +AnyMod : "\EO*R"
#key F4 +AnyMod : "\EO*S"
#key F5 +AnyMod : "\E[15;*~"
#key F6 +AnyMod : "\E[17;*~"
#key F7 +AnyMod : "\E[18;*~"
#key F8 +AnyMod : "\E[19;*~"
#key F9 +AnyMod : "\E[20;*~"
#key F10 +AnyMod : "\E[21;*~"
#key F11 +AnyMod : "\E[23;*~"
#key F12 +AnyMod : "\E[24;*~"
# Work around dead keys
key Space +Control : "\x00"
# Some keys are used by konsole to cause operations.
# The scroll* operations refer to the history buffer.
key Up +Shift-AppScreen : scrollLineUp
key Prior +Shift-AppScreen : scrollPageUp
key Down +Shift-AppScreen : scrollLineDown
key Next +Shift-AppScreen : scrollPageDown
#key Up +Shift : scrollLineUp
#key Prior +Shift : scrollPageUp
#key Down +Shift : scrollLineDown
#key Next +Shift : scrollPageDown
key ScrollLock : scrollLock
# keypad characters are not offered differently by Qt.

@ -0,0 +1,108 @@
# [solaris.keytab] Konsole Keyboard Table
#
keyboard "Solaris console"
# --------------------------------------------------------------
#
# This configuration table allows to customize the
# meaning of the keys.
#
# The syntax is that each entry has the form :
#
# "key" Keyname { ("+"|"-") Modename } ":" (String|Operation)
#
# Keynames are those defined in <qnamespace.h> with the
# "Qt::Key_" removed. (We'd better insert the list here)
#
# Mode names are :
#
# - Shift
# - Alt
# - Control
#
# The VT100 emulation has two modes that can affect the
# sequences emitted by certain keys. These modes are
# under control of the client program.
#
#
# - Newline : effects Return and Enter key.
# - Application : effects Up and Down key.
#
# - Ansi : effects Up and Down key (This is for VT52, really).
#
# Operations are
#
# - scrollUpLine
# - scrollUpPage
# - scrollDownLine
# - scrollDownPage
#
# - emitSelection
#
# If the key is not found here, the text of the
# key event as provided by QT is emitted, possibly
# preceeded by ESC if the Alt key is pressed.
#
# --------------------------------------------------------------
key Escape : "\E"
key Tab : "\t"
key Return-Alt : "\r"
key Return+Alt : "\E\r"
# Backspace and Delete codes are preserving CTRL-H.
key Backspace : "\x08"
#key Delete : "\x7F"
# cursor keys
key Up -Shift : "\EOA"
key Down -Shift : "\EOB"
key Right -Shift : "\EOC"
key Left -Shift : "\EOD"
# other grey PC keys
key Enter : "\r"
key Home : "\E[1~"
key Insert-Shift : "\E[2~"
key Delete : "\E[3~"
key End : "\E[4~"
key Prior -Shift : "\E[5~"
key Next -Shift : "\E[6~"
# function keys
key F1 : "\E[11~"
key F2 : "\E[12~"
key F3 : "\E[13~"
key F4 : "\E[14~"
key F5 : "\E[15~"
key F6 : "\E[17~"
key F7 : "\E[18~"
key F8 : "\E[19~"
key F9 : "\E[20~"
key F10 : "\E[21~"
key F11 : "\E[23~"
key F12 : "\E[24~"
# Work around dead keys
key Space +Control : "\x00"
# Some keys are used by konsole to cause operations.
# The scroll* operations refer to the history buffer.
#key Left +Shift : prevSession
#key Right +Shift : nextSession
key Up +Shift : scrollLineUp
key Prior +Shift : scrollPageUp
key Down +Shift : scrollLineDown
key Next +Shift : scrollPageDown
#key Insert+Shift : emitSelection
# keypad characters are not offered differently by Qt.

@ -0,0 +1,168 @@
#
# NOTE: This keyboard binding is not installed because it
# apparently doesn't work with actual VT420 systems
# (see BUG:170220)
#
# [vt420pc.keytab] Konsole Keyboard Table (VT420pc keys)
# adapted by ferdinand gassauer f.gassauer@aon.at
# Nov 2000
#
################################################################
#
# The escape sequences emmited by the
# keys Shift+F1 to Shift+F12 might not fit your needs
#
################# IMPORTANT NOTICE #############################
# the key bindings (Kcontrol -> look and feel -> keybindgs)
# overrule the settings in this file. The key bindings might be
# changed by the user WITHOUT notification of the maintainer of
# the keytab file. Konsole will not work as expected by
# the maintainer of the keytab file.
################################################################
#
# --------------------------------------------------------------
keyboard "DEC VT420 Terminal"
# --------------------------------------------------------------
#
# This configuration table allows to customize the
# meaning of the keys.
#
# The syntax is that each entry has the form :
#
# "key" Keyname { ("+"|"-") Modename } ":" (String|Operation)
#
# Keynames are those defined in <qnamespace.h> with the
# "Qt::Key_" removed. (We'd better insert the list here)
#
# Mode names are :
#
# - Shift
# - Alt
# - Control
#
# The VT100 emulation has two modes that can affect the
# sequences emitted by certain keys. These modes are
# under control of the client program.
#
# - Newline : effects Return and Enter key.
# - Application : effects Up and Down key.
#
# - Ansi : effects Up and Down key (This is for VT52, really).
#
# Operations are
#
# - scrollUpLine
# - scrollUpPage
# - scrollDownLine
# - scrollDownPage
#
# - emitSelection
#
# If the key is not found here, the text of the
# key event as provided by QT is emitted, possibly
# preceeded by ESC if the Alt key is pressed.
#
# --------------------------------------------------------------
key Escape : "\E"
key Tab : "\t"
key Backtab: "\E[Z"
# VT100 can add an extra \n after return.
# The NewLine mode is set by an escape sequence.
key Return-NewLine : "\r"
key Return+NewLine : "\r\n"
# Some desperately try to save the ^H.
# may be not everyone wants this
key Backspace : "\x08" # Control H
key Delete : "\x7f"
# These codes are for the VT420pc
# The Ansi mode (i.e. VT100 mode) is set by
# an escape sequence
key Up -Shift-Ansi : "\EA"
key Down -Shift-Ansi : "\EB"
key Right-Shift-Ansi : "\EC"
key Left -Shift-Ansi : "\ED"
# VT100 emits a mode bit together
# with the arrow keys.The AppCuKeys
# mode is set by an escape sequence.
key Up -Shift+Ansi+AppCuKeys : "\EOA"
key Down -Shift+Ansi+AppCuKeys : "\EOB"
key Right-Shift+Ansi+AppCuKeys : "\EOC"
key Left -Shift+Ansi+AppCuKeys : "\EOD"
key Up -Shift+Ansi-AppCuKeys : "\E[A"
key Down -Shift+Ansi-AppCuKeys : "\E[B"
key Right-Shift+Ansi-AppCuKeys : "\E[C"
key Left -Shift+Ansi-AppCuKeys : "\E[D"
# function keys
key F1 -Shift : "\E[11~"
key F2 -Shift : "\E[12~"
key F3 -Shift : "\E[13~"
key F4 -Shift : "\E[14~"
key F5 -Shift : "\E[15~"
key F6 -Shift : "\E[17~"
key F7 -Shift : "\E[18~"
key F8 -Shift : "\E[19~"
key F9 -Shift : "\E[20~"
key F10-Shift : "\E[21~"
key F11-Shift : "\E[23~"
key F12-Shift : "\E[24~"
#
# Shift F1-F12
#
key F1 +Shift : "\E[11;2~"
key F2 +Shift : "\E[12;2~"
key F3 +Shift : "\E[13;2~"
key F4 +Shift : "\E[14;2~"
key F5 +Shift : "\E[15;2~"
key F6 +Shift : "\E[17;2~"
key F7 +Shift : "\E[18;2~"
key F8 +Shift : "\E[19;2~"
key F9 +Shift : "\E[20;2~"
key F10+Shift : "\E[21;2~"
key F11+Shift : "\E[23;2~"
key F12+Shift : "\E[24;2~"
key Home : "\E[H"
key End : "\E[F"
key Prior -Shift : "\E[5~"
key Next -Shift : "\E[6~"
key Insert-Shift : "\E[2~"
# Keypad-Enter. See comment on Return above.
key Enter+NewLine : "\r\n"
key Enter-NewLine : "\r"
key Space +Control : "\x00"
# some of keys are used by konsole.
key Up +Shift : scrollLineUp
key Prior +Shift : scrollPageUp
key Down +Shift : scrollLineDown
key Next +Shift : scrollPageDown
key ScrollLock : scrollLock
#----------------------------------------------------------
# keypad characters as offered by Qt
# cannot be recognized as such.
#----------------------------------------------------------
# Following other strings as emitted by konsole.

@ -0,0 +1,226 @@
/* $XFree86: xc/programs/xterm/wcwidth.character,v 1.3 2001/07/29 22:08:16 tsi Exp $ */
/*
* This is an implementation of wcwidth() and wcswidth() as defined in
* "The Single UNIX Specification, Version 2, The Open Group, 1997"
* <http://www.UNIX-systems.org/online.html>
*
* Markus Kuhn -- 2001-01-12 -- public domain
*/
#include <QString>
#include "konsole_wcwidth.h"
struct interval {
unsigned short first;
unsigned short last;
};
/* auxiliary function for binary search in interval table */
static int bisearch(quint16 ucs, const struct interval * table, int max)
{
int min = 0;
int mid;
if (ucs < table[0].first || ucs > table[max].last) {
return 0;
}
while (max >= min) {
mid = (min + max) / 2;
if (ucs > table[mid].last) {
min = mid + 1;
} else if (ucs < table[mid].first) {
max = mid - 1;
} else {
return 1;
}
}
return 0;
}
/* The following functions define the column width of an ISO 10646
* character as follows:
*
* - The null character (U+0000) has a column width of 0.
*
* - Other C0/C1 control characters and DEL will lead to a return
* value of -1.
*
* - Non-spacing and enclosing combining characters (general
* category code Mn or Me in the Unicode database) have a
* column width of 0.
*
* - Other format characters (general category code Cf in the Unicode
* database) and ZERO WIDTH SPACE (U+200B) have a column width of 0.
*
* - Hangul Jamo medial vowels and final consonants (U+1160-U+11FF)
* have a column width of 0.
*
* - Spacing characters in the East Asian Wide (W) or East Asian
* FullWidth (F) category as defined in Unicode Technical
* Report #11 have a column width of 2.
*
* - All remaining characters (including all printable
* ISO 8859-1 and WGL4 characters, Unicode control characters,
* etc.) have a column width of 1.
*
* This implementation assumes that quint16 characters are encoded
* in ISO 10646.
*/
int konsole_wcwidth(quint16 ucs)
{
/* sorted list of non-overlapping intervals of non-spacing characters */
static const struct interval combining[] = {
{ 0x0300, 0x034E }, { 0x0360, 0x0362 }, { 0x0483, 0x0486 },
{ 0x0488, 0x0489 }, { 0x0591, 0x05A1 }, { 0x05A3, 0x05B9 },
{ 0x05BB, 0x05BD }, { 0x05BF, 0x05BF }, { 0x05C1, 0x05C2 },
{ 0x05C4, 0x05C4 }, { 0x064B, 0x0655 }, { 0x0670, 0x0670 },
{ 0x06D6, 0x06E4 }, { 0x06E7, 0x06E8 }, { 0x06EA, 0x06ED },
{ 0x070F, 0x070F }, { 0x0711, 0x0711 }, { 0x0730, 0x074A },
{ 0x07A6, 0x07B0 }, { 0x0901, 0x0902 }, { 0x093C, 0x093C },
{ 0x0941, 0x0948 }, { 0x094D, 0x094D }, { 0x0951, 0x0954 },
{ 0x0962, 0x0963 }, { 0x0981, 0x0981 }, { 0x09BC, 0x09BC },
{ 0x09C1, 0x09C4 }, { 0x09CD, 0x09CD }, { 0x09E2, 0x09E3 },
{ 0x0A02, 0x0A02 }, { 0x0A3C, 0x0A3C }, { 0x0A41, 0x0A42 },
{ 0x0A47, 0x0A48 }, { 0x0A4B, 0x0A4D }, { 0x0A70, 0x0A71 },
{ 0x0A81, 0x0A82 }, { 0x0ABC, 0x0ABC }, { 0x0AC1, 0x0AC5 },
{ 0x0AC7, 0x0AC8 }, { 0x0ACD, 0x0ACD }, { 0x0B01, 0x0B01 },
{ 0x0B3C, 0x0B3C }, { 0x0B3F, 0x0B3F }, { 0x0B41, 0x0B43 },
{ 0x0B4D, 0x0B4D }, { 0x0B56, 0x0B56 }, { 0x0B82, 0x0B82 },
{ 0x0BC0, 0x0BC0 }, { 0x0BCD, 0x0BCD }, { 0x0C3E, 0x0C40 },
{ 0x0C46, 0x0C48 }, { 0x0C4A, 0x0C4D }, { 0x0C55, 0x0C56 },
{ 0x0CBF, 0x0CBF }, { 0x0CC6, 0x0CC6 }, { 0x0CCC, 0x0CCD },
{ 0x0D41, 0x0D43 }, { 0x0D4D, 0x0D4D }, { 0x0DCA, 0x0DCA },
{ 0x0DD2, 0x0DD4 }, { 0x0DD6, 0x0DD6 }, { 0x0E31, 0x0E31 },
{ 0x0E34, 0x0E3A }, { 0x0E47, 0x0E4E }, { 0x0EB1, 0x0EB1 },
{ 0x0EB4, 0x0EB9 }, { 0x0EBB, 0x0EBC }, { 0x0EC8, 0x0ECD },
{ 0x0F18, 0x0F19 }, { 0x0F35, 0x0F35 }, { 0x0F37, 0x0F37 },
{ 0x0F39, 0x0F39 }, { 0x0F71, 0x0F7E }, { 0x0F80, 0x0F84 },
{ 0x0F86, 0x0F87 }, { 0x0F90, 0x0F97 }, { 0x0F99, 0x0FBC },
{ 0x0FC6, 0x0FC6 }, { 0x102D, 0x1030 }, { 0x1032, 0x1032 },
{ 0x1036, 0x1037 }, { 0x1039, 0x1039 }, { 0x1058, 0x1059 },
{ 0x1160, 0x11FF }, { 0x17B7, 0x17BD }, { 0x17C6, 0x17C6 },
{ 0x17C9, 0x17D3 }, { 0x180B, 0x180E }, { 0x18A9, 0x18A9 },
{ 0x200B, 0x200F }, { 0x202A, 0x202E }, { 0x206A, 0x206F },
{ 0x20D0, 0x20E3 }, { 0x302A, 0x302F }, { 0x3099, 0x309A },
{ 0xFB1E, 0xFB1E }, { 0xFE20, 0xFE23 }, { 0xFEFF, 0xFEFF },
{ 0xFFF9, 0xFFFB }
};
/* test for 8-bit control characters */
if (ucs == 0) {
return 0;
}
if (ucs < 32 || (ucs >= 0x7f && ucs < 0xa0)) {
return -1;
}
/* binary search in table of non-spacing characters */
if (bisearch(ucs, combining,
sizeof(combining) / sizeof(struct interval) - 1)) {
return 0;
}
/* if we arrive here, ucs is not a combining or C0/C1 control character */
return 1 +
(ucs >= 0x1100 &&
(ucs <= 0x115f || /* Hangul Jamo init. consonants */
(ucs >= 0x2e80 && ucs <= 0xa4cf && (ucs & ~0x0011) != 0x300a &&
ucs != 0x303f) || /* CJK ... Yi */
(ucs >= 0xac00 && ucs <= 0xd7a3) || /* Hangul Syllables */
(ucs >= 0xf900 && ucs <= 0xfaff) || /* CJK Compatibility Ideographs */
(ucs >= 0xfe30 && ucs <= 0xfe6f) || /* CJK Compatibility Forms */
(ucs >= 0xff00 && ucs <= 0xff5f) || /* Fullwidth Forms */
(ucs >= 0xffe0 && ucs <= 0xffe6) /* do not compare UINT16 with 0x20000 ||
(ucs >= 0x20000 && ucs <= 0x2ffff) */));
}
#if 0
/*
* The following function is the same as konsole_wcwidth(), except that
* spacing characters in the East Asian Ambiguous (A) category as
* defined in Unicode Technical Report #11 have a column width of 2.
* This experimental variant might be useful for users of CJK legacy
* encodings who want to migrate to UCS. It is not otherwise
* recommended for general use.
*/
int konsole_wcwidth_cjk(quint16 ucs)
{
/* sorted list of non-overlapping intervals of East Asian Ambiguous
* characters */
static const struct interval ambiguous[] = {
{ 0x00A1, 0x00A1 }, { 0x00A4, 0x00A4 }, { 0x00A7, 0x00A8 },
{ 0x00AA, 0x00AA }, { 0x00AD, 0x00AD }, { 0x00B0, 0x00B4 },
{ 0x00B6, 0x00BA }, { 0x00BC, 0x00BF }, { 0x00C6, 0x00C6 },
{ 0x00D0, 0x00D0 }, { 0x00D7, 0x00D8 }, { 0x00DE, 0x00E1 },
{ 0x00E6, 0x00E6 }, { 0x00E8, 0x00EA }, { 0x00EC, 0x00ED },
{ 0x00F0, 0x00F0 }, { 0x00F2, 0x00F3 }, { 0x00F7, 0x00FA },
{ 0x00FC, 0x00FC }, { 0x00FE, 0x00FE }, { 0x0101, 0x0101 },
{ 0x0111, 0x0111 }, { 0x0113, 0x0113 }, { 0x011B, 0x011B },
{ 0x0126, 0x0127 }, { 0x012B, 0x012B }, { 0x0131, 0x0133 },
{ 0x0138, 0x0138 }, { 0x013F, 0x0142 }, { 0x0144, 0x0144 },
{ 0x0148, 0x014A }, { 0x014D, 0x014D }, { 0x0152, 0x0153 },
{ 0x0166, 0x0167 }, { 0x016B, 0x016B }, { 0x01CE, 0x01CE },
{ 0x01D0, 0x01D0 }, { 0x01D2, 0x01D2 }, { 0x01D4, 0x01D4 },
{ 0x01D6, 0x01D6 }, { 0x01D8, 0x01D8 }, { 0x01DA, 0x01DA },
{ 0x01DC, 0x01DC }, { 0x0251, 0x0251 }, { 0x0261, 0x0261 },
{ 0x02C7, 0x02C7 }, { 0x02C9, 0x02CB }, { 0x02CD, 0x02CD },
{ 0x02D0, 0x02D0 }, { 0x02D8, 0x02DB }, { 0x02DD, 0x02DD },
{ 0x0391, 0x03A1 }, { 0x03A3, 0x03A9 }, { 0x03B1, 0x03C1 },
{ 0x03C3, 0x03C9 }, { 0x0401, 0x0401 }, { 0x0410, 0x044F },
{ 0x0451, 0x0451 }, { 0x2010, 0x2010 }, { 0x2013, 0x2016 },
{ 0x2018, 0x2019 }, { 0x201C, 0x201D }, { 0x2020, 0x2021 },
{ 0x2025, 0x2027 }, { 0x2030, 0x2030 }, { 0x2032, 0x2033 },
{ 0x2035, 0x2035 }, { 0x203B, 0x203B }, { 0x2074, 0x2074 },
{ 0x207F, 0x207F }, { 0x2081, 0x2084 }, { 0x20AC, 0x20AC },
{ 0x2103, 0x2103 }, { 0x2105, 0x2105 }, { 0x2109, 0x2109 },
{ 0x2113, 0x2113 }, { 0x2121, 0x2122 }, { 0x2126, 0x2126 },
{ 0x212B, 0x212B }, { 0x2154, 0x2155 }, { 0x215B, 0x215B },
{ 0x215E, 0x215E }, { 0x2160, 0x216B }, { 0x2170, 0x2179 },
{ 0x2190, 0x2199 }, { 0x21D2, 0x21D2 }, { 0x21D4, 0x21D4 },
{ 0x2200, 0x2200 }, { 0x2202, 0x2203 }, { 0x2207, 0x2208 },
{ 0x220B, 0x220B }, { 0x220F, 0x220F }, { 0x2211, 0x2211 },
{ 0x2215, 0x2215 }, { 0x221A, 0x221A }, { 0x221D, 0x2220 },
{ 0x2223, 0x2223 }, { 0x2225, 0x2225 }, { 0x2227, 0x222C },
{ 0x222E, 0x222E }, { 0x2234, 0x2237 }, { 0x223C, 0x223D },
{ 0x2248, 0x2248 }, { 0x224C, 0x224C }, { 0x2252, 0x2252 },
{ 0x2260, 0x2261 }, { 0x2264, 0x2267 }, { 0x226A, 0x226B },
{ 0x226E, 0x226F }, { 0x2282, 0x2283 }, { 0x2286, 0x2287 },
{ 0x2295, 0x2295 }, { 0x2299, 0x2299 }, { 0x22A5, 0x22A5 },
{ 0x22BF, 0x22BF }, { 0x2312, 0x2312 }, { 0x2460, 0x24BF },
{ 0x24D0, 0x24E9 }, { 0x2500, 0x254B }, { 0x2550, 0x2574 },
{ 0x2580, 0x258F }, { 0x2592, 0x2595 }, { 0x25A0, 0x25A1 },
{ 0x25A3, 0x25A9 }, { 0x25B2, 0x25B3 }, { 0x25B6, 0x25B7 },
{ 0x25BC, 0x25BD }, { 0x25C0, 0x25C1 }, { 0x25C6, 0x25C8 },
{ 0x25CB, 0x25CB }, { 0x25CE, 0x25D1 }, { 0x25E2, 0x25E5 },
{ 0x25EF, 0x25EF }, { 0x2605, 0x2606 }, { 0x2609, 0x2609 },
{ 0x260E, 0x260F }, { 0x261C, 0x261C }, { 0x261E, 0x261E },
{ 0x2640, 0x2640 }, { 0x2642, 0x2642 }, { 0x2660, 0x2661 },
{ 0x2663, 0x2665 }, { 0x2667, 0x266A }, { 0x266C, 0x266D },
{ 0x266F, 0x266F }, { 0x300A, 0x300B }, { 0x301A, 0x301B },
{ 0xE000, 0xF8FF }, { 0xFFFD, 0xFFFD }
};
/* binary search in table of non-spacing characters */
if (bisearch(ucs, ambiguous,
sizeof(ambiguous) / sizeof(struct interval) - 1)) {
return 2;
}
return konsole_wcwidth(ucs);
}
#endif
// single byte char: +1, multi byte char: +2
int string_width( const QString & txt )
{
int w = 0;
for ( int i = 0; i < txt.length(); ++i ) {
w += konsole_wcwidth( txt[ i ].unicode() );
}
return w;
}

@ -0,0 +1,25 @@
/* $XFree86: xc/programs/xterm/wcwidth.h,v 1.2 2001/06/18 19:09:27 dickey Exp $ */
/* Markus Kuhn -- 2001-01-12 -- public domain */
/* Adaptions for KDE by Waldo Bastian <bastian@kde.org> */
/*
Rewritten for QT4 by e_k <e_k at users.sourceforge.net>
*/
#ifndef _KONSOLE_WCWIDTH_H_
#define _KONSOLE_WCWIDTH_H_
// Qt
#include <QtGlobal>
class QString;
int konsole_wcwidth(quint16 ucs);
#if 0
int konsole_wcwidth_cjk(Q_UINT16 ucs);
#endif
int string_width( const QString & txt );
#endif

@ -0,0 +1,412 @@
/*
* This file is a part of QTerminal - http://gitorious.org/qterminal
*
* This file was un-linked from KDE and modified
* by Maxim Bourmistrov <maxim@unixconn.com>
*
*/
/*
This file is part of the KDE libraries
Copyright (C) 2007 Oswald Buddenhagen <ossi@kde.org>
This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
modify it under the terms of the GNU Library General Public
License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
Library General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public License
along with this library; see the file COPYING.LIB. If not, write to
the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.
*/
#include "kprocess.h"
#include <qfile.h>
#ifdef Q_OS_WIN
# include <windows.h>
#else
# include <unistd.h>
# include <errno.h>
#endif
#ifndef Q_OS_WIN
# define STD_OUTPUT_HANDLE 1
# define STD_ERROR_HANDLE 2
#endif
#ifdef _WIN32_WCE
#include <stdio.h>
#endif
void KProcessPrivate::writeAll(const QByteArray &buf, int fd)
{
#ifdef Q_OS_WIN
#ifndef _WIN32_WCE
HANDLE h = GetStdHandle(fd);
if (h) {
DWORD wr;
WriteFile(h, buf.data(), buf.size(), &wr, 0);
}
#else
fwrite(buf.data(), 1, buf.size(), (FILE*)fd);
#endif
#else
int off = 0;
do {
int ret = ::write(fd, buf.data() + off, buf.size() - off);
if (ret < 0) {
if (errno != EINTR)
return;
} else {
off += ret;
}
} while (off < buf.size());
#endif
}
void KProcessPrivate::forwardStd(KProcess::ProcessChannel good, int fd)
{
Q_Q(KProcess);
QProcess::ProcessChannel oc = q->readChannel();
q->setReadChannel(good);
writeAll(q->readAll(), fd);
q->setReadChannel(oc);
}
void KProcessPrivate::_k_forwardStdout()
{
#ifndef _WIN32_WCE
forwardStd(KProcess::StandardOutput, STD_OUTPUT_HANDLE);
#else
forwardStd(KProcess::StandardOutput, (int)stdout);
#endif
}
void KProcessPrivate::_k_forwardStderr()
{
#ifndef _WIN32_WCE
forwardStd(KProcess::StandardError, STD_ERROR_HANDLE);
#else
forwardStd(KProcess::StandardError, (int)stderr);
#endif
}
/////////////////////////////
// public member functions //
/////////////////////////////
KProcess::KProcess(QObject *parent) :
QProcess(parent),
d_ptr(new KProcessPrivate)
{
d_ptr->q_ptr = this;
setOutputChannelMode(ForwardedChannels);
}
KProcess::KProcess(KProcessPrivate *d, QObject *parent) :
QProcess(parent),
d_ptr(d)
{
d_ptr->q_ptr = this;
setOutputChannelMode(ForwardedChannels);
}
KProcess::~KProcess()
{
delete d_ptr;
}
void KProcess::setOutputChannelMode(OutputChannelMode mode)
{
Q_D(KProcess);
d->outputChannelMode = mode;
disconnect(this, SIGNAL(readyReadStandardOutput()));
disconnect(this, SIGNAL(readyReadStandardError()));
switch (mode) {
case OnlyStdoutChannel:
connect(this, SIGNAL(readyReadStandardError()), SLOT(_k_forwardStderr()));
break;
case OnlyStderrChannel:
connect(this, SIGNAL(readyReadStandardOutput()), SLOT(_k_forwardStdout()));
break;
default:
QProcess::setProcessChannelMode((ProcessChannelMode)mode);
return;
}
QProcess::setProcessChannelMode(QProcess::SeparateChannels);
}
KProcess::OutputChannelMode KProcess::outputChannelMode() const
{
Q_D(const KProcess);
return d->outputChannelMode;
}
void KProcess::setNextOpenMode(QIODevice::OpenMode mode)
{
Q_D(KProcess);
d->openMode = mode;
}
#define DUMMYENV "_KPROCESS_DUMMY_="
void KProcess::clearEnvironment()
{
setEnvironment(QStringList() << QString::fromLatin1(DUMMYENV));
}
void KProcess::setEnv(const QString &name, const QString &value, bool overwrite)
{
QStringList env = environment();
if (env.isEmpty()) {
env = systemEnvironment();
env.removeAll(QString::fromLatin1(DUMMYENV));
}
QString fname(name);
fname.append(QLatin1Char('='));
for (QStringList::Iterator it = env.begin(); it != env.end(); ++it)
if ((*it).startsWith(fname)) {
if (overwrite) {
*it = fname.append(value);
setEnvironment(env);
}
return;
}
env.append(fname.append(value));
setEnvironment(env);
}
void KProcess::unsetEnv(const QString &name)
{
QStringList env = environment();
if (env.isEmpty()) {
env = systemEnvironment();
env.removeAll(QString::fromLatin1(DUMMYENV));
}
QString fname(name);
fname.append(QLatin1Char('='));
for (QStringList::Iterator it = env.begin(); it != env.end(); ++it)
if ((*it).startsWith(fname)) {
env.erase(it);
if (env.isEmpty())
env.append(QString::fromLatin1(DUMMYENV));
setEnvironment(env);
return;
}
}
void KProcess::setProgram(const QString &exe, const QStringList &args)
{
Q_D(KProcess);
d->prog = exe;
d->args = args;
#ifdef Q_OS_WIN
setNativeArguments(QString());
#endif
}
void KProcess::setProgram(const QStringList &argv)
{
Q_D(KProcess);
Q_ASSERT( !argv.isEmpty() );
d->args = argv;
d->prog = d->args.takeFirst();
#ifdef Q_OS_WIN
setNativeArguments(QString());
#endif
}
KProcess &KProcess::operator<<(const QString &arg)
{
Q_D(KProcess);
if (d->prog.isEmpty())
d->prog = arg;
else
d->args << arg;
return *this;
}
KProcess &KProcess::operator<<(const QStringList &args)
{
Q_D(KProcess);
if (d->prog.isEmpty())
setProgram(args);
else
d->args << args;
return *this;
}
void KProcess::clearProgram()
{
Q_D(KProcess);
d->prog.clear();
d->args.clear();
#ifdef Q_OS_WIN
setNativeArguments(QString());
#endif
}
#if 0
void KProcess::setShellCommand(const QString &cmd)
{
Q_D(KProcess);
KShell::Errors err;
d->args = KShell::splitArgs(
cmd, KShell::AbortOnMeta | KShell::TildeExpand, &err);
if (err == KShell::NoError && !d->args.isEmpty()) {
d->prog = KStandardDirs::findExe(d->args[0]);
if (!d->prog.isEmpty()) {
d->args.removeFirst();
#ifdef Q_OS_WIN
setNativeArguments(QString());
#endif
return;
}
}
d->args.clear();
#ifdef Q_OS_UNIX
// #ifdef NON_FREE // ... as they ship non-POSIX /bin/sh
# if !defined(__linux__) && !defined(__FreeBSD__) && !defined(__NetBSD__) && !defined(__OpenBSD__) && !defined(__DragonFly__) && !defined(__GNU__)
// If /bin/sh is a symlink, we can be pretty sure that it points to a
// POSIX shell - the original bourne shell is about the only non-POSIX
// shell still in use and it is always installed natively as /bin/sh.
d->prog = QFile::symLinkTarget(QString::fromLatin1("/bin/sh"));
if (d->prog.isEmpty()) {
// Try some known POSIX shells.
d->prog = KStandardDirs::findExe(QString::fromLatin1("ksh"));
if (d->prog.isEmpty()) {
d->prog = KStandardDirs::findExe(QString::fromLatin1("ash"));
if (d->prog.isEmpty()) {
d->prog = KStandardDirs::findExe(QString::fromLatin1("bash"));
if (d->prog.isEmpty()) {
d->prog = KStandardDirs::findExe(QString::fromLatin1("zsh"));
if (d->prog.isEmpty())
// We're pretty much screwed, to be honest ...
d->prog = QString::fromLatin1("/bin/sh");
}
}
}
}
# else
d->prog = QString::fromLatin1("/bin/sh");
# endif
d->args << QString::fromLatin1("-c") << cmd;
#else // Q_OS_UNIX
// KMacroExpander::expandMacrosShellQuote(), KShell::quoteArg() and
// KShell::joinArgs() may generate these for security reasons.
setEnv(PERCENT_VARIABLE, QLatin1String("%"));
#ifndef _WIN32_WCE
WCHAR sysdir[MAX_PATH + 1];
UINT size = GetSystemDirectoryW(sysdir, MAX_PATH + 1);
d->prog = QString::fromUtf16((const ushort *) sysdir, size);
d->prog += QLatin1String("\\cmd.exe");
setNativeArguments(QLatin1String("/V:OFF /S /C \"") + cmd + QLatin1Char('"'));
#else
d->prog = QLatin1String("\\windows\\cmd.exe");
setNativeArguments(QLatin1String("/S /C \"") + cmd + QLatin1Char('"'));
#endif
#endif
}
#endif
QStringList KProcess::program() const
{
Q_D(const KProcess);
QStringList argv = d->args;
argv.prepend(d->prog);
return argv;
}
void KProcess::start()
{
Q_D(KProcess);
QProcess::start(d->prog, d->args, d->openMode);
}
int KProcess::execute(int msecs)
{
start();
if (!waitForFinished(msecs)) {
kill();
waitForFinished(-1);
return -2;
}
return (exitStatus() == QProcess::NormalExit) ? exitCode() : -1;
}
// static
int KProcess::execute(const QString &exe, const QStringList &args, int msecs)
{
KProcess p;
p.setProgram(exe, args);
return p.execute(msecs);
}
// static
int KProcess::execute(const QStringList &argv, int msecs)
{
KProcess p;
p.setProgram(argv);
return p.execute(msecs);
}
int KProcess::startDetached()
{
Q_D(KProcess);
qint64 pid;
if (!QProcess::startDetached(d->prog, d->args, workingDirectory(), &pid))
return 0;
return (int) pid;
}
// static
int KProcess::startDetached(const QString &exe, const QStringList &args)
{
qint64 pid;
if (!QProcess::startDetached(exe, args, QString(), &pid))
return 0;
return (int) pid;
}
// static
int KProcess::startDetached(const QStringList &argv)
{
QStringList args = argv;
QString prog = args.takeFirst();
return startDetached(prog, args);
}
int KProcess::pid() const
{
#ifdef Q_OS_UNIX
return (int) QProcess::pid();
#else
return QProcess::pid() ? QProcess::pid()->dwProcessId : 0;
#endif
}

@ -0,0 +1,372 @@
/*
* This file is a part of QTerminal - http://gitorious.org/qterminal
*
* This file was un-linked from KDE and modified
* by Maxim Bourmistrov <maxim@unixconn.com>
*
*/
/*
This file is part of the KDE libraries
Copyright (C) 2007 Oswald Buddenhagen <ossi@kde.org>
This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
modify it under the terms of the GNU Library General Public
License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
Library General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public License
along with this library; see the file COPYING.LIB. If not, write to
the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.
*/
#ifndef KPROCESS_H
#define KPROCESS_H
//#include <kdecore_export.h>
#include <QProcess>
class KProcessPrivate;
/**
* \class KProcess kprocess.h <KProcess>
*
* Child process invocation, monitoring and control.
*
* This class extends QProcess by some useful functionality, overrides
* some defaults with saner values and wraps parts of the API into a more
* accessible one.
* This is the preferred way of spawning child processes in KDE; don't
* use QProcess directly.
*
* @author Oswald Buddenhagen <ossi@kde.org>
**/
class KProcess : public QProcess
{
Q_OBJECT
Q_DECLARE_PRIVATE(KProcess)
public:
/**
* Modes in which the output channels can be opened.
*/
enum OutputChannelMode {
SeparateChannels = QProcess::SeparateChannels,
/**< Standard output and standard error are handled by KProcess
as separate channels */
MergedChannels = QProcess::MergedChannels,
/**< Standard output and standard error are handled by KProcess
as one channel */
ForwardedChannels = QProcess::ForwardedChannels,
/**< Both standard output and standard error are forwarded
to the parent process' respective channel */
OnlyStdoutChannel,
/**< Only standard output is handled; standard error is forwarded */
OnlyStderrChannel /**< Only standard error is handled; standard output is forwarded */
};
/**
* Constructor
*/
explicit KProcess(QObject *parent = 0);
/**
* Destructor
*/
virtual ~KProcess();
/**
* Set how to handle the output channels of the child process.
*
* The default is ForwardedChannels, which is unlike in QProcess.
* Do not request more than you actually handle, as this output is
* simply lost otherwise.
*
* This function must be called before starting the process.
*
* @param mode the output channel handling mode
*/
void setOutputChannelMode(OutputChannelMode mode);
/**
* Query how the output channels of the child process are handled.
*
* @return the output channel handling mode
*/
OutputChannelMode outputChannelMode() const;
/**
* Set the QIODevice open mode the process will be opened in.
*
* This function must be called before starting the process, obviously.
*
* @param mode the open mode. Note that this mode is automatically
* "reduced" according to the channel modes and redirections.
* The default is QIODevice::ReadWrite.
*/
void setNextOpenMode(QIODevice::OpenMode mode);
/**
* Adds the variable @p name to the process' environment.
*
* This function must be called before starting the process.
*
* @param name the name of the environment variable
* @param value the new value for the environment variable
* @param overwrite if @c false and the environment variable is already
* set, the old value will be preserved
*/
void setEnv(const QString &name, const QString &value, bool overwrite = true);
/**
* Removes the variable @p name from the process' environment.
*
* This function must be called before starting the process.
*
* @param name the name of the environment variable
*/
void unsetEnv(const QString &name);
/**
* Empties the process' environment.
*
* Note that LD_LIBRARY_PATH/DYLD_LIBRARY_PATH is automatically added
* on *NIX.
*
* This function must be called before starting the process.
*/
void clearEnvironment();
/**
* Set the program and the command line arguments.
*
* This function must be called before starting the process, obviously.
*
* @param exe the program to execute
* @param args the command line arguments for the program,
* one per list element
*/
void setProgram(const QString &exe, const QStringList &args = QStringList());
/**
* @overload
*
* @param argv the program to execute and the command line arguments
* for the program, one per list element
*/
void setProgram(const QStringList &argv);
/**
* Append an element to the command line argument list for this process.
*
* If no executable is set yet, it will be set instead.
*
* For example, doing an "ls -l /usr/local/bin" can be achieved by:
* \code
* KProcess p;
* p << "ls" << "-l" << "/usr/local/bin";
* ...
* \endcode
*
* This function must be called before starting the process, obviously.
*
* @param arg the argument to add
* @return a reference to this KProcess
*/
KProcess &operator<<(const QString& arg);
/**
* @overload
*
* @param args the arguments to add
* @return a reference to this KProcess
*/
KProcess &operator<<(const QStringList& args);
/**
* Clear the program and command line argument list.
*/
void clearProgram();
/**
* Set a command to execute through a shell (a POSIX sh on *NIX
* and cmd.exe on Windows).
*
* Using this for anything but user-supplied commands is usually a bad
* idea, as the command's syntax depends on the platform.
* Redirections including pipes, etc. are better handled by the
* respective functions provided by QProcess.
*
* If KProcess determines that the command does not really need a
* shell, it will trasparently execute it without one for performance
* reasons.
*
* This function must be called before starting the process, obviously.
*
* @param cmd the command to execute through a shell.
* The caller must make sure that all filenames etc. are properly
* quoted when passed as argument. Failure to do so often results in
* serious security holes. See KShell::quoteArg().
*/
void setShellCommand(const QString &cmd);
/**
* Obtain the currently set program and arguments.
*
* @return a list, the first element being the program, the remaining ones
* being command line arguments to the program.
*/
QStringList program() const;
/**
* Start the process.
*
* @see QProcess::start(const QString &, const QStringList &, OpenMode)
*/
void start();
/**
* Start the process, wait for it to finish, and return the exit code.
*
* This method is roughly equivalent to the sequence:
* <code>
* start();
* waitForFinished(msecs);
* return exitCode();
* </code>
*
* Unlike the other execute() variants this method is not static,
* so the process can be parametrized properly and talked to.
*
* @param msecs time to wait for process to exit before killing it
* @return -2 if the process could not be started, -1 if it crashed,
* otherwise its exit code
*/
int execute(int msecs = -1);
/**
* @overload
*
* @param exe the program to execute
* @param args the command line arguments for the program,
* one per list element
* @param msecs time to wait for process to exit before killing it
* @return -2 if the process could not be started, -1 if it crashed,
* otherwise its exit code
*/
static int execute(const QString &exe, const QStringList &args = QStringList(), int msecs = -1);
/**
* @overload
*
* @param argv the program to execute and the command line arguments
* for the program, one per list element
* @param msecs time to wait for process to exit before killing it
* @return -2 if the process could not be started, -1 if it crashed,
* otherwise its exit code
*/
static int execute(const QStringList &argv, int msecs = -1);
/**
* Start the process and detach from it. See QProcess::startDetached()
* for details.
*
* Unlike the other startDetached() variants this method is not static,
* so the process can be parametrized properly.
* @note Currently, only the setProgram()/setShellCommand() and
* setWorkingDirectory() parametrizations are supported.
*
* The KProcess object may be re-used immediately after calling this
* function.
*
* @return the PID of the started process or 0 on error
*/
int startDetached();
/**
* @overload
*
* @param exe the program to start
* @param args the command line arguments for the program,
* one per list element
* @return the PID of the started process or 0 on error
*/
static int startDetached(const QString &exe, const QStringList &args = QStringList());
/**
* @overload
*
* @param argv the program to start and the command line arguments
* for the program, one per list element
* @return the PID of the started process or 0 on error
*/
static int startDetached(const QStringList &argv);
/**
* Obtain the process' ID as known to the system.
*
* Unlike with QProcess::pid(), this is a real PID also on Windows.
*
* This function can be called only while the process is running.
* It cannot be applied to detached processes.
*
* @return the process ID
*/
int pid() const;
protected:
/**
* @internal
*/
KProcess(KProcessPrivate *d, QObject *parent);
/**
* @internal
*/
KProcessPrivate * const d_ptr;
private:
// hide those
using QProcess::setReadChannelMode;
using QProcess::readChannelMode;
using QProcess::setProcessChannelMode;
using QProcess::processChannelMode;
Q_PRIVATE_SLOT(d_func(), void _k_forwardStdout())
Q_PRIVATE_SLOT(d_func(), void _k_forwardStderr())
};
/* ----------- kprocess_p.h ---------------- */
class KProcessPrivate {
Q_DECLARE_PUBLIC(KProcess)
protected:
KProcessPrivate() :
openMode(QIODevice::ReadWrite)
{
}
void writeAll(const QByteArray &buf, int fd);
void forwardStd(KProcess::ProcessChannel good, int fd);
void _k_forwardStdout();
void _k_forwardStderr();
QString prog;
QStringList args;
KProcess::OutputChannelMode outputChannelMode;
QIODevice::OpenMode openMode;
KProcess *q_ptr;
};
/* ------------------------------------------- */
#endif

@ -0,0 +1,701 @@
/*
This file is part of the KDE libraries
Copyright (C) 2002 Waldo Bastian <bastian@kde.org>
Copyright (C) 2002-2003,2007 Oswald Buddenhagen <ossi@kde.org>
Rewritten for QT4 by e_k <e_k at users.sourceforge.net>, Copyright (C)2008
This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
modify it under the terms of the GNU Library General Public
License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
Library General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public License
along with this library; see the file COPYING.LIB. If not, write to
the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.
*/
#include "kpty_p.h"
#include <QtDebug>
#if defined(__FreeBSD__) || defined(__NetBSD__) || defined(__OpenBSD__) || defined(__DragonFly__)
#define HAVE_LOGIN
#define HAVE_LIBUTIL_H
#endif
#ifdef __sgi
#define __svr4__
#endif
#ifdef __osf__
#define _OSF_SOURCE
#include <float.h>
#endif
#ifdef _AIX
#define _ALL_SOURCE
#endif
// __USE_XOPEN isn't defined by default in ICC
// (needed for ptsname(), grantpt() and unlockpt())
#ifdef __INTEL_COMPILER
# ifndef __USE_XOPEN
# define __USE_XOPEN
# endif
#endif
#include <sys/types.h>
#include <sys/ioctl.h>
#include <sys/time.h>
#include <sys/resource.h>
#include <sys/stat.h>
#include <sys/param.h>
#include <errno.h>
#include <fcntl.h>
#include <time.h>
#include <stdlib.h>
#include <stdio.h>
#include <string.h>
#include <unistd.h>
#include <grp.h>
#if defined(HAVE_PTY_H)
# include <pty.h>
#endif
#ifdef HAVE_LIBUTIL_H
# include <libutil.h>
#elif defined(HAVE_UTIL_H)
# include <util.h>
#endif
#ifdef HAVE_UTEMPTER
extern "C" {
# include <utempter.h>
}
#else
# include <utmp.h>
# ifdef HAVE_UTMPX
# include <utmpx.h>
# endif
# if !defined(_PATH_UTMPX) && defined(_UTMPX_FILE)
# define _PATH_UTMPX _UTMPX_FILE
# endif
# ifdef HAVE_UPDWTMPX
# if !defined(_PATH_WTMPX) && defined(_WTMPX_FILE)
# define _PATH_WTMPX _WTMPX_FILE
# endif
# endif
#endif
/* for HP-UX (some versions) the extern C is needed, and for other
platforms it doesn't hurt */
extern "C" {
#include <termios.h>
#if defined(HAVE_TERMIO_H)
# include <termio.h> // struct winsize on some systems
#endif
}
#if defined (_HPUX_SOURCE)
# define _TERMIOS_INCLUDED
# include <bsdtty.h>
#endif
#ifdef HAVE_SYS_STROPTS_H
# include <sys/stropts.h> // Defines I_PUSH
# define _NEW_TTY_CTRL
#endif
#if defined (__FreeBSD__) || defined (__NetBSD__) || defined (__OpenBSD__) || defined (__bsdi__) || defined(__APPLE__) || defined (__DragonFly__)
# define _tcgetattr(fd, ttmode) ioctl(fd, TIOCGETA, (char *)ttmode)
#else
# if defined(_HPUX_SOURCE) || defined(__Lynx__) || defined (__CYGWIN__)
# define _tcgetattr(fd, ttmode) tcgetattr(fd, ttmode)
# else
# define _tcgetattr(fd, ttmode) ioctl(fd, TCGETS, (char *)ttmode)
# endif
#endif
#if defined (__FreeBSD__) || defined (__NetBSD__) || defined (__OpenBSD__) || defined (__bsdi__) || defined(__APPLE__) || defined (__DragonFly__)
# define _tcsetattr(fd, ttmode) ioctl(fd, TIOCSETA, (char *)ttmode)
#else
# if defined(_HPUX_SOURCE) || defined(__CYGWIN__)
# define _tcsetattr(fd, ttmode) tcsetattr(fd, TCSANOW, ttmode)
# else
# define _tcsetattr(fd, ttmode) ioctl(fd, TCSETS, (char *)ttmode)
# endif
#endif
//#include <kdebug.h>
//#include <kstandarddirs.h> // findExe
// not defined on HP-UX for example
#ifndef CTRL
# define CTRL(x) ((x) & 037)
#endif
#define TTY_GROUP "tty"
///////////////////////
// private functions //
///////////////////////
//////////////////
// private data //
//////////////////
KPtyPrivate::KPtyPrivate(KPty* parent) :
masterFd(-1), slaveFd(-1), ownMaster(true), q_ptr(parent)
{
}
KPtyPrivate::~KPtyPrivate()
{
}
bool KPtyPrivate::chownpty(bool)
{
// return !QProcess::execute(KStandardDirs::findExe("kgrantpty"),
// QStringList() << (grant?"--grant":"--revoke") << QString::number(masterFd));
return true;
}
/////////////////////////////
// public member functions //
/////////////////////////////
KPty::KPty() :
d_ptr(new KPtyPrivate(this))
{
}
KPty::KPty(KPtyPrivate *d) :
d_ptr(d)
{
d_ptr->q_ptr = this;
}
KPty::~KPty()
{
close();
delete d_ptr;
}
bool KPty::open()
{
Q_D(KPty);
if (d->masterFd >= 0)
return true;
d->ownMaster = true;
QByteArray ptyName;
// Find a master pty that we can open ////////////////////////////////
// Because not all the pty animals are created equal, they want to
// be opened by several different methods.
// We try, as we know them, one by one.
#ifdef HAVE_OPENPTY
char ptsn[PATH_MAX];
if (::openpty( &d->masterFd, &d->slaveFd, ptsn, 0, 0)) {
d->masterFd = -1;
d->slaveFd = -1;
qWarning(175) << "Can't open a pseudo teletype";
return false;
}
d->ttyName = ptsn;
#else
#ifdef HAVE__GETPTY // irix
char *ptsn = _getpty(&d->masterFd, O_RDWR|O_NOCTTY, S_IRUSR|S_IWUSR, 0);
if (ptsn) {
d->ttyName = ptsn;
goto grantedpt;
}
#elif defined(HAVE_PTSNAME) || defined(TIOCGPTN)
#ifdef HAVE_POSIX_OPENPT
d->masterFd = ::posix_openpt(O_RDWR|O_NOCTTY);
#elif defined(HAVE_GETPT)
d->masterFd = ::getpt();
#elif defined(PTM_DEVICE)
d->masterFd = ::open(PTM_DEVICE, O_RDWR|O_NOCTTY);
#else
# error No method to open a PTY master detected.
#endif
if (d->masterFd >= 0) {
#ifdef HAVE_PTSNAME
char *ptsn = ptsname(d->masterFd);
if (ptsn) {
d->ttyName = ptsn;
#else
int ptyno;
if (!ioctl(d->masterFd, TIOCGPTN, &ptyno)) {
d->ttyName = QByteArray("/dev/pts/") + QByteArray::number(ptyno);
#endif
#ifdef HAVE_GRANTPT
if (!grantpt(d->masterFd)) {
goto grantedpt;
}
#else
goto gotpty;
#endif
}
::close(d->masterFd);
d->masterFd = -1;
}
#endif // HAVE_PTSNAME || TIOCGPTN
// Linux device names, FIXME: Trouble on other systems?
for (const char * s3 = "pqrstuvwxyzabcde"; *s3; s3++) {
for (const char * s4 = "0123456789abcdef"; *s4; s4++) {
ptyName = QString().sprintf("/dev/pty%c%c", *s3, *s4).toUtf8();
d->ttyName = QString().sprintf("/dev/tty%c%c", *s3, *s4).toUtf8();
d->masterFd = ::open(ptyName.data(), O_RDWR);
if (d->masterFd >= 0) {
#ifdef Q_OS_SOLARIS
/* Need to check the process group of the pty.
* If it exists, then the slave pty is in use,
* and we need to get another one.
*/
int pgrp_rtn;
if (ioctl(d->masterFd, TIOCGPGRP, &pgrp_rtn) == 0 || errno != EIO) {
::close(d->masterFd);
d->masterFd = -1;
continue;
}
#endif /* Q_OS_SOLARIS */
if (!access(d->ttyName.data(),R_OK|W_OK)) { // checks availability based on permission bits
if (!geteuid()) {
struct group * p = getgrnam(TTY_GROUP);
if (!p) {
p = getgrnam("wheel");
}
gid_t gid = p ? p->gr_gid : getgid ();
if (!chown(d->ttyName.data(), getuid(), gid)) {
chmod(d->ttyName.data(), S_IRUSR|S_IWUSR|S_IWGRP);
}
}
goto gotpty;
}
::close(d->masterFd);
d->masterFd = -1;
}
}
}
qWarning() << "Can't open a pseudo teletype";
return false;
gotpty:
struct stat st;
if (stat(d->ttyName.data(), &st)) {
return false; // this just cannot happen ... *cough* Yeah right, I just
// had it happen when pty #349 was allocated. I guess
// there was some sort of leak? I only had a few open.
}
if (((st.st_uid != getuid()) ||
(st.st_mode & (S_IRGRP|S_IXGRP|S_IROTH|S_IWOTH|S_IXOTH))) &&
!d->chownpty(true)) {
qWarning()
<< "chownpty failed for device " << ptyName << "::" << d->ttyName
<< "\nThis means the communication can be eavesdropped." << endl;
}
#if defined (HAVE__GETPTY) || defined (HAVE_GRANTPT)
grantedpt:
#endif
#ifdef HAVE_REVOKE
revoke(d->ttyName.data());
#endif
#ifdef HAVE_UNLOCKPT
unlockpt(d->masterFd);
#elif defined(TIOCSPTLCK)
int flag = 0;
ioctl(d->masterFd, TIOCSPTLCK, &flag);
#endif
d->slaveFd = ::open(d->ttyName.data(), O_RDWR | O_NOCTTY);
if (d->slaveFd < 0) {
qWarning() << "Can't open slave pseudo teletype";
::close(d->masterFd);
d->masterFd = -1;
return false;
}
#if (defined(__svr4__) || defined(__sgi__))
// Solaris
ioctl(d->slaveFd, I_PUSH, "ptem");
ioctl(d->slaveFd, I_PUSH, "ldterm");
#endif
#endif /* HAVE_OPENPTY */
fcntl(d->masterFd, F_SETFD, FD_CLOEXEC);
fcntl(d->slaveFd, F_SETFD, FD_CLOEXEC);
return true;
}
bool KPty::open(int fd)
{
#if !defined(HAVE_PTSNAME) && !defined(TIOCGPTN)
qWarning() << "Unsupported attempt to open pty with fd" << fd;
return false;
#else
Q_D(KPty);
if (d->masterFd >= 0) {
qWarning() << "Attempting to open an already open pty";
return false;
}
d->ownMaster = false;
# ifdef HAVE_PTSNAME
char *ptsn = ptsname(fd);
if (ptsn) {
d->ttyName = ptsn;
# else
int ptyno;
if (!ioctl(fd, TIOCGPTN, &ptyno)) {
char buf[32];
sprintf(buf, "/dev/pts/%d", ptyno);
d->ttyName = buf;
# endif
} else {
qWarning() << "Failed to determine pty slave device for fd" << fd;
return false;
}
d->masterFd = fd;
if (!openSlave()) {
d->masterFd = -1;
return false;
}
return true;
#endif
}
void KPty::closeSlave()
{
Q_D(KPty);
if (d->slaveFd < 0) {
return;
}
::close(d->slaveFd);
d->slaveFd = -1;
}
bool KPty::openSlave()
{
Q_D(KPty);
if (d->slaveFd >= 0)
return true;
if (d->masterFd < 0) {
qDebug() << "Attempting to open pty slave while master is closed";
return false;
}
//d->slaveFd = KDE_open(d->ttyName.data(), O_RDWR | O_NOCTTY);
d->slaveFd = ::open(d->ttyName.data(), O_RDWR | O_NOCTTY);
if (d->slaveFd < 0) {
qDebug() << "Can't open slave pseudo teletype";
return false;
}
fcntl(d->slaveFd, F_SETFD, FD_CLOEXEC);
return true;
}
void KPty::close()
{
Q_D(KPty);
if (d->masterFd < 0) {
return;
}
closeSlave();
// don't bother resetting unix98 pty, it will go away after closing master anyway.
if (memcmp(d->ttyName.data(), "/dev/pts/", 9)) {
if (!geteuid()) {
struct stat st;
if (!stat(d->ttyName.data(), &st)) {
chown(d->ttyName.data(), 0, st.st_gid == getgid() ? 0 : -1);
chmod(d->ttyName.data(), S_IRUSR|S_IWUSR|S_IRGRP|S_IWGRP|S_IROTH|S_IWOTH);
}
} else {
fcntl(d->masterFd, F_SETFD, 0);
d->chownpty(false);
}
}
::close(d->masterFd);
d->masterFd = -1;
}
void KPty::setCTty()
{
Q_D(KPty);
// Setup job control //////////////////////////////////
// Become session leader, process group leader,
// and get rid of the old controlling terminal.
setsid();
// make our slave pty the new controlling terminal.
#ifdef TIOCSCTTY
ioctl(d->slaveFd, TIOCSCTTY, 0);
#else
// __svr4__ hack: the first tty opened after setsid() becomes controlling tty
::close(::open(d->ttyName, O_WRONLY, 0));
#endif
// make our new process group the foreground group on the pty
int pgrp = getpid();
#if defined(_POSIX_VERSION) || defined(__svr4__)
tcsetpgrp(d->slaveFd, pgrp);
#elif defined(TIOCSPGRP)
ioctl(d->slaveFd, TIOCSPGRP, (char *)&pgrp);
#endif
}
void KPty::login(const char * user, const char * remotehost)
{
#ifdef HAVE_UTEMPTER
Q_D(KPty);
addToUtmp(d->ttyName, remotehost, d->masterFd);
Q_UNUSED(user);
#else
# ifdef HAVE_UTMPX
struct utmpx l_struct;
# else
struct utmp l_struct;
# endif
memset(&l_struct, 0, sizeof(l_struct));
// note: strncpy without terminators _is_ correct here. man 4 utmp
if (user) {
strncpy(l_struct.ut_name, user, sizeof(l_struct.ut_name));
}
if (remotehost) {
strncpy(l_struct.ut_host, remotehost, sizeof(l_struct.ut_host));
# ifdef HAVE_STRUCT_UTMP_UT_SYSLEN
l_struct.ut_syslen = qMin(strlen(remotehost), sizeof(l_struct.ut_host));
# endif
}
# ifndef __GLIBC__
Q_D(KPty);
const char * str_ptr = d->ttyName.data();
if (!memcmp(str_ptr, "/dev/", 5)) {
str_ptr += 5;
}
strncpy(l_struct.ut_line, str_ptr, sizeof(l_struct.ut_line));
# ifdef HAVE_STRUCT_UTMP_UT_ID
strncpy(l_struct.ut_id,
str_ptr + strlen(str_ptr) - sizeof(l_struct.ut_id),
sizeof(l_struct.ut_id));
# endif
# endif
# ifdef HAVE_UTMPX
gettimeofday(&l_struct.ut_tv, 0);
# else
l_struct.ut_time = time(0);
# endif
# ifdef HAVE_LOGIN
# ifdef HAVE_LOGINX
::loginx(&l_struct);
# else
::login(&l_struct);
# endif
# else
# ifdef HAVE_STRUCT_UTMP_UT_TYPE
l_struct.ut_type = USER_PROCESS;
# endif
# ifdef HAVE_STRUCT_UTMP_UT_PID
l_struct.ut_pid = getpid();
# ifdef HAVE_STRUCT_UTMP_UT_SESSION
l_struct.ut_session = getsid(0);
# endif
# endif
# ifdef HAVE_UTMPX
utmpxname(_PATH_UTMPX);
setutxent();
pututxline(&l_struct);
endutxent();
# ifdef HAVE_UPDWTMPX
updwtmpx(_PATH_WTMPX, &l_struct);
# endif
# else
utmpname(_PATH_UTMP);
setutent();
pututline(&l_struct);
endutent();
updwtmp(_PATH_WTMP, &l_struct);
# endif
# endif
#endif
}
void KPty::logout()
{
#ifdef HAVE_UTEMPTER
Q_D(KPty);
removeLineFromUtmp(d->ttyName, d->masterFd);
#else
Q_D(KPty);
const char *str_ptr = d->ttyName.data();
if (!memcmp(str_ptr, "/dev/", 5)) {
str_ptr += 5;
}
# ifdef __GLIBC__
else {
const char * sl_ptr = strrchr(str_ptr, '/');
if (sl_ptr) {
str_ptr = sl_ptr + 1;
}
}
# endif
# ifdef HAVE_LOGIN
# ifdef HAVE_LOGINX
::logoutx(str_ptr, 0, DEAD_PROCESS);
# else
::logout(str_ptr);
# endif
# else
# ifdef HAVE_UTMPX
struct utmpx l_struct, *ut;
# else
struct utmp l_struct, *ut;
# endif
memset(&l_struct, 0, sizeof(l_struct));
strncpy(l_struct.ut_line, str_ptr, sizeof(l_struct.ut_line));
# ifdef HAVE_UTMPX
utmpxname(_PATH_UTMPX);
setutxent();
if ((ut = getutxline(&l_struct))) {
# else
utmpname(_PATH_UTMP);
setutent();
if ((ut = getutline(&l_struct))) {
# endif
memset(ut->ut_name, 0, sizeof(*ut->ut_name));
memset(ut->ut_host, 0, sizeof(*ut->ut_host));
# ifdef HAVE_STRUCT_UTMP_UT_SYSLEN
ut->ut_syslen = 0;
# endif
# ifdef HAVE_STRUCT_UTMP_UT_TYPE
ut->ut_type = DEAD_PROCESS;
# endif
# ifdef HAVE_UTMPX
gettimeofday(&ut->ut_tv, 0);
pututxline(ut);
}
endutxent();
# else
ut->ut_time = time(0);
pututline(ut);
}
endutent();
# endif
# endif
#endif
}
// XXX Supposedly, tc[gs]etattr do not work with the master on Solaris.
// Please verify.
bool KPty::tcGetAttr(struct ::termios * ttmode) const
{
Q_D(const KPty);
return _tcgetattr(d->masterFd, ttmode) == 0;
}
bool KPty::tcSetAttr(struct ::termios * ttmode)
{
Q_D(KPty);
return _tcsetattr(d->masterFd, ttmode) == 0;
}
bool KPty::setWinSize(int lines, int columns)
{
Q_D(KPty);
struct winsize winSize;
memset(&winSize, 0, sizeof(winSize));
winSize.ws_row = (unsigned short)lines;
winSize.ws_col = (unsigned short)columns;
return ioctl(d->masterFd, TIOCSWINSZ, (char *)&winSize) == 0;
}
bool KPty::setEcho(bool echo)
{
struct ::termios ttmode;
if (!tcGetAttr(&ttmode)) {
return false;
}
if (!echo) {
ttmode.c_lflag &= ~ECHO;
} else {
ttmode.c_lflag |= ECHO;
}
return tcSetAttr(&ttmode);
}
const char * KPty::ttyName() const
{
Q_D(const KPty);
return d->ttyName.data();
}
int KPty::masterFd() const
{
Q_D(const KPty);
return d->masterFd;
}
int KPty::slaveFd() const
{
Q_D(const KPty);
return d->slaveFd;
}

@ -0,0 +1,191 @@
/* This file is part of the KDE libraries
Copyright (C) 2003,2007 Oswald Buddenhagen <ossi@kde.org>
Rewritten for QT4 by e_k <e_k at users.sourceforge.net>, Copyright (C)2008
This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
modify it under the terms of the GNU Library General Public
License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
Library General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public License
along with this library; see the file COPYING.LIB. If not, write to
the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.
*/
#ifndef kpty_h
#define kpty_h
#include <QObject>
struct KPtyPrivate;
struct termios;
/**
* Provides primitives for opening & closing a pseudo TTY pair, assigning the
* controlling TTY, utmp registration and setting various terminal attributes.
*/
class KPty {
Q_DECLARE_PRIVATE(KPty)
public:
/**
* Constructor
*/
KPty();
/**
* Destructor:
*
* If the pty is still open, it will be closed. Note, however, that
* an utmp registration is @em not undone.
*/
~KPty();
/**
* Create a pty master/slave pair.
*
* @return true if a pty pair was successfully opened
*/
bool open();
bool open(int fd);
/**
* Close the pty master/slave pair.
*/
void close();
/**
* Close the pty slave descriptor.
*
* When creating the pty, KPty also opens the slave and keeps it open.
* Consequently the master will never receive an EOF notification.
* Usually this is the desired behavior, as a closed pty slave can be
* reopened any time - unlike a pipe or socket. However, in some cases
* pipe-alike behavior might be desired.
*
* After this function was called, slaveFd() and setCTty() cannot be
* used.
*/
void closeSlave();
bool openSlave();
/**
* Creates a new session and process group and makes this pty the
* controlling tty.
*/
void setCTty();
/**
* Creates an utmp entry for the tty.
* This function must be called after calling setCTty and
* making this pty the stdin.
* @param user the user to be logged on
* @param remotehost the host from which the login is coming. This is
* @em not the local host. For remote logins it should be the hostname
* of the client. For local logins from inside an X session it should
* be the name of the X display. Otherwise it should be empty.
*/
void login(const char * user = 0, const char * remotehost = 0);
/**
* Removes the utmp entry for this tty.
*/
void logout();
/**
* Wrapper around tcgetattr(3).
*
* This function can be used only while the PTY is open.
* You will need an #include &lt;termios.h&gt; to do anything useful
* with it.
*
* @param ttmode a pointer to a termios structure.
* Note: when declaring ttmode, @c struct @c ::termios must be used -
* without the '::' some version of HP-UX thinks, this declares
* the struct in your class, in your method.
* @return @c true on success, false otherwise
*/
bool tcGetAttr(struct ::termios * ttmode) const;
/**
* Wrapper around tcsetattr(3) with mode TCSANOW.
*
* This function can be used only while the PTY is open.
*
* @param ttmode a pointer to a termios structure.
* @return @c true on success, false otherwise. Note that success means
* that @em at @em least @em one attribute could be set.
*/
bool tcSetAttr(struct ::termios * ttmode);
/**
* Change the logical (screen) size of the pty.
* The default is 24 lines by 80 columns.
*
* This function can be used only while the PTY is open.
*
* @param lines the number of rows
* @param columns the number of columns
* @return @c true on success, false otherwise
*/
bool setWinSize(int lines, int columns);
/**
* Set whether the pty should echo input.
*
* Echo is on by default.
* If the output of automatically fed (non-interactive) PTY clients
* needs to be parsed, disabling echo often makes it much simpler.
*
* This function can be used only while the PTY is open.
*
* @param echo true if input should be echoed.
* @return @c true on success, false otherwise
*/
bool setEcho(bool echo);
/**
* @return the name of the slave pty device.
*
* This function should be called only while the pty is open.
*/
const char * ttyName() const;
/**
* @return the file descriptor of the master pty
*
* This function should be called only while the pty is open.
*/
int masterFd() const;
/**
* @return the file descriptor of the slave pty
*
* This function should be called only while the pty slave is open.
*/
int slaveFd() const;
protected:
/**
* @internal
*/
KPty(KPtyPrivate * d);
/**
* @internal
*/
KPtyPrivate * const d_ptr;
};
#endif

@ -0,0 +1,50 @@
/* This file is part of the KDE libraries
Copyright (C) 2003,2007 Oswald Buddenhagen <ossi@kde.org>
Rewritten for QT4 by e_k <e_k at users.sourceforge.net>, Copyright (C)2008
This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
modify it under the terms of the GNU Library General Public
License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later version.
This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
Library General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public License
along with this library; see the file COPYING.LIB. If not, write to
the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.
*/
#ifndef kpty_p_h
#define kpty_p_h
#include "kpty.h"
#include <QByteArray>
struct KPtyPrivate {
Q_DECLARE_PUBLIC(KPty)
KPtyPrivate(KPty* parent);
virtual ~KPtyPrivate();
#ifndef HAVE_OPENPTY
bool chownpty(bool grant);
#endif
int masterFd;
int slaveFd;
bool ownMaster:1;
QByteArray ttyName;
KPty *q_ptr;
};
#endif

Some files were not shown because too many files have changed in this diff Show More

Loading…
Cancel
Save